ML101240859: Difference between revisions

From kanterella
Jump to navigation Jump to search
(Created page by program invented by StriderTol)
(StriderTol Bot change)
 
(One intermediate revision by the same user not shown)
Line 15: Line 15:


=Text=
=Text=
{{#Wiki_filter:}}
{{#Wiki_filter:ES-401                        Site-Specific SRO Written Examination              Form ES-401-8 Cover Sheet US. Nuclear Regulatory Commission Site-Specific SRO Written Examination Applicant Information Name:
Date:    04/2012010                              Facility/Unit:  Brunswick Units 1 & 2 Region:          I LI  i      nt LI  iv LI      ReactorType:    WL] CE LI BWL] GE Start Time:                                        Finish Time:
Instructions Use the answer sheets provided to document your answers. Staple this cover sheet on top of the answer sheets. To pass the examination you must achieve a final grade of at least 8000 percent overall, with 70.00 percent or better on the SRO-only items if given in conjunction with the RO exam; SRO-only exams given alone require a final grade of 80.00 percent to pass. You have 8 hours to complete the combined examination, and 3 hours if you are only taking the SRO portion.
Applicant Certification All work done on this examination is my own. I have neither given nor received aid.
Applicants Signature Results RO/SRO-Only/Total Examination Values                                /        /        Points Applicants Scores                                                  /        /        Points Applicants Grade                                                    /        1          Percent
 
Written Exam Reference Index
: 1. 20P-32, Condensate and Feedwater System Operating Procedure, Attachment 4, Final Feedwater Temperature Vs Power
: 2. RCIC System Partial P&ID
: 3. OEOP-O1-UG, Users Guide, Attachment 5, Heat Capacity Temperature Limit
 
1R531                                      ATTACHMENT4                                                    Information Page 1 of 2                                                    Use Final Feedwater Temperature Vs Power NOTE:  The reactor thermal power)temperature data in this table are NOT intended for determining reactor power level. The data are based on final feedwater temperature (FFWT) operating data scaled to theoretical plant thermal performance and do NOT incorporate degraded performance. Reference Precaution and Limitation 3.10.
RX PWR        Nominal FW Temp    Nominal FW Temp    I 1O.3F Reduced Reduced 1OF          FW Temp 100%              431.4            421.4              321.1 99%                430,5            420,5              320.5 98%                429.6            419.6              319.9 97%                428.7            418.7              319.3 96%                427.8            417.8              318.7 95%                426.9            416.9              318.1 94%                426.0            416.0              317.5 93%                425.1            415.1              316.9 92%                424.1            414.1              316.2 91%
* 423.2            413.2              315.6 90%                422.2            412.2              315.0 89%                421.2            411.2              314.3 88%                420.3            410.3              313.7 87%                419.3            409.3              313.0 86%                418.3            408.3              312.3 85%                417.3            407.3              311.7 84%                416.2            406.2              311.0 83%                415.2            405,2      j      310.3 82%                414.2            404,2      1      309.6 81%                413.1            403.1              308.9 80%                412.0            402.0              308.2 79%                411.0            401.0              307.5 78%                409.9            399.9              306.7 77%                408.8            398.8              306.0 76%                407.7            397.7              305.3 75%                406.5            396.5              304.5 74%                405.4            395.4              303.7 73%                404.2            394,2              303.0 72%                403.0            393.0              302.2 71%                401.9            391.9              301,4 70%                400.7            390.7              300,6 69%                399.4            389.4              299.8 68%                398.2            388.2              298.9 67%                396.9            386.9              298.1 20P-32                                      Rev. 168                                Page 296 of 309
 
ATTACHMENT 4 Page 2of2 Final Feedwater Temperature Vs Power RX PWR
[ Nomina FW Temp  Nominai FW Temp Reduced 1OF 1 10.3F Reduced FW Temp 66%              395.7__          385.7                297.3 65%              394.4            384.4                296.4 64%              393.1            383.1                295.5 63%              391.7            381.7                294.6 62%              390.4  -        380,4                293.7 61%              389.0            379.0    I          292.8 60%              387.6            377.6    1          291.9 59                386.2            376.2                290.9 58%              384.7            374.7                290.0 57%              383.3            373.3                289.0 56%              381.8            371.8                288.0 55%              380,3            370.3                287.0 54%              378.7            368.7                286.0 53%              377.2            367.2                284.9 52%              375.6            365.6                283,8 51%              373.9            363.9                282.8 50%              372.3            362.3                281.6 49%              370.6            360.6                280.5 48%              368.8            358.8                279.4 47%              367.1            357.1                278,2 46%              365.3            355.3                277.0 45%              363.4            353.4                275,7 44%              361.5            351.5                274.5 43%              359.6            349.6                273.2 42%              357.6            347.6                271.9 41%              355.            345.6                270.5 40%              353.5            343.5              269,1 39%              351A,,,          341.4              267.7 38%              349.2            339.2 37%              347.0            337.0              264.8 36%              344.6            334,6              263.2 35%              342.3            332.3              261.6 339.8            329.8      1 337.3            327.3              258.3 32%              334.7            324.7              256.6 332.0            322.0      I        254.8
                      ,,,,,,,329.2              319.2              252.9 29%              326.3            316.3              251.0 28%              323.3            313.3              249.0 27%              320.2            310.2                246,9
      ,                      317,0            307.0              244.8 313.6            303,6              242.5 24%              310,1            300,1                240.2 306.5                                237J 20P-32                              Rev. 168                                Page 297 of 309
 
RCIC STEAM POT Partial P&ID (D-02529 Sheet 1) bU j:yri P&ø1 DRAIN.
TI              POT F 045 LE                                              D59 L) S 60 OlE  a)
DRA1  \j H
si 4
i964 AS CS SI 0
P60 A
 
ATTACHMENT 5 Page 18 of 27 FIGURE 3 Heat Capacity Temperature Limit LL 210 UNSAFE ABOVE 1-                    *_._
SELECTED LINE
      <  200-\---
190 LU c  170--- :::m                                                (-)025FT
(-)1.25FT
      <  160                      -1                            1
__i%N()25OFT 150    zI:: :: : :    = HH1E : :c:EE c EE- (-)3.25 FT o  l o
4  j::                              -  [:
j 1 H425Fr Z  130          sEL.cTEDLJNE:&#xe7;E Li)      EE::::_E:+/-                E::E:L::
I              -1,150 100    300      500      700      900    1,100 0      200    400      600      800      1,000 REACTOR PRESSURE (PSIG)
SUPPRESSION POOL WATER TEMPERATURE IS DETERMINED BY:
  -    CAC-TR-4426-IA, POINT WTR AVG OR
  -    CAC-TR-4426-2A, POINT WTR AVG OR
  -    COMPUTER POINT G050 OR
  -    COMPUTER POINT G051 OR
  -    CAC-TY-4426-1 OR
  -    CAC-TY-4426-2 SELECT GRAPH LINE IMMEDIATELY BELOW SUPPRESSION POOL WATER LEVEL AS THE LIMIT.
OEOP-O1-UG                            Rev. 57                            Page 77 of 151
 
1.201001A1030c11 Unit Two was operating at rated power when the running CRD Pump tripped, the CRD system is being restarted lAW 20P-08, Control Rod Drive Hydraulic System Operating Procedure, with the following plant conditions:
2A CRD pump                              Running C12-FOO2B, Flow Control Valve 2B        Auto CRD system flow                          45 gpm C12-PCV-F003, Drive Pressure Vlv        Full open The operator is directed to throttle the C12-PCV-F003 to establish drive water DP between 260 and 275 psid.
Which one of the following choices completes the statement below?
As the operator throttles closed the C12-PCV-F003, the C12-FOO2B will throttle    (1) and drive water DP will    (2)
A. (1)open (2) lower B. (1)closed (2) lower C (1)open (2) rise D. (1)closed (2) rise
 
Feedback K/A: 201001 A1.03 Ability to predict andlor monitor changes in parameters associated with operating the CONTROL ROD DRIVE HYDRAULIC SYSTEM controls including:
CRD system flow (CFR: 41.5 / 45.5)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.9/2.8 Objective:
CLS-LP-08, Obj 6c Given plant and CRDHS conditions, predict the values for the following CRDH system parameters:
CRDHS Total System Flow Rate
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-08, CRD Hydraulic System Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
With the given conditions (F003 full open) the drive water pressure will be low. The closing of the F003 would reduce the size of the hole in the flowpath thereby raising pressure. With the F002 in auto, it would have to open to maintain the desired flowrate. All of the plausibilities deal with the relationship of the flow control valve to the pressure control valve making any of them possible depending on where the student thinks the valves are.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the F002 will open and if the F003 is in a different portion of the flowpath the pressure would drop.
Choice B: Plausible because if the F002 and F003 were in a different alignment in the flowpath this would be possible.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because if the F002 was in a different alignment this would be possible, i.e. on the drive water header.
: 2. 2&1002 K6.01 001 Which one of the following identifies how the Reactor Manual Control System will be affected by a total loss of the Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS)?
Control rods      (1)
Control rod position      (2)
A. (1)can be inserted using the Emergency Rod In Notch Override switch (2) cannot be determined from Full Core Display, 4 Rod group Display, ERFIS, or the process computer B (1) cannot be inserted by any method other than scram (2) cannot be determined from Full Core Display, 4 Rod group Display, ERFIS, or the process computer C. (1)can be inserted using the Emergency Rod In Notch Override switch (2) can be determined only from ERFIS or the process computer D. (1)cannot be inserted by any method other than scram (2) can be determined only from ERFIS or the process computer
 
Feedback                    -
K/A: 201002 K6.01 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the following will have on the REACTOR MANUAL CONTROL SYSTEM:
Select matrix power (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)
ROISRO Rating:
2.5/2.6 Objective:
CLS-LP-07 Obj 12 List the power supplies to the Reactor Manual Control and Rod Position Indication Systems.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-52, 120 VAC Electrical System SD-07, Reactor Manual Control System Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
This meets the ka by a loss of UPS which is the power supply to the select matrix and then asking how rods can be moved.
UPS provides power to the select matrix. With no rod being able to be selected, the operator can only insert rods via a scram. UPS also provides power to the Full core and four rod displays, which would be lost. RPIS is also lost. With the rod position indication gone then ERFIS / process computer will display show unknown (??)for each rod.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the Emergency In switch bypasses the RMCS logic, but there is no power to select a rod to move. There is no power to the indications (full Core/4 rod) and no RPIS input to the process computer or ERFIS.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the Emergency In switch bypasses the RMCS logic, but there is no power to select a rod to move. ERFIS/process computer has power but the RPIS input is lost.
Choice D: Plausible because ERFIS/process computer has power but the RPIS input is lost.
 
3.2olooOK5.olool Which one of the following defines the purpose of the Rod Worth Minimizer (RWM) lAW Technical Specifications?
A. Ensures that fuel enthalpy does not exceed 280 cal/gm during a control rod drop accident when power is> 19.1%.
B Ensures that fuel enthalpy does not exceed 280 cal/gm during a control rod drop accident when reactor power is 8.75%.
C. Ensures that the MCPR remains 1 .11, while withdrawing control rods, when power is> 19.1%.
D. Ensures that the MCPR remains ?1 .11, while withdrawing control rods, when reactor power is 8.75%.
Feedback K/A: 201006 K5.01 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to ROD WORTH MINIMIZER SYSTEM (RWM) (PLANT SPECIFIC):
Minimize clad damage if a control rod drop accident (CRDA) occurs P-Spec (Not-BWR6) (CFR: 41.5 / 45.3)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.3/3.7 Objective:
CLS-LP-07.1 Obj. 1 State the purpose of the RWM.
 
==Reference:==
 
Tech Spec 3.3.2.1 Control Rod Block Instrumentation Bases Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
OPERABILITY of the RWM, is required in MODES 1 and 2 when THERMAL POWER is 8.75% RTP.
When THERMAL POWER is> 8.75% RTP, there is no possible control rod configuration that results in a control rod worth that could exceed the 280 cal/gm fuel damage limit during a CRDA.
Since the failure consequences for UO2 have shown that sudden fuel pin rupture requires a fuel energy deposition of approximately 425 cal/gm, the fuel damage limit of 280 cal/gm provides a margin of safety from significant core damage which would result in release of radioactivity. Generic evaluations of a design basis CRDA (i.e., a CRDA resulting in a peak fuel energy deposition of 280 cal/gm) have shown that if the peak fuel enthalpy remains below 280 cal/gm Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the RWM enforces control rod movement from all rods full-in to the Low Power Setpoint (LPSP). (19.1%)
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the RWM enforces control rod movement from all rods full-in to the Low Power Setpoint (LPSP). (19.1%) and the RBM ensures MCPR limits.
Choice D: Plausible because the RBM is what ensures the MCPR limits.
: 4. 203000 K1.&2002 Unit One is operating at rated power with RHR Loop A operating in suppression pool cooling at a flowrate of 11,500 gpm due to entry into PCCP.
A LOCA inside primary containment subsequently occurs. Plant conditions are:
RPV level              Below TAF RPV pressure          20 psig Drywell pressure 18 psig Which one of the following is the expected response of RHR Loop A?
A. Pumping to the reactor only at 11,500 gpm.
B Pumping to the reactor only at 17,000 gpm.
C. Pumping to the suppression pool only at 11,500 gpm.
D. Pumping to both the reactor and the suppression pool at 17,000 gpm.
Feedback K/A: 203000 K1.02 Knowledge of the physical connections andlor cause effect relationships between RHRILPCI:
INJECTION MODE (PLANT SPECIFIC) and the following:
Suppression Pool (CFR: 41.2 to 41.9 / 45.7 to 45.8)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.9/3.9 Objective:
CLS-LP-17 Obj 7 Given plant conditions, determine if the RHR System should automatically initiate in the LPCI mode.
 
==Reference:==
 
sd-17 Cog Level:
High Explanation: With SPC in operation at 11,500 gpm requires two pump operation. Single pump operation limited to 10,000 gpm. When the Loca Signal occurs the LPCI system will re-aline for injection to the vessel and the SPC flowpath will isolate. Two pump operation will provide 17,000 gpm. The RPV pressure is low enough to provide for the valve manipulations and full flow to the vessel.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because previous flow was at 11500.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the overrides could have prevented the transfer to the vessel.
Choice D: Plausible because with overrides the SPC valves would not close thus providing two flowpaths.
: 5. 205000 G2.04.21 002 The following conditions exist on Unit Two following a forced outage shutdown:
Reactor pressure 100 psig MSIVs closed RHR Loop B in shutdown cooling with a cooldown in progress RHR Loop A in standby lineup Which one of the following describes how the plant will be affected if 2B RPS MG set trips? (assume no operator action)
Reactor pressure will    (1)  ; a mode change    fZ)  occur.
A. (1) continue to lower (2) will B. (1) continue to lower (2) will not C. (1)rise (2)will D (1) rise (2)will not
 
Feedback K/A: 205000 G2.04.21 Knowledge of the parameters and logic used to assess the status of safety functions, such as reactivity control, core cooling and heat removal, reactor coolant system integrity, containment conditions, radioactivity release control, etc.
Shutdown Cooling System (RHR Shutdown Cooling Mode)
(CFR: 41.7 / 43.5/45.12)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.0/4.6 Objective:
CLS-LP-200-B Obj. 05 Given a set of plant conditions, determine the plant MODE
 
==Reference:==
 
TS Cog Level:
High Explanation:
U2 Loss of RPS MG Set B will cause F008 to close thereby tripping the RHR pump. With a loss of SDC pressure will rise. With the unit at 100 psig the reactor will be in Mode 3 and will stay in mode 3 as the reactor heats up.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because if there is no effect the pressure will continue to lower and a mode change will occur.
Choice B: Plausible because if there is no effect the pressure will continue to lower and the student could think that a mode change would occur from Mode 4 to 3.
Choice C: Plausible because pressure will rise and the student could think that a mode change would occur from Mode 4 to 3.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.
 
6.206000 K4.02 001 Unit One is at rated power when a steam line break causes the temperatures in the ECCS pipe tunnel to exceed 203&deg;F two minutes ago.
Which one of the following identifies the current status of the Group 4 and Group 5 isolation valves?
A Group 4 valves closed only.
B. Group 5 valves closed only.
C. Both Group 4 and Group 5 valves closed.
D. Neither Group 4 nor Group 5 valves closed.
Feedback K/A: 206000 K4.02 Knowledge of HIGH PRESSURE COOLANT INJECTION SYSTEM design feature(s) andlor interlocks which provide for the following:
System isolation: BWR-2,3,4 (CFR: 41.7)
ROISRO Rating:
3.9/4.0 Objective:
cLS-Lp-o12-A Obj 6 Given plant conditions, determine if a Group Isolation should occur.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-12, Primary Containment Isolation System Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
RCIC Group 5 has 27 mm time delay to allow HPCI isolation to occur and possibly isolate the leak leaving RCIC available.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because it may be thought that the time delay is on the Grp 4 instead of the Grp 5.
Choice C: Plausible if they do not apply any time delays.
Choice D: Plausible if they do apply the time delay to both groups.
: 7. 209001 K3.01 001 A Dual Unit Loss of Offsite Power occurs with DGI under clearance and the following electrical plant lineup:
4 kV E-Busses          Energized from their respective available DGs 480 V E-Busses        E5 and E8 only are de-energized Then a LOCA signal is received on Unit Two.
Which one of the following completes the statement below concerning the ability of Unit Two Core Spray to restore reactor water level?
The Core Spray Pump(s) in      (1) running and injection flow is available through the (2)  , Core Spray Inboard Injection Valve.
A. (1) Loop A only is (2) 2E21-FOO5A B. (1)LoopBonlyis (2) 2E21-FOO5B C (1) both Loops are (2) 2E21-FOO5A D. (1) both Loops are (2) 2E21-FOO5B
 
Feedback K/A: 209001 K3.01 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the LOW PRESSURE CORE SPRAY SYSTEM will have on following:
Reactor water level (CFR: 41.7 / 45.4)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.8/3.9 Objective:
CLS-LP-18 Obj.13b List the power supplies for each of the following Core Spray System components: MOVs
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-I 8, Core Spray System Cog Level:
High Explanation:
This meets the KA because the power loss is causing a loss of CS and then determining what loops are available to inject (raise reactor water level) based on this loss.
A Core Spray Initiation Signal is present and power is available to both Core Spray pumps, E3 and E4 are energized. With the power loss to E8, MCC 2XD will not have power and the B loop Core Spray valves will be de-energized. So both pumps would be running and injection would only be available from A Loop of Core Spray.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because loop A pump is running and the injection path is available through A loop.
Wrong because the B loop pump is also running.
Choice B: Plausible because the loop pump has power but the injection valve does not. May think that valve power comes from the opposite unit same division similar to the RHR arrangement. The configuration of RHR pumps has power from the opposite unit for the pumps so with a loss of El makes a loss of CS pump A plausable.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because both pumps do have power but the B injection valve does not. May think that valve power comes from the opposite unit same division like RHR does.
: 8. 209001 K3.03 001 CS Pump 1A is running for surveillance testing when the CS Pump IA control power fuses blow inside its 4KV breaker compartment.
A Loss of Off-Site Power then occurs.
Which one of the following choices completes the statement below?
DGI      (1)      auto tie onto El because the  (2)
A. (1) will still (2) DG1 output breaker logic will not recognize that the CS Pump IA breaker is closed B. (1) will still (2) CS Pump lA breaker will still auto trip open C (l)will not (2) CS Pump IA breaker fails to trip open D. (l)will not (2) DG1 output breaker has no control power
 
Feedback K/A: 209001 K3.03 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the LOW PRESSURE CORE SPRAY SYSTEM will have on following:
Emergency generators (CFR: 41.7 /45.4)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.9/3.0 Objective:
CLS-LP-39 Obj.12 Given plant conditions, determine if permissives are satisfied for the DG output breaker to close.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-39, Emergency Diesel Generators Cog Level:
High Explanation:
This meets the KA because the malfunction (loss of control power to the CS pump) causes the DG not to be able to automatically close onto the E-bus.
CS pump 1A is powered from bus El and must load strip prior to EDG #1 0/P breaker closure.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible if examinee believes the blown control power fuse has effected the DGI output breaker logic Choice B: Plausible if examinee believes that the blown control power fuse will not prevent the CS Pump IA breaker from tripping on the LOOP Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible if examinee believes the blown control power fuse has effected the DGloutputt breaker logic
 
9.211000 K1,01 001 Which one of the following identifies the relationship between the SLC system and Core Spray Line Break Detection differential pressure instrument?
The      (1)      leg of this DP instrument senses            (2)    core plate pressure via the SLC/Core Differential Pressure penetration.
A. (1)variable (2) below B. (1)variable (2) above C. (1)reference (2) below D(1)reference (2) above Feedback K/A: 211000 K1.01 Knowledge of the physical connections and/or cause effect relationships between STANDBY LIQUID CONTROL SYSTEM and the following:
Core spray line break detection: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.2 to 41.9 /45.7 to 45.8)
ROISRO Rating:
3.0/3.3 Objective:
CLS-LP-18 Obj. 10 Explain the principle of operation of the CS Line Break Detection Instrumentation
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-i 8, Core Spray System Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
This system is comprised of a differential pressure detector which provides Control Room annunciation on detected high DP. The high pressure reference leg of this instrument is exposed to above core plate pressure via the SLC/Core Differential Pressure penetration. The low pressure of this instrument is normally exposed to above core pressure via the Core Spray injection line. This results in the instrument normally measuring core DP (not including core plate DP).
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the examinee may confuse the reference and variable legs and SLC does discharge below the core plate Choice B: Plausible because the examinee may confuse the reference and variable legs Choice C: Plausible because it is the reference leg and SLC does discharge below the core plate.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 10. 212000 K2.01 001 Which one of the following identifies which RPS MG Set and EPA breakers that trip on a loss of 480 VAC Substation E7?
RPS MG Set        (1)  EPA breakers    (2)
A. (1)A (2) 1 & 2 only B. (1)B (2)3&4only C(1)A (2) 1 & 2 and alternate source EPA breakers 5 & 6 D. (1)B (2) 3 & 4 and alternate source EPA breakers 5 & 6
 
Feedback K/A: 212000 K2.01 Knowledge of electrical power supplies to the following:
RPS motor-generator sets (CFR: 41.7)
ROISRO Rating:
3.2/3.3 Objective:
CLS-LP-03 Obj 1 8a State the power supplies for the following: RPS MG Set A
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-03, Reactor Protection System Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
Power for the Motor Generator Sets is tapped off two phases of the normal 480 VAC MC 1 CA/I CB (2CN2CB) power supply for the motor through a stepdown transformer (480V to 120V) from E5/E6 (E7/E8). Selectable reserve power to the Bus is provided from 120 VAC I E5(2E7) or 1 E6(2E8), and is normally selected to Division I. In the event that either RPS M-G Set fails to operate, the alternate power source must be manually selected.
Two EPAs in series are installed downstream of the generator output breaker for each Motor Generator Set and the alternate power supply for the RPS buses. Bus A is protected by EPA-I and -2; Bus B by EPA-3 and -4. Alternate power is protected by EPA-5 and -6 Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because A MG set is lost along with EPA breakers 1 & 2, but these are not the only EPA breakers to trip.
Choice B: Plausible if the examinee picks the wrong power supply and EPA breakers 3 & 4 are powered from RPS MG Set B.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible if the examinee picks the wrong power supply and EPA breakers 3 & 4 are powered from RPS MG Set B.
 
11.214000 A3.o4odn A control rod is notched out from position 12.
The operator observes the 12 indication on the four rod display goes out, comes back on, and then goes out again.
The operator then observes the 13 indication come on and then go out.
No additional rod position is displayed on the four rod display.
Which one of the following identifies the rod position that will be displayed on the RWM? (assume no additional operator action)
A. Position 12 in inverse video.
B. FE with an inferred position of 12.
C. Position 14 in inverse video.
D FE with an inferred position of 14.
 
Feedback K/A: 214000 A3.04 Ability to monitor automatic operations of the ROD POSITION INFORMATION SYSTEM including:
RCIS: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.5/3.8 Objective:
CLS-LP-07.1 Obj. 8 Explain how control rod position is inferred and substituted in the RWM
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-07.1, Rod Worth Minimizer System Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
For Brunswick the rod control system is RWM which supplies rod blocks and such and indications of the selected rod and position of that rod.
On a rod withdrawal if the even notch position (in this case 14) is failed, as long as RWM detects the previous odd reed switch (13) RWM will provide an inferred position of 14 since RWM also receives data from RMCS that the operator initiated a withdraw motion. If there is an inferred position available, it will not be automatically substituted into RWM. A substitute rod position will be displayed on RWM in inverse video.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Incorrect since 12 will not be displayed but is plausible since position 12 was the last good even position sensed by RWM Choice B: Incorrect since position 13 was detected but is plausible since no inferred position would be available if 13 failed or if no rod motion command was sensed by RWM and the last sensed reed switch was odd Choice C: Incorrect since RWM will not automatically substitute inferred position but plausible since the rod is actually at 14, and this would be the display once the operator accepts the inferred position Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 12. 215003 A2.02 001 A plant startup is in progress when the high voltage power supply for IRM G failed low.
All IRMs are on range 1. (Mode switch is in Startup)
Which one of the following choices completes the statements below?
The expected plant response is a        (1)
The action required lAW the annunciator procedure(s) is to place the      (2)
A. (1) rod block only (2) joystick on P603 for IRM G to Bypass B. (1) rod block only (2) operate switch on the IRM G drawer to STANDBY C (1) rod block with a half scram (2) joystick on P603 for IRM G to Bypass D. (1) rod block with a half scram (2) operate switch on the IRM G drawer to STANDBY
 
Feedback K/A: 215003 A2.02 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the INTERMEDIATE RANGE MONITOR (IRM)
SYSTEM; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:
IRM mop condition (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.5/3.7 Objective:
CLS-LP-09.1 Obj. 13c Given plant conditions and one of the following events, use plant procedures to determine the actions required to control and/or mitigate the consequences of the event: IRM mop alarm
 
==Reference:==
 
1 APP-A-05 SD-9.1, Neutron Monitoring System (SRM/IRM)
Cog Level:
High Explanation:
A loss of power to the high voltage supply is an mop trip of the IRM. This will cause a half scram and rod block. In order to clear the cause of this alarm per the annunciator procedure would be to place the IRM in bypass using the joystick on the P603 panel. The question can not state lAW the specific procedure because that would give the answer to the first part of the question.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the actions are correct and rod block will occur, but also a half scram will occur.
Choice B: Plausible becasue a rod block will occur and some components placing it in standby will remove the signal from the trip circuit (i.e. standby gas in standby removes the train from the logic).
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible becasue these will occur and some components placing it in standby will remove the signal from the trip circuit (i.e. standby gas in standby removes the train from the logic).
 
F3. 215004 K5.03 001 A plant startup is in progress. A control rod block has occurred. The following nuclear instrument indications are noted:
SRM        Counts      Position            IRM      Counts      Range A        5 3x10          Full In              A        25/125        3 B          190      Mid Position            B        65/125        2 C        4 6x10          Full In              C        35/1 25        3 D          125      Mid Position            D        15/125        3 E        12/125        2 F        55/125        2 G        30/125        3 H        25/125        3 Which one of the following is the minimum required action(s) that will clear the control rod block?
A Withdrawing SRM A only.
B. Ranging IRM E to range 3.
C. Withdrawing SRM A and C.
D. Ranging IRM B and F to range 3.
 
Feedback K/A: 215004 K5.03 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to SOURCE RANGE MONITOR (SRM) SYSTEM:
Changing detector position (CFR: 41.5 / 45.3)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.8/2.8 Objective:
CLS-LP-09.1 Obj. 9a Describe the insertion/withdrawal of the SRM detectors, including the following:
Reason for maintaining counts between 125 and 2x10 .
5
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-09.1, Neutron Monitoring System (SRM/IRM)
Cog Level:
High Explanation:
To clear the rod block SRM must be below 2x10 5 or IRMs must be> range 7. The retract permit is bypassed with IRMs> range 3. Withdrawing SRM A will cause the rod block to clear when less than 5
2x10 Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because IRM E is the only Div I IRM below range 3. If all Div I IRMs are above range 3 then the rod block from SRM Retract Permissive in would be bypassed, not the signal from SRM upscale. Also ranging IRM E to range 3 will cause a IRM downscale which is a rod block.
Choice C: Plausible because SRM A does need to be withdrawn and C is above the old setpoint for the upscale alarm. (recent change, old setpoint was 5x10).
4 Choice D: Plausible because IRM B & F are the only Div II IRMs below range 3 and these do meet the requirements for ranging them to 3. If all Div II IRMs are above range 3 then a rod block from SRM Retract Permissive would be bypassed on Div II, not the signal from SRM upscale.
: 14. 215005 A2.04 001 Which one of the following identifies the impact a loss of RPS MG Set B will have on the Unit One Power Range Neutron Monitoring system and identifies the action required to energize RPS B from its alternate power supply?
Power will be lost to    (1)      2 and 4.
In order to re-energize RPS B lAW I OP-03, Reactor Protection System Operating Procedure, the RPS Power Source Select Switch on Panel P610 is required to be placed in the      (2)    position.
A. (1)APRMs (2)ALTA B. (1)APRMs (2)ALTB C. (I) Voters (2)ALTA Dv (1) Voters (2)ALTB
 
Feedback K/A: 215005 A2.04 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the AVERAGE POWER RANGE MONITOR!
LOCAL POWER RANGE MONITOR SYSTEM; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:
SCRAM trip signals (CFR: 41.5 /45.6)
ROISRO Rating:
3.8/3.9 Objective:
CLS-LP-09.6 Obj.12b Given plant conditions, predict the response of the PRNMS to a malfunction/failure of the following systems/components: 120 VAC Distribution
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-09.6, Power Range Neutron Monitoring System Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Each APRM instrument receives power from two power supplies, LVPS I and LVPS 4. LVPS 1 is fed from RPS Bus A while LVPS 4 is fed from RPS Bus B. Therefore, a loss of an RPS Bus will not affect operation of the APRM NUMACS. Each of the four VOTERS corresponds to a channel of the Al, A2, Bi, and B2 RPS logic. The VOTER outputs to the RPS logic are: Al (VOTER I), A2 (VOTER 3), BI (VOTER 2), and B2 (VOTER 4). Voters 2 and 4 are powered from RPS B. OP-03 contains the steps to re-energize the RPS MG Set in which transferring to alternate power supply can be performed. If this is done then the switch will be placed in Alt B position. Some confusion usually happens as this procedure is performed because the light above the Alt B position is unlit. Students usually think then that Alt B has no power available to energize the RPS Bus and want to take the switch to Alt A which is the energized bus.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the APRM lose one power source but have a redundent power supply. The procedure action is plausible because the ALT A is a position switch that is used for transferring the A RPS to alternate. The student may confuse this with transferring to the A RPS power supply because the light will be extinguished above the Alt B position and be on above the Alt A position.
Choice B: Plausible becasue the APRM lose one power source but have a redundent power supply. Alt B is the correct switch position for the transfer switch.
Choice C: The procedure action is plausible because the ALT A is a position switch that is used for transferring the A RPS to alternate. The student may confuse this with transferring to the A RPS power supply because the light will be extinguished above the Alt B position and be on above the Alt A position.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.
: 15. 215005 A2.05 001 Unit One is at 94% power when one recirc flow input to APRM 2 fails downscale (zero).
Which one of the following identifies:
(1) the OPRM response to the recirc flow failure and (2) the required action lAW the annunciator procedures?
A (1) OPRM 2 only is enabled.
(2) Bypass APRM 2.
B. (1) OPRM 2 only is enabled.
(2) Verify RBM B auto transfers to APRM 3.
C. (1)AIl OPRMs are enabled.
(2) Bypass APRM 2.
D. (1) All OPRMs are enabled.
(2) Verify RBM B auto transfers to APRM 3.
 
- Feedback K/A: 215005 A2.05 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the AVERAGE POWER RANGE MONITOR!
LOCAL POWER RANGE MONITOR SYSTEM ; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:
Loss of recirculation flow signal (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.5/3.6 Objective:
CLS-LP-09.6 Obj 12g Given plant conditions, predict the response of the PRNMS to a malfunction/failure of the following systems/components: Recirc Flow Module
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-9.6, Power Range Neutron Monitoring System 1 APP-A-06 Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Each Numac processes the signals from one sensor in Loop A and one in Loop B and averages the signals to obtain total recirc flow rate. If one of the two recirc flow signals to an APRM failed to a zero signal with reactor power at 100%, its OPRM becomes enabled because the calculated flow is reduced to one half of its initial value. The other APRM/OPRMs will be unaffected. The RBM has a primary reference from APRM 2 with the primary alternate from APRM 4 and a secondary alternate from APRM 3. Transfer to the alternate alternate requires a critical self test fault on the alternate.
The APP direction is to bypass the effected APRM.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because the RBM B will transfer from APRM 2 to its alternate reference which is APRM 4 or its secondary alternate of APRM 3.
Choice C: Plausible because the alarm for OPRM enabled will be in alarm, and the Voters will see the OPRM enabled on all 4 voters for only OPRM 2 though.
Choice D: Plausible because the alarm for OPRM enabled will be in alarm, and the Voters will see the OPRM enabled on all 4 voters for only OPRM 2 though. The RBM B will transfer from APRM 2 to its alternate reference which is APRM 4 or its secondary alternate of APRM 3.
: 16. 216000K2.O1 001 Which one of the following identifies the power supply to the Unit One RPS A analog trip cabinets?
A. 125 VDC Panel 3A B. 125 VDC Panel 4A C 125 VDC Panel hA D. 125 VDC Panel 12A
 
Feedback K/A: 216000 K2.01 Knowledge of electrical power supplies to the following:
Analog trip system: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.7)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.8/2.8 Objective:
CLS-LP-03 Obj 1 8h State the power supplies for the following: Analog Trip System Logic Cabinets
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-03, Reactor Protection System Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
There are four cabinets for the RPS, each housing a separate channel (XU-65 through XU-68). Cabinets receive power from DC panels 1 1A(B) for Unit I and DC panels 12A(B) for unit 2. An NLI /Topaz (backup) inverter and a Lambda power supply are located in each cabinet. In order to meet the complete redundancy criteria, the power supplies are designed to be shared in the event of a power supply failure in one cabinet. These four cabinets cause a trip on a loss of power.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because this is the feed to the Unit 2 Div 1 ESS trip cabinet Choice B: Plausible because this is the feed to the Unit 1 Div 1 ESS trip cabinet Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because this is the feed to Unit two analog trip system cabinets.
: 17. 217000 A1.01 001 Following a loss of feedwater, RCIC automatically initiated and subsequently shut down on high reactor water level.
Current plant status is:
Reactor water level is 170 inches RCIC flow controller in Auto set at 200 gpm The RO opens the E51-F045 and then depresses the PF push button on the RCIC flow controller. No other actions are performed.
Which one of the following identifies the indicated flow on the RCIC flow controller that would be observed for these conditions?
A 0 gpm B. 200 gpm C. 400 gpm D. 500 gpm
 
Feedback K/A: 217000 Al .01 Ability to predict andlor monitor changes in parameters associated with operating the REACTOR CORE ISOLATION COOLING SYSTEM (RCIC) controls including; RCIC flow (CFR: 41.5 / 45.5)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.7/3.7 Objective:
CLS-LP-016-A Obj.12a Given plant conditions, with RCIC controlled from the RTGB, determine if the following automatic actions should occur: RCIC System Initiation
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-16, Reactor Core Isolation Cooling System (RCIC)
Cog Level:
High Explanation:
The RCIC Injection Valve will automatically open upon receiving a low reactor water level signal (LL2) provided that neither the Turbine Trip and Throttle Valve, E51-V8, nor the Turbine Steam Supply Valve, E51-F045, is full closed. Located on the controller face is a PF (programmable function) pushbutton.
When depressed an automatic transfer from MANUAL to AUTOMATIC at a predetermined setpoint of 400 GPM will result. NOTE: This button (PF) has no function if the controller is already in AUTOMATIC.
Since reactor level is above the LL2 setpoint, and the LL2 initiation relays do not seal in, the injection valve F013 will not auto open. The turbine will develop speed and discharge pressure causing the mm flow valve to open, but this flow will not be reflected on the flow indication since the flow instrument is located downstream of the mm flow line.
An operator that does not have knowledge of the interlocks associated with the RCIC injection valve, or who has misconceptions about the operation of the RCIC flow controller could easily choose any of the incorrect choices.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because this would be correct if the operator also opened F013, or if reactor level dropped below LL2.
Choice C: Plausible because this would be correct if the operator also opened FOl 3, or if reactor level dropped below LL2, and if the operator placed the controller in Manual prior to depressing the PF push button.
Choice D: Plausible because the PF push button would raise RCIC flow to rated (400 gpm) and not maximum per procedure (500 gpm). Achieving 500 gpm would require the flow control setpoint to be manually raised.
 
1-8. 217-0O&A1.04 001 Given the following plant conditions with RCIC in pressure control mode:
RCIC controller output        70%
Bypass to CST Vlv, E51-F022 Throttled RCIC Flow                      300 gpm RPV pressure                    990 psig, slowly rising RCIC controller                Automatic set @ 300 gpm Which one of the following identifies two independent actions that will stabilize RPV pressure?
The RO can throttle the E51-F022 in the        (1)      direction, or by      (2) the RCIC Flow Controller auto setpoint.
A. (1)open (2) lowering B. (1)open (2) raising C. (1)closed (2) lowering Db (1) closed (2) raising
 
Feedback K/A: 217000 A1.04 Ability to predict andlor monitor changes in parameters associated with operating the REACTOR CORE ISOLATION COOLING SYSTEM (RCIC) controls including:
Reactor pressure (CFR: 41.5 / 45.5)
ROISRO Rating:
3.6/3.6 Objective:
CLS-LP-016-A Obj. 17b Describe how the following evolutions are performed during operation of the RCIC system:
Adjusting RCIC flow in the reactor pressure control mode.
 
==Reference:==
 
RCIC Hard Card Cog Level:
High Explanation:
There are two ways to reduce the RPV pressure with the conditions given. One way is to close the 22 valve, thereby decreasing the size of the hole and forcing the turbine to work harder to deliver the same flowrate. The second is to raise the controller setpoint thereby causing the turbine to work harder by forcing more flow through the same size hole..
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible becasue these are the opposite of the actual answers and if the operator was trying to raise RPV pressure this would be correct.
Choice B: Plausible because raising is correct and the operator could have a misconception about the 22 valve.
Choice C: Plausible because closing the 22 is correct and the operator could have a misconception about the flow controller.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.
 
19.2lgoooK3.oloo2 Unit One is operating at power with CS pump I B under clearance.
A small break LOCA occurs simultaneously with a Loss of Off-site Power to both units.
Only DG2 and DG3 start and tie onto their respective E bus.
The following plant conditions exist on Unit One:
AUTO DEPRESS TIMERS INITIATED                  In alarm REACTOR LOW WTR LEVEL INITIATION              In alarm RPV pressure                                  600 psig Drywell pressure                              13 psig Based on the conditions above, which one of the following:
(1) identifies the status of ADS and (2) how RPV water level restoration is established?
A. (1) ADS will auto initiate.
(2) Level will be recovered with RHR Loop A.
B. (I) ADS will auto initiate.
(2) Level will be recovered with RHR Loop B.
C (1) ADS will not auto initiate.
(2) When ADS is manually initiated level will be recovered with RHR Loop A.
D. (1) ADS will not auto initiate.
(2) When ADS is manually initiated level will be recovered with RHR Loop B.
 
Feedback K/A: 218000 K3.01 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the AUTOMATIC DEPRESSURIZATION SYSTEM will have on following:
Restoration of reactor water level after a break that does not depressurize the reactor when required (CFR: 41.7 I 45.4)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.4/4.4 Objective:
CLS-LP-20 Obj. 16b Given plant conditions, predict how the following will be affected by a loss or malfunction of ADSISRVs:
: b. Reactor water level
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-20, Automatic Depressurization System (ADS)
Cog Level:
High Explanation:
With the loss of offsite power and 1 B CS pump under clearance this would leave only one pump available in each RHR loop. Therefore ADS logic is lost. Level will continue to lower until the ADS valves are manually opened (emergency depressurization) at which time the running low pressure pumps will be able to add water. Injection would be from the A Loop of RHR as the B Loop injection valves do not have power.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because ADS does have initiation conditions except that the logic will not have the appropriate pumps lined up for injection.
Choice B: Plausible because ADS does have initiation conditions except that the logic will not have the appropriate pumps lined up for injection. B Loop of RHR does not have power to the injection valves Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation.
Choice D: Plausible because ADS will not auto initiate but the B Loop of RHR does not have power to the injection valves.
: 20. 2230&2 A3.03 001 Reactor Recirculation pumps have tripped due to a low level condition.
G31-FOO1, RWCU Inboard Isol Vlv, is Closed.
G31-F004, RWCU Outboard Isol VIv, is Open.
Which one of the following identifies what the Group 3 Isolation Status Box on ERFIS will display in five minutes?
A A green GROUP ISOL B. A red NO GROUP ISOL C. A yellow GROUP ISOL CMND D. A green NO GROUP ISOL CMND Feedback K/A: 223002 A3.03 Ability to monitor automatic operations of the PRIMARY CONTAINMENT ISOLATION SYSTEM/NUCLEAR STEAM SUPPLY SHUT-OFF including:
SPDS/ERIS/CRIDS/GDS: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)
ROISRO Rating:
2.5/2.8 Objective:
CLS-LP-060-A Obj 4d Describe the methods used to do the following on the ERFIS/SPDS Computer:
Obtain Group Isolation status including valve position
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-60, ERFIS Data Aquisition, Processing and Display Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
ERFIS relies on the isolation signal to determine if an isolation is required. Since RWCU did receive a signal, ERFIS will recognize a valid isolation signal with at least one valve closed in the penetration path and remain Green and display GROUP ISOL.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation.
Choice B: Plausible because this is what would be expected with an isolation signal and no valves closed.
Choice C: Plausible because the isolation signal and valve closure time has not expired and can be confused with an incomplete isolation of the penetration flow path (both valves not closed).
Choice D: Plausible because the candidate does not recognize Recirc pump trip is LL2 (same as RWCU) would be indicated if no isolation signal present.
: 21. 23000&A1.06 001 Given the following small break LOCA conditions on Unit Two:
Drywell pressure                          14.8 psig Suppression chamber pressure              12.5 psig Which one of the following identifies the response of suppression pool water level after initiating suppression pool sprays?
The CAC-Ll-4177, Suppression Pool Level, indication will      (1)    slightly due to the      (2)    DP between the drywell and suppression pool.
A. (1)lower (2) higher B. (1)lower (2) reduced C (1) rise (2) higher D. (1)rise (2) reduced
 
Feedback K/A: 230000 Al .06 Ability to predict and/or monitor changes in parameters associated with operating the RHRILPCI:
TORUSISUPPRESSION POOL SPRAY MODE controls including:
Suppression pool level (CFR: 41.5 /45.5)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.3/3.3 Objective:
N/A
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-04, Primary Containment Cog Level:
High Explanation:
With the SP at 12.5 psig and then sprays initiated the pressure will lower in the SP and this will cause the higher delta pressure between the DW and SP to force some water down the downcomers to slightly raise the water level in the SP due to the Higher dP. The pumps take a suction from the SP and then spray back to the SP.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because a higher d/p would be developed from the spray initiation, but level would not lower based ondP.
Choice B: Plausible if the student has backward thinking of what is occurring with d/p. Lower pressure is lowering dP.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because a lower d/p would cause level to rise but the d/p will increase when sprays are initiated.
: 22. 234000 A4.02 002 Given the following conditions on Unit One with the Mode Switch in Refuel:
        -Control rod 26-27 is withdrawn to position 48 for blade removal lAW 1 OP-08, Control Rod Drive Hydraulic System Operating Procedure.
        -RWM is in Bypass Which one of the following completes the statement below if Rod Select power is turned off?
When Rod Select Power is turned back on        (1)  can be selected and the Withdraw Permissive white light (2) be lit.
A. (1) any control rod (2) will B (1) any control rod (2) will not C. (1) only Control Rod 26-27 (2) will D. (1) only Control Rod 26-27 (2) will not
 
Feedback KJA: 234000 A4.02 Ability to manually operate andlor monitor in the control room:
Control rod drive system (CFR: 41.7 /45.5 to 45.8)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.4/3.7 Objective:
CLS-LP-07 Obj. 9e Describe the conditions which will energize the following indicating lights: Withdraw Permissive
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-07, Reactor Manual Control System Cog Level:
High Explanation:
The rod select circuit is designed so that the rod selection is locked in unless power is removed from the select panel. If rod select power is turned off and back on with a rod withdrawn, the interlock will allow selection of other rods, but will generate a rod block if the rod selected is different than the withdrawn rod.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because any rod may be selected but the withdraw permissive light will not be lit.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation.
Choice C: Plausible because it is a misconception that no other rod may be selected. the withdraw permissive light will not be lit.
Choice D: Plausible because it is a misconception that no other rod may be selected.
: 23. 239002 A4.04 001                                      -
The following annunciators are received while performing OPT-I 1.1.2, Automatic Depressurization System and Safety Relief Valve Operability Test:
SPTMS DIV I BULK WTR SETPOINT TSI SPTMS DIV II BULK WTR SETPOINT TSI Which one of the following identifies the minimum Suppression Pool temperature required to receive the above annunciators?
A 95&deg;F.
B  100&deg;F C 105&deg;F D. 110&deg;F.
Feedback K/A: 239002 A4.04 Ability to manually operate andlor monitor in the control room:
Suppression pool temperature (CFR: 41.7 / 45.5 to 45.8)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.3/4.3 Objective:
CLS-LP-302M Obj. 1 Given plant conditions, determine if the following AOPs should be entered: AOP-30
 
==Reference:==
 
APP UA-12 5-4(5-5)
Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
This alarm setpoint is 95&deg;F.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because this is a homogeneous setpoint distractor Choice C: Plausible because this is the setpoint for SPTMS DIV I BULK WTR TEMP SETPT TMAX Choice D: Plausible because this is the setpoint for Boron Injection Initiation Temperature (BIIT)
: 24. 259001 A2.06 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power. The DFCS control signal input to 2A RFP has been lost. The RD observes the following:
RFP A CONTROL TROUBLE alarm is received RFPT A Man/DFCS control switch is in DFCS DFCS Control light for REP A on XU-1 is out Which one of the following describes how REP 2A will respond, and what operator action is required by RFP A CONTROL TROUBLE, to adjust the speed of REP 2A?
REP2Aspeedwill          (1)
The operator can control REP A speed by      (2)
A. (1) drop to the idle speed setpoint (2) operating the REPT A Man/DECS Raise/Lower control switch B (1) remain at the last known demand (2) operating the REPT A Man/DECS Raise/Lower control switch C. (1) drop to the idle speed setpoint (2) placing the C32-SIC-R6OIA, REPT A Sp Ctl, in Manual and adjusting the output demand D. (1) remain at the last known demand (2) placing the C32-SIC-R6OIA, REPT A Sp Ctl, in Manual and adjusting the output demand
 
Feedback K/A: 259001 A2.06 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the REACTOR FEEDWATER SYSTEM ; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:
Loss of A.C. electrical power (CFR: 41.5 I 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.2/3.2 Objective:
CLS-LP-32.3 Obj. lOj Given plant conditions and one or more of the following events use plant procedures to determine the actions required to control and/or mitigate the consequences of the event:
Loss of signal from the DFCS
 
==Reference:==
 
UA-13 6-5 SD-32.3, RFP Turbine Speed Control Cog Level:
High Explanation:
UPS supplies power to the controls.
From OP-32, Section 5.7.2 (Notes)
IF RFPT B(A) MAN/DFCS selector switch is in DFCS, AND the DFCS control signal subsequently drops below 2450 rpm, OR increases to greater than 5450 rpm, THEN Woodward 5009 digital controls will automatically assume RFPT speed control and maintain current speed. In this condition, the RFPT will only respond to LOWER/RAISE speed control switch commands From APP UA-13 6-5 (RFP A Control Trouble)
IF RFPT 2A DFCS CTRL light on RTGB XU-1 is NOT illuminated, THEN attempt to control RFP turbine speed as necessary using the LOWER/RAISE speed control switch Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the woodward manual control signal automatically tracks the DFCS output signal. An operator without this knowledge could believe the RFP speed would drop to minimum woodward control speed with the DFCS control signal failed Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the DFCS control signal has failed. with the DFCS Control light out, the REP is under manual control of the woodward governor and adjusting the output of the individual REP Speed Controller will have no effect. An operator without understanding of the hierarchy of the REP control system could believe this choice is correct.
Choice D: Plausible because the DFCS control signal has failed, with the DECS Control light out, the REP is under manual control of the woodward governor and adjusting the output of the individual REP Speed Controller will have no effect. An operator without understanding of the hierarchy of the REP control system could believe this choice is correct.
: 25. 2-5900zK6.o400r Unit One is operating at rated power when the Feedwater Flow B indicator has drifted upscale.
Which one of the following identifies the effect this failure has on reactor water level and DFCS control? (Assume no operator actions)
A RPV water level will initially lower and then return to the current setpoint DFCS transfers to 1-element control B. RPV water level will initially rise and then return to the current setpoint DFCS transfers to 1-element control C. RPV water level will initially lower and then return to the current setpoint DFCS remains in 3-element control D. RPV water level will initially rise and then return to the current setpoint DFCS remains in 3-element control
 
Feedback K/A: 259002 K6.04 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the following will have on the REACTOR WATER LEVEL CONTROL SYSTEM:
Reactor feedwater flow input (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.1/3.1 Objective:
CLS-LP-32.2 Obj 7b Given plant conditions, determine the response of the DFCS to the following events:
Loss of any feed flow input
 
==Reference:==
 
APP A-07 4-2, FW CTL SYS TROUBLE SD-32.2, Digital Feedwater Control System Cog Level:
High Explanation:
DFCS is going to see the false rise in feed flow and compensate with higher steam flow drawing more inventory from the vessel causing level to initially drop.
The following signals are the permissives to operate in 3 element control:
All steam flows (4) outputs are valid (within 10% of avg)
All feed flows (2) outputs are valid (within 10% of both)
Master control station in Automatic At least one (1) Feed pump control station is in Automatic Reactor Power is > 20%
Feed flow and Steam flow matched with the feed flow failure this will transfer to I element control. Level will be maintained based on level only Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because the examinee may misinterpret the feed flow indication rise as an actual rise in feedflow which would raise vessel level.
Choice C: Plausible because level will ultimately be maintained at the current setpoint but it will transfer to single element control on greater than 10% difference between feed flow signals.
Choice D: Plausible because the examinee may misinterpret the feed flow indication rise as an actual rise in feedflow which would raise vessel level. Plausible because level will ultimately be maintained at the current setpoint but it will transfer to single element control on greater than 10% difference between feed flow signals.
: 26. 261000 A3.01 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power with Standby Gas Treatment (SBGT) System controls aligned as follows:
Train A in SYST A PREF Train B in STBY Drywell cooling is lost and the reactor scrams on high drywell pressure. Reactor water level drops to 130 inches and is now rising.
Given these plant conditions, which one of the following choices predicts the SBGT system flow indications at the XU-51 panel?
SBGT Train A flow (Fl-3150-1) is      (1)  SCFM.
SBGT Train B flow (Fl-3151-1) is      (2)  SCFM.
A. (1)0 (2)0 B. (1)0 (2) 3300 C (1)3300 (2) 0 D. (1)3300 (2) 3300
 
Feedback K/A: 261000 A3.01 Ability to monitor automatic operations of the STANDBY GAS TREATMENT SYSTEM including:
System flow (CFR: 41.7 /45.7)
ROISRO Rating:
3.2/3.3 Objective:
CLS-LP-10 Obj. 4 Given plant conditions determine if SBGTs should have initiated.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-i 0, Standby Gas Treatment System OP-I 0, Standby Gas Treatment System Operating Procedure Cog Level:
High Explanation:
With the B SBGT train in STBY it will not auto start, this is more like an Off position. There is an auto start signal from high DW pressure and flow should be verified to be greater than 3000 scfm. The control room indicators scale is from 0 to 4500 scfm. Normal system flow is 3300 scfm.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because if there was not an initiation signal this would be correct.
Choice B: Plausible because there is an initiation signal but only one train will operate. If the examinee thinks only B only will start then it would indicate 3300 scfm.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because there is a initiation signal and the examinee may think that both trains would initiate. The standby position is a common misunderstanding, this is actually an OFF position.
: 27. 262001 K6.01 001 Which one of the following identifies how the manually initiated, automatically executed fast bus transfer capability is affected following a loss of 125V DC Panel 9A?
The fast bus transfer will            (1)        if attempted for 4 KV Bus I B.
The fast bus transfer will            (2)        if attempted for 4 KV Bus IC.
A. (1)occur (2) occur B (l)occur (2) not occur C. (1)notoccur (2) occur D. (I)notoccur (2) not occur Feedback K/A: 262001 K6.01 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the following will have on the A.C.
ELECTRICAL DISTRIBUTION:
D.C. power (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)
ROISRO Rating:
3.1/3.4 Objective:
CLS-LP-50.1 Obj 7 Given plant conditions, predict the effect a loss of DC control power will have on the 4160 VAC System.
 
==Reference:==
 
01-50, 125/250 and 24/48 VDC Electrical Load Lists SD-50.1, 4160 VAC Electrical System Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
BOP Bus I B has AUTO control power transfer capability where 1 C and 1 D do not.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the auto transfer of control power will occur on I B, but will not on IC and D.
Recent plant mods have removed some of the auto transfer capabilities on some of the DC control power arrangements (E-busses require a manual transfer of control power).
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation.
Choice C: Plausible because the examinee may have the logics reversed.
Choice D: Plausible because the auto bus transfer will not occur on IC and D, but it will on lB. Recent plant mods have removed some of the auto transfer capabilities on some of the DC control power arrangements.
: 28. 262001 K6.02 001 Which one of the following completes the statements below if a Loss of Offsite Power (LOOP) occurs on Unit Two with DG4 under clearance?
RHR Pump 2B              (1)        lost its power supply.
The 2-E11-FOI5B, LPCI Inboard Injection Valve,                    (2)        lost its power supply.
A. (1)has (2) has BY (1) has (2) has not C. (1) has not (2) has D. (1)hasnot (2) has not Feedback K/A: 262001 K6.02 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the following will have on the A.C.
ELECTRICAL DISTRIBUTION:
Off-site power (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.6/3.9 Objective:
CLS-LP-39 Obj 9c Describe the effects on the plant if one or more of the EDGs failed to start during the following conditions:
LOOP
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-17, Residual Heat Removal System Cog Level:
High Explanation:
B RHR Pump receives power from E4 which is feed by DG #4. since it has failed then E4 would be de-energized and the B RHR Pump would have no power. The B Loop injection valves are powered from the same division, but opposite units E Bus. That would be E2, which does have power for the injection valves and D RHR pump.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible the B Pump has lost power and one would logically think that the B Loop would be powered by the Div II power source, which is correct except that it is from Unit 1 Div II.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the D RHR has not lost power and one would logically think that the B Loop would be powered by the Div II power source, which is correct except that it is from Unit 1 Div Choice D: Plausible because the D RHR has not lost power and the injection valve has not lost power.
: 29. 2620&2G2.04.11 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power when a complete loss of Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) occurs.
Which one of the following completes both statements below?
After the loss of UPS,    (1) of the symptoms listed in OAOP-02.O, Control Rod Malfu nction/Misposition, will be present.
lAW OAOP-12.O, Loss of Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) the TCC-V117, Main Turbine Oil Coolers TBCCW Outlet Isolation Valve, is required to be throttled  (2)
A. (1)some (2) opened B (1)some (2) closed C. (1)none (2) opened D. (1)none (2) closed
 
Feedback KJA: 262002 G2.04.11 Knowledge of abnormal condition procedures.
Uninterruptable Power Supply (A.C./D.C.)
(CFR: 41.10 /43.5/45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.0/4.2 Objective:
CLS-LP-302G Obj. 4a Given plant conditions and any of the following AOPs, determine the required supplemental actions:
AOP-12.0, Loss of Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS)
 
==Reference:==
 
OAOP-12.0, Loss of Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS)
Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
AOP-12 directs reference to AOP-02. the loss of four rod and the full core display are symptoms for AOP-02. An action in AOP-12 is IF necessary, THEN THROTTLE CLOSED MAIN TURBINE OIL COOLERS TBCCW OUTLET ISOLATION VALVE, TCC-V117, to maintain normal turbine lube oil temperature Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because some of AOP-02 symptoms are present but the TCC valve is closed not opened.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation.
Choice C: Plausible because it is not readily apparent that AOP-02 would be entered, and the TCC valve is throttled closed not open.
Choice D: Plausible because it is not readily apparent that AOP-02 would be entered.
 
3&. 263000 1(201 001 Which one of the following identifies the power supply to the Main Turbine Emergency Bearing Oil Pump (EBOP)?
A. 125 VDC Division I B. 125 VDC Division II C. 250 VDC Division I D 250 VDC Division II Feedback K/A: 263000 K2.01 Knowledge of electrical power supplies to the following:
Major D.C. loads (CFR: 41.7)
ROISRO Rating:
3.1/3.4 Objective:
CLS-LP-26.1 Obj. 5c Identify the electrical distribution system which powers the following: Emergency Bearing Oil Pump
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-26.1, Main Turbine Lube Oil and Lube Oil Storage and Conditioning Systems Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
The emergency bearing oil pump (EBOP) is provided to supply oil to the bearings of the main turbine when all ac power is lost. The EBOP is driven by a dc motor powered from 250 VDC 2(1)B.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because 125 VDC Div I is a potential DC source for an emergency pump Choice B: Plausible because 125 VDC Div II is a potential DC source for an emergency pump Choice C: Plausible because 250 VDC Div 1 is a potential DC source for an emergency pump Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 31. 264000 A1.01 002 During monthly load testing of DG3, engine outlet lube oil temperature stabilizes at 182&deg; F. A manual adjustment to LO-TCV-2077, Lube Oil Automatic Temperature Control Valve, causes DG3 to trip and lockout on high lube oil temperature.
Prior to the lockout being reset, a line break in the drywell results in the following plant conditions:
RPV water level    +40 inches RPV pressure        430 psig Drywell pressure    14.5 psig Bus E3              Energized from Off-Site power Which one of the following would be the response of DG3?
DG3 will:
A auto start and run with no operator action.
B. auto start only after the lockout relay is manually reset.
C. remain tripped because no auto start signal is present.
D. remain tripped because of the high lube oil temperature trip.
 
Feedback K/A: 264000 Al .01 Ability to predict andlor monitor changes in parameters associated with operating the EMERGENCY GENERATORS (DIESELIJET) controls including:
Lube oil temperature (CFR: 41.5 /45.5)
ROISRO Rating:
3.0/3.0 Objective:
CLS-LP-39 Obj. 18 Describe the effect of an auto start signal on a diesel generator that was tripped and locked out.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-39, Emergency Diesel Generators OP-39, Emergency Diesel Generators Operating Procedure Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Engine lockout is auto reset by any auto start signal. LOCA start signal present based on hi drywell pressure concurrent with low reactor pressure. The hi lube oil temperature trip is bypassed with any auto start signal present.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible for the examinee to think the lockout must be reset prior to D/G auto start Choice C: Plausible because the examinee may not diagnose the presence of a LOCA start signal Choice D: Plausible for the examinee to think the high lube oil temp trip would prevent an engine start for engine protection
: 32. 264000 K1:07 001 During accident conditions on Unit Two the following sequence of events occur:
Time (seconds)        Event 0          Drywell pressure rises above the scram setpoint 2          Complete Loss of Off-site Power occurs 8          Reactor pressure is 400 psig 10          DGs energize their respective E Buses 15          Reactor water level drops below LL3 Which one of the following identifies the earliest time that the LPCI pumps will auto start?
A. 10 seconds B. 15 seconds C. 18 seconds Dv 20 seconds
 
Feedback K/A: 264000 K1.07 Knowledge of the physical connections and/or cause effect relationships between EMERGENCY GENERATORS (DIESEL/JET) and the following:
Emergency core cooling systems (CFR: 41.2 to 41.9 I 45.7 to 45.8)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.9/4.1 Objective:
CLS-LP-17 Obj 07 Given plant conditions, determine if the RHR System should automatically initiate in the LPCI mode.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-17, Residual Heat Removal System Cog Level:
High Explanation:
The RHR System will automatically start in the LPCI mode of operation in response to either of two initiation signals: reactor vessel low level (LL 3) or drywell high pressure coincident with reactor vessel low pressure.
All RHR Pumps automatically start 10 seconds from receipt of the initiation signal if the Emergency busses are energized (off-site power available). If off-site power is not available, the pumps automatically start 10 seconds from the time the Emergency Diesel Generators re-energize the busses.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because this is when LPCI power becomes available with a LOCA signal present Choice B: Plausible because this is when the initiation signal is present from LL3.
Choice C: Plausible because this is applying the 10 second time delay from when the initiation signal is present from hi DW pressure and low reactor pressure and would have started the pumps if electrical power was present.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.
: 33. 272000K3.05 002 Unit One is operating with the AOG system bypassed.
The AOG-HCV-1 02, AOG Bypass Valve, control switch is in Auto.
At 0800 hours the B SJAE Rad Monitor loses power.
At 0820 hours the A SJAE Rad Monitor reaches its hi hi radiation setpoint due to a valid condition.
Which one of the following identifies the earliest time that the AOG Bypass Valve will auto close?
A. 0800 B. 0815 C. 0820 Dv 0835 Feedback K/A: 272000 K3.05 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the RADIATION MONITORING System will have on following:
Offgas system (cFR: 41.5 / 45.3)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.5/3.7 Objective:
CLS-LP-11.0 Obj 5c Explain the effect that a loss/malfunction of the PRM System will have on the following: AOG System
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-i 1.0, Process Radiation Monitoring System Cog Level:
High Explanation:
AOG-HCV-102, AOG Bypass Valve, will auto close on a valid HI-HI, Lo or lnop trip signal from both detectors after a 15 minute time delay.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the examinee may believe that a loss of power to one rad monitor will initiate an isolation signal and not remember the 15 minute time delay.
Choice B: Plausible because the examinee may believe that a loss of power to one rad monitor will initiate an isolation signal and remember the 15 minute time delay.
Choice C: Plausible because the examinee may recognize the valid isolation signal but forget the 15 minute time delay.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.
: 34. 288000 K1.0 0tH Given the following plant conditions after a Loss of Off-Site Power to Unit One:
DGI                        Running at 3575 KW load DG2                        Running at 3680 KW load RB HVAC                    Isolated The operator is directed to restart Reactor Building HVAC using three (3) supply fans (75 KW each) and three (3) exhaust fans (45 KW each).
Which one of the following identifies the impact on Diesel Generator loading if:
two supply fans and two exhaust fans are sequentially started from MCC 1XG and one supply fan and one exhaust fan are sequentially started from MCC 1XH?
A. DGI only maximum load will be exceeded.
B. DG2 only maximum load will be exceeded.
C. DGI and DG2 maximum load will be exceeded.
Dv DGI and DG2 will remain within maximum load limits.
 
Feedback K/A: 288000 KI .04 Knowledge of the physical connections and/or cause effect relationships between PLANT VENTILATION SYSTEMS and the following:
AC Electrical (CFR: 41.2 to 41.9 / 45.7 to 45.8)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.6/2.6 Objective:
CLS-LP-39 Obj. 17a Given plant conditions, OP-39, OP-50.1, AOP-36.2, and/or ASSD procedures, determine the limits for the following DG parameters: Generator kW.
 
==Reference:==
 
AOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or 480V E-Buses Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Max loading during LOOP is 110% of rated (3500KW x 110% = 3850KW). 2 sets from MCC IXG (DGI) adds 240 kw for total of 3815 KW. 1 set from MCC 1XH (DG2) adds 120KW for total of 3800 KW.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible if the examinee adds the wrong values for the fans, supply vs exhaust, then this answer would be correct.
Choice B: Plausible if the examinee thinks that 1XG is from DG2, then this answer would be correct.
Choice C: Plausible if the examinee considers the rated value instead of the emergency value for the answer.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.
: 35. 290002 G2.04.46 002 Two is at rated power when the following alarm is received:
RPVFLANGE SEAL LEAK Which one of the following identifies:
(1) the 0-ring that has failed and (2) the type of instrumentation used to detect the failure?
A. (1)outer (2) pressure switch B. (1)outer (2) temperature switch C (1) inner (2) pressure switch D. (1)inner (2) temperature switch
 
Feedback K/A: 290002 02.04.46 Ability to verify that the alarms are consistent with the plant conditions.
Reactor Vessel Internals (CFR: 41.10 /43.5 / 45.3 / 45.12)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.2/4.2 Objective:
CLS-LP-01 Obj 3 Describe the plant conditions that could cause RPV Flange Seal Leak (Annunciator A-02, window 5-6) to annunciate.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-01 .2, Reactor Vessel Instrumentation Cog Level:
High Explanation:
The head to vessel flange seal is made up by two concentric 0-rings that are installed in grooves. A drilled passage connects the annulus between the two 0-rings to a pressure switch. If the pressure rises to 600 psig due to the inner 0-ring leaking, an annunciator, A-02 5-6 RPV FLANGE SEAL LEAK, will alarm by the pressure switch closing. Failure of both flange seals is detected by the primary containment leak detection system.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible if examinee has a misconception of the 0-ring configuration Choice B: Plausible if examinee has a misconception of the 0-ring configuration.
Plausible because some plant leakage detection systems monitor for system process temperature indications rather than pressure.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because some plant leakage detection systems monitor for system process temperature indications rather than pressure.
: 36. 290003 K4.01 001 Which one of the following valid alarm conditions will result in an auto start of the CREV System?
A. PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HI-HI B. AREA RAD RADWASTE BLDG HIGH C. REACTOR VESS LO LEVEL TRIP D PRI CTMT PRESS HI TRIP Feedback K/A: 290003 K4.0l Knowledge of CONTROL ROOM HVAC design feature(s) andlor interlocks which provide for the following:
System initiations/reconfiguration: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.7)
ROISRO Rating:
3.1/32 Objective:
CLS-LP-37 Obj. 4a Given plant conditions determine if signals exist that would cause the following to automatically start/open:
Emergency Recirculation Fans
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-37, Control Building HVAC System Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
An automatic start signal is initiated by any of the following:
: a. Any one of three Area Radiation Monitors (1) Control Room (Channel 1)1 mr/hr +/- .O5mr increasing (2) Control Building Ventilation Intake (Channel 2 or 3) 7 mr/hr +/-.O5mr increasing
: b. LOCA Signal detected by one of the following:
(1) Reactor Water Low Level 2 (2) Drywell Pressure High Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the LOCA signal that does start CREV comes from the same device that initiates the Group 6 isolation and the RB HI HI Rad is an input into the Group 6 isolation logic and not into the start logic for CREV.
Choice B: Plausible because radwaste is located below the main control room and control room rad signals do initiate CREV.
Choice C: Plausible since this is a low level scram setpoint and not the LL2 signal that would initiate CREV.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 37. 295001 K1.03 002 Which one of the following completes the statement below?
A single recirculation pump trip from rated power will cause the value of Critical Power to (1) and Thermal Limits (2) required to be adjusted lAW Technical Specification 3.4.1, Reactor Coolant System (RCS), for continued power operation.
(Assume operation greater than 24 hours)
A. (1) rise (2) are B. (1) rise (2) are not C (1) lower (2) are D. (1) lower (2) are not
 
Feedback K/A: 295001 K1.03 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to PARTIAL OR COMPLETE LOSS OF FORCED CORE FLOW CIRCULATION:
Thermal limits (CFR: 41.8 to 41.10)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.6/4.1 Objective:
CLS-LP-1 06A*1 3B Describe how a change in each of the following affects critical power: Mass flow rate
 
==Reference:==
 
OPS-FUN-LP-104-I (Thermal Limits)
Tech Spec 3.4.1, Reactor Coolant System (RCS)
Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
Critical Power is equal to the bundle power at which OTB occurs. As actual power goes down, void fraction increases. This causes critical power to lower, although not as significantly as actual power.
Since actual power drops further than critical power, the Critical Power Ratio gets larger.
CPR= CP/AP LCO 3.4.1 states:
Two recirculation loops with matched flows shall be in operation, OR One recirculation loop may be in operation provided the following limits are applied when the associated LCO is applicable:
: a. LCO 3.2.1, AVERAGE PLANAR LINEAR HEAT GENERATION RATE (APLHGR), single loop operation limits specified in the COLR;
: b. LCO 3.2.2, MINIMUM CRITICAL POWER RATIO (MCPR), single loop operation limits specified in the COLR;
: c. LCO 3.2.3, LINEAR HEAT GENERATION RATE (LHGR), single loop operation limits specified in the COLR; and
: d. LCO 3.3.1.1, Reactor Protection System (RPS) Instrumentation, Function 2.b (Average Power Range Monitors Simulated Thermal PowerHigh), Allowable Value of Table 3.3.1.1-1 is reset for single loop operation.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible if examinee has a misconception of Critical Power and the effects of lower core flow on CP. Part (2) is correct.
Choice B: Plausible if examinee has a misconception of Critical Power and the effects of lower core flow on CP. Plausible if the examinee is not aware of the requirements of TS 3.4.1 or is not familiar with the time requirement for the applicable action statement.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible if the examinee is not aware of the requirements of TS 3.4.1 or is not familiar with the time requirement for the applicable action statement.
 
38.295003 A2.05 001 Both Units were operating at rated power when ALL switchyard PCB position indications turn green.
Diesel Generator status:
DG1        Running loaded DG2        Under clearance DG3        Running loaded DG4        Tripped on low lube oil pressure Which one of the following identifies the AOP(s) that Unit One and Unit Two are required to perform?
Unit One is required to perform    (1)
Unit Two is required to perform    (2)
A (1) OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV EBuses (2) OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses B. (1) OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses (2) OAOP-36.2, Station Blackout C. (1) OAOP-36.2, Station Blackout (2) OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses D. (1) OAOP-36.2, Station Blackout (2) OAOP-36.2, Station Blackout
 
Feedback K/A: 295003 A2.05 Ability to determine andlor interpret the following as they apply to PARTIAL OR COMPLETE LOSS OF A.C. POWER:
Whether a partial or complete loss of A.C. power has occurred (CFR: 41 .10/43.5/45.13)
ROISRO Rating:
3.9/4.2 Objective:
LOlCLSLP303A*001 Given plant conditions and control room indications, determine if AOP 36.2, Station Blackout Procedure, should be entered.
 
==Reference:==
 
AOP-36.2, Station Blackout AOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or 480V E-Buses Cog Level:
High Explanation:
This meets the KA because the student will have to determine that all green lights is a LOOP on BOTH Units then determine that neither unit is in Station Blackout since each unit has a running and loaded DIG available.
Switchyard PCB green position indication shows all PCB are OPEN, which indicates Loss of J offsite power.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because examinee could misdiagnose unit specific DIG availability Choice C: Plausible because examinee could misdiagnose unit specific DIG availability Choice D: Plausible because examinee could confuse a loss of off-site power on both units as an entry condition for AOP-36.2 on both units
: 39. 295004 At02 001 Following a loss of feedwater on Unit Two, HPCI and RCIC are being used to restore Reactor water level to the normal band.
Then a loss of Battery Bus 2A-1 and 2A-2 occurs.
Which one of the following completes the statement below due to the conditions above?
(1)  continues to operate and if RPV water level reaches 211 inches  (2)
A. (1)HPCI (2) HPCI will still auto trip B. (1) HPCI (2) HPCI will not auto trip C. (1)RCIC (2) RCIC will still auto shutdown D (1) RCIC (2) RCIC will not auto shutdown
 
Feedback K/A: 295004 A1.02 Ability to operate and/or monitor the following as they apply to PARTIAL OR COMPLETE LOSS OF D.C. POWER:
Systems necessary to assure safe plant shutdown (CFR: 41.7 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.8/4.1 Objective:
CLS-LP-1 9*26B Given plant conditions and one of the following events, use plant procedures to determine the actions required to control and/or mitigate the consequences of the event: Loss of DC power CLS-LP-1 6*1 5E Given plant conditions, predict the RCIC System response to the following conditions:DC power failure
 
==Reference:==
 
AOP-39.0, Loss of C Power 01-50, 125/250 and 24/48 VDC Uectrical Load Lists Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Division I DC is required for HPCI start and operation. A loss of Division I DC will make the RCIC inboard isolation logic inoperable which results in failure of the steam supply valve closure on high vessel level.
A loss of Div II DC would make RCIC fail and allows for HPCI vessel high water level trip logic to be partially made up (one out of two).
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because HPCI and RCIC are impacted by a loss of either Division of DC. A loss of Div II DC will allow HPCI to continue to operate and will trip on high vessel water level. RCIC flow would be lost on loss of Div II DC.
Choice B: Plausible because HPCI and RCIC are impacted by a loss of either Division of DC. A loss of Div II DC will allow HPCI to continue to operate and will trip on high vessel water level. RCIC flow would be lost on loss of Div II DC.
Choice C: Plausible because HPCI and RCIC are impacted by a loss of either Division of DC. RCIC would continue to inject but would not trip on high vessel water level with a loss of Div I DC.
HPCI flow would be lost.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 40. 295005 AI:07 001 Unit One is operating at rated power with DGI running loaded for a monthly load test.
A fault trips the Main Generator Primary Lockout relay.
BOP Bus IC fails to transfer on the generator lockout due to failure of the SAT supply breaker to close.
Which one of the following identifies the status of the El Bus that would be reported to the CRS?
El is energized from:
A. DGI with off-site power available.
B. both DGI and from off-site power.
C. DGI with off-site power unavailable.
D off-site power with DGI running unloaded.
 
Feedback K/A: 295005 A1.07 Ability to operate and/or monitor the following as they apply to MAIN TURBINE GENERATOR TRIP:
AC. electrical distribution (CFR: 41.7 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.3/3.3 Objective:
CLSLP27*05 State the effect that actuation of a main generator lockout relay will have on the Main Generator and station loads.
CLS-LP-39 /Objectives 3, 7, 12 Given plant conditions, determine if EDGs will automatically start.
Given plant conditions, determine if:
: a. EDG output breaker will trip
: b. E Bus Master/Slave breakers will trip with the EDG in manual mode Given plant conditions, determine if permissives are satisfied for the EDG output breaker to close (either automatically or manually).
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-39, Emergency Diesel Generators, Sections 3.2.4, 3.2.6, 3.2.7, and 3.2.10 Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Based on the conditions the RO will have to determine the status in order to report to the CRS which meets the monitoring AC electrical on a generator trip.
Generator primary lockout is a loss of off-site power signal to DG auto start logic. All four DGs will auto start. The DG1 auto start signal will trip the DG1 output breaker to allow the DG to transfer from the manual to auto mode of operation (governor, voltage regulator, trip circuits). The DG will then tie back onto the bus once the bus stripped interlock and bus undervoltage interlock is satisfied. Otherwise it will continue to run unloaded. Bus 1C fails to transfer from UAT to SAT on the trip. This results in loss of BOP bus IC but this bus feeds E2, not El so Bus El will remain powered from off-site power (BOP bus).
DG2 will auto start, tie to bus E2. Bus El is being powered from off-site power via BOP bus ID and the DG1 is running unloaded Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because if the peaking relays on the E Bus actuated and tripped the master/slave breakers. Peaking relays could actuate during a fast transfer with a DG in parallel if the turbine had tripped resulting in a backup lockout rather than a primary.
Choice B: Plausible because this would be the most likely configuration if the turbine tripped resulting in a backup generator lockout instead of a primary lockout (would not produce a LOOP signal).
Choice C: Plausible because since this would be the configuration if the BOP bus that failed to transfer to the SAT was bus 1 D rather than 1 C.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 41. 295006 K1.02 002 A scram has occurred on Unit Two with the following control rod positions:
Control Rods          Fully inserted with the following exceptions:
26-31    02 26-23    02 22-35    02 22-27    02 18-23    02 18-39    02 30-23    02 30-35    02 34-31    02 Which one of the following choices completes the statement below?
The reactor (1) remain shutdown under all conditions without boron.
The operator must insert the control rods (2)        lAW LEP-02.
AY (1)will (2) by driving rods using RMCS B. (1)will (2) by placing the individual scram test switches to the Scram position C. (1)will not (2) by driving rods using RMCS D. (1)will not (2) by placing the individual scram test switches to the Scram position
 
Feedback K/A: 295006 K1.02 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to SCRAM:
Shutdown margin (CFR: 41.8 to 41.10)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.4/3.7 Objective:
 
==Reference:==
 
01-37.4, Reactor Vessel Control Procedure Basis Document LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
The given conditions state that 9 control rods are at position 02. All other control rods are fully inserted.
Per 01-37.4, Analysis has also shown that the reactor will remain shutdown under all conditions if no more than 10 control rods are withdrawn to or beyond position 02.
These conditions are meet making the correct response to part (1) The reactor WILL remain shutdown under all conditions without boron.
Step 23 of the Reactor Scram Procedure directs Alternate Control Rod Insertion per LEP-02.
The steps in LEP-02 will guide you to Section 1.0 which will direct driving control rods using RMCS.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because attempting to insert control rods using the Scram Test Switches is an option available in LEP-02 applicable to other ATWS conditions.
Choice C: Plausible if the examinee is unsure of the number of allowable rods at 02 to satisfy the shutdown under all conditions without boron statement.
Choice D: Plausible if the examinee is unsure of the number of allowable rods at 02 to satisfy the shutdown under all conditions without boron statement.
Plausible because attempting to insert control rods using the Scram Test Switches is an option available in LEP-02 applicable to other ATWS conditions.
: 42. 295008 K1.01 001 Which one of the following completes the statement below?
Excessive moisture carryover is caused by      (1) reactor water level and will result in  (2)
A. (1) high (2) increased jet pump vibrations B (1) high (2) increased erosion wear of turbine blades C. (1) low (2) reduced Reactor Recirc pump NPSH D. (1) low (2) increased erosion wear of turbine blades
 
Fcedback K/A: 295008 K1.01 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to HIGH REACTOR WATER LEVEL:
Moisture carryover (CFR:41.8to41.10)
ROISRO Rating:
3.0/3.2 Objective:
CLSLP01*08 With regard to moisture carryover:
: a. Define the term.
: b. Describe how it is affected by reactor water level.
: c. Describe the adverse affects.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-01, Nuclear Boiler System, Section 2.1.14.a Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
Moisture carryover is defined as that moisture entrained in the steam exiting the Reactor Pressure Vessel.
The amount of carryover is affected by the reactor water level. If the water level is too high, the water draining out of the separators tends to back up resulting in increased moisture out the top of the separators. Too much moisture will overload the steam dryers with a resultant decrease in steam quality exiting the reactor vessel. This decreased steam quality will cause increased erosion of turbine blades.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible if examinee confuses the effects of excessive carryover with the effects of moisture carryunder.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible if examinee confuses carryover with carryunder and if examinee confuses the effects of excessive carryover with the effects of moisture carryunder.
Choice D: Plausible if examinee confuses carryover with carryunder.
 
-43. 295014 A2.03 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power when the following conditions are observed by the RO:
Core Thermal Power initially drops below and then stabilizes slightly above 100%.
Main Generator electrical output (MWe) lowers.
Which one of the following events caused the parameter changes observed above?
A. A single control rod drop.
B An open Safety Relief Valve.
C. Reactor Recirculation Pump 2A speed step change of 2%.
D. 4A Feedwater Heater Extraction steam isolation.
 
Feedback K/A: 295014 A2.03 Ability to determine andlor interpret the following as they apply to INADVERTENT REACTIVITY ADDITION:
Cause of reactivity addition (CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.0/4.3 Objective:
CLSLP302M*01 c Given plant conditions, determine if the following Abnormal Operating Procedure(s) (AOP5) should be entered: OAOP 30.0, Safety/Relief Valve Failures
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-20, Automatic Depressurization System (ADS)
Cog Level:
High Explanation:
An SRV opening initially reduces reactor pressure (increasing Voids) causing reactor power to lower. The EHC system senses lower PAM pressure and reduces TCV position to restore pressure. This causes reduced steam flow to the Main Turbine and lower Generator MW output throughout. Reduced steam flow to MT causes less extraction steam flow to FWHs, causing reduction in final feedwater temperature to the reactor, which combined with pressure restoration, raises reactor power above the initial power level.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because a control rod drop does provide positive reactivity addition. Generator MWe would also increase.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because 2A RR pump speed rising would provide positive reactivity addition.
Generator MWe would also increase.
Choice D: Plausible because extraction steam isolation does cause feedwater temperature reduction positive reactivity addition. Generator MWe would also increase. A FWH tube leak would look similar to the SRV opening which is different from the extraction isolation.
: 44. 295015 K3.01 002 Which one of the following choices completes both statements lAW LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion?
The RWM is bypassed using a      (1)
The reason that the RWM is bypassed is because the      (2)
A (1) keylock switch (2) Emergency Rod In Notch Override switch will not work when an Insert Block exists B. (1) joystick (2) Emergency Rod In Notch Override switch will not work when an Insert Block exists C. (1) keylock switch (2) Mode Switch in Shutdown generates a Control Rod Block D. (1) joystick (2) Mode Switch in Shutdown generates a Control Rod Block
 
Feedback                    -
K/A: 295015 K3.0l Knowledge of the reasons for the following responses as they apply to INCOMPLETE SCRAM:
Bypassing rod insertion blocks (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)
ROISRO Rating:
3.4/3.7 Objective:
CLSLP007*02d State the purpose(s) of the following RWM components: Bypass Switch
 
==Reference:==
 
LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
LEP-02 is the procedure the we use to insert rods that have failed to insert on a scram. Direction is given to bypass the RWM which is accomplished by using a keylock switch in the RWM display console.
The RWM is bypassed to override the RWM Enforced Insert Block, allowing rods to be inserted using the Emergency Rod In Notch Override Switch.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because many other components are bypasses using a joystick controller.
Choice C: Plausible if examinee confuses the Shutdown withdraw block with an insert block.
Choice D: Plausible because many other components are bypasses using a joystick controller.
Plausible if examinee confuses the Shutdown withdraw block with an insert block.
 
45: 295016G 2.04.01 002 Control Room evacuation has been directed by the Shift Manager due to toxic gas.
Which one of the following identifies the next required immediate operator action that must be performed lAW OAOP-32.0, Plant Shutdown From Outside the Control Room, (for Unit One) once the main turbine has tripped?
A. Wait until steam flow is less than 3 x 106 lb/hr, then place the reactor mode switch to Shutdown.
B Immediately place the reactor mode switch to Shutdown C. Trip both Reactor Recirculation Pumps D. Manually Scram the reactor
 
Feedback K/A: 295016G 2.04.01 Knowledge of EOP entry conditions and immediate action steps.
Control Room Abandonment (CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)
There is no EOP for Control Room Abandonment; AOP-32. 0 does have entry conditions and immediate actions. K/A applied to A OP.
RO/SRO Rating:
4.6/4.8 Objective:
CLSLP302E*002 List the Immediate Operator Actions required in accordance with OAOP-32.0, Plant Shutdown from Outside Control Room.
 
==Reference:==
 
AOP-32.0, Plant Shutdown from Outside Control Room Cog Level:
High Explanation:
AOP-32 immediate actions are to be performed in a specific order so as to not challenge equipment.
: 1. MANUALLY SCRAM the reactor.
: 2. TRIP the main turbine.
: 3. OBSERVE auxiliary power transferred to the SAT.
: 4. Unit 1 only: PLACE the Reactor Mode Switch to SHUTDOWN.
: 5. Unit 2 only: WHEN steam flow is less than 3 x 106 lb/hr, THEN PLACE the Reactor Mode Switch to SHUTDOWN.
: 6. TRIP both Reactor Recirculation Pumps.
: 7. REDUCE reactor pressure to approximately 700 psig using the bypass valve opening jack.
: 8. WHEN reactor pressure reaches approximately 700 psig, THEN PLACE the control switches for the INBOARD and OUTBOARD MSIVS to CLOSE.
: 9. PLACE Mode Selector Switches for Condensate Booster Pumps in MAN.
: 10. PLACE Mode Selector Switches for the Condensate Pumps in MAN.
: 11. GO TO I (2)EOP-01.-RSP AND PERFORM CONCURRENTLY as many of the actions as possible prior to evacuation.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because this is a required action and the examinee may confuse the required sequence of actions.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because this is a required action and the examinee may confuse the required sequence of actions.
Choice D: Plausible because this is a required action and the examinee may confuse the required sequence of actions.
: 46. 295018 A1.02 001 A manual reactor Scram was performed on Unit Two following a complete loss of RBCCW.
Which one of the following identifies the allowances for operating a CRD Pump under these conditions without cooling water flow lAW OAOP-1 6.0, RBCCW System Failure?
The CRD Pump can be operated:
A. for a maximum of 1.5 minutes B. for a maximum of 10 minutes C for a maximum of 20 minutes D. Indefinitely Feedback K/A: 295018A1.02 Ability to operate andlor monitor the following as they apply to PARTIAL OR COMPLETE LOSS OF COMPONENT COOLING WATER:
System loads (CFR: 41.7 / 45.6)
ROISRO Rating:
3.3/3.4 Objective:
CLSLP3O2H*O1 2a Given plant conditions and entry into any of the following AOPs, explain the basis for a specific caution, note, or series of procedure steps: OAOP-16.O, RBCCW System Failure
 
==Reference:==
 
OAOP-16, RBCCW System Failure Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
A loss of RBCCW will result in elevated CRD pump component temperatures and could possibly lead to CRD pump failure. Both pumps should be tripped if a total loss of RBCCW occurs, but may be run for up to 20 minutes without RBCCW Cooling if directed by the SRO for rod insertions or RPV level control.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because Reactor Recirculation pumps must be shutdown within 90 seconds (1.5 minutes) with a loss of seal injection and seal cooling flow.
Choice B: Plausible because Reactor Recirculation pumps are allowed continued operation for a maximum of 10 minutes with no RBCCW cooling flow.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because plant OE has shown that a CRD pump can run indefinitely without RBCCW cooling.
: 47. 2950 19G 2.02.37 002 Unit Two is operating at rated power. The Non-Interruptible Air (RNA) header pressure has lowered to 65 psig due to a leak.
Which one of the following predicts how the Outboard MSIVs will be affected  if the RNA header pressure remains at this value, including the reason?
The Outboard MSIVs will:
A. remain open due to the Pneumatic Nitrogen System supplying the valve actuators in Model.
B. remain open due to the Backup Nitrogen System automatically re-aligning to the valve actuators.
C eventually drift closed due to the diminishing pneumatic supply to the valve actuators.
D. immediately close due to an automatic isolation signal.
 
Feedb-ack KJA: 295019G 2.02.37 Ability to determine operability and/or availability of safety related equipment.
Partial or Complete Loss of Instrument Air (CFR: 41.7 /43.5 / 45.12)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.6/4.6 Objective:
CLSLP25*08b Given plant conditions, predict the effect that the following will have on the Main Steam System: Loss of Reactor Non-interruptible Air (RNA)/PNS/Backup Nitrogen.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-46, Pneumatic Systems, Section 4.2.4 Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
The pneumatic sources for the outboard MSIVs are Reactor Building Non-Interruptible Air (RNA) System Division I and Division II. The pneumatic sources for the inboard MSIVs are Pneumatic Nitrogen System (PNS) Division I and Division II when operating in mode I and (RNA) System Division I and Division II when shutdown. Unlike the SRVs, a loss of PNS does not result in lining up the BU N2 System to the pneumatic operators. An air accumulator located between the MSIV air operator and the check valves provides backup operating air. The capacity of the accumulator is sufficient for the air operator to exercise the valve through one-half of a cycle (open-to-closed or closed-to-open) should the supply air to the operator be interrupted.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible if examinee confuses Inboard pneumatic supply with Outboard pneumatic supply.
Choice B: Plausible because backup nitrogen is capable of supplying the Inboard valves but not the Outboard.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible there are automatic component isolations associated with the plant Pneumatic System. This is not one.
: 48. 295020G 204.01 001 Unit Two has entered the RSP due to an inadvertent Group I isolation.
RCIC is the only injection source available.
SRVs are being used for pressure control.
Reactor water level is 160 inches and lowering.
Which one of the following is the first Suppression Pool Temperature that requires POOP entry and which additional EOPs (if any) are required to be entered given these conditions?
A. 95&deg;F None B 95&deg;F RVCP C. 105&deg;F None D. 105&deg;F RVCP
 
Feedback K/A: 295020G 2.04.01 Knowledge of EOP entry conditions and immediate action steps.
Inadvertent Containment Isolation (CFR: 41.10 /43.5 /45.13)
The EOPs at Brunswick do not have any immediate operator actions, so the question is written for only the EOP entry conditions.
RO/SRO Rating:
4.6/4.8 Objective:
LOl-CLS-LP-300-L Obj. 2 Given plant conditions, determine if the Primary Containment Control Procedure should be entered
 
==Reference:==
 
PCCP and RVCP Cog Level:
High Explanation:
EOP-02-PCCP requires entry at 95 degrees SP temperature or 105 degrees if testing is in progress. RSP requires entry into RVCP if level can not be maintained greater than 170 inches. There are no immediate operator actions for EOP entries.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because SPT is 95&deg;F which is PCCP entry condition. Level is an entry into RVCP.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because SPT at 105&deg;F is PCCP entry condition while testing. Though no testing is in progress. Level is an entry into RVCP.
Choice D: Plausible because SPT at 105&deg;F is PCCP entry condition while testing. Though no testing is in progress.
 
  - 49. 295021 A2.02 002 Following a loss of normal shutdown cooling, alternate shutdown cooling using SRVs is being performed per OAOP-1 5.0, Loss of Shutdown Cooling. Plant conditions are:
Reactor water level      400 (NO27NB)
Reactor pressure        175 psig Suppr chamber press      0.1 psig Suppr pool temp          80&deg;F SRVs                    I open RHR Pumps                2A injecting to the RPV, 2D in suppression pool cooling Based on these plant conditions which one of the following is an action that is required lAW OAOP-15.0?
A. Reduce reactor water level.
B Open an additional SRV.
C. Reduce RHR injection flowrate.
D. Start2CRHRPump.
 
Feedback K/A: 295021 A2.02 Ability to determine and/or interpret the following as they apply to LOSS OF SHUTDOWN COOLING:
RHR/shutdown cooling system flow (CFR: 41.10 /43.5 / 45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.4/3.4 Objective:
CLSLP302L*01 a Given plant conditions, determine if the following Abnormal Operating Procedure(s) (AOP5) should be entered: AOP-15.0, Loss of Shutdown Cooling
 
==Reference:==
 
OAOP-15, Loss of Shutdown Cooling, Page 2 Symptoms Cog Level:
High Explanation:
With the given conditions, reactor pressure is greater than 164 psig than SP pressure. This requires an additional SRV to be opened to make sure that there is sufficient RHR flow through the core to provide cooling.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the student may think that lower level would solve the RHR head pressure concerns.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because they may think that RHR is pressurizing the reactor.
Choice D: Plausible because they may think that starting a second pump would allow more flow through the core.
: 50. 295023 K3.03 001 A spent fuel bundle has been dropped on the refuel floor. The following alarm is received:
PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HIGH Which one of the following predicts the status of Secondary Containment lAW OAOP-05.0, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation, and Airborne Activity and the reason?
Secondary Containment        (1)    in order to  (2)
A. (1) has auto isolated and SBGT has auto started (2) provide an elevated/filtered release point B. (1) has auto isolated and SBGT has auto started (2) prevent an unmonitored release C (1) is required to be manually isolated and SBGT manually started (even though no auto actions have occurred)
(2) provide an elevated/filtered release point D. (1) is required to be manually isolated and SBGT manually started (even though no auto actions have occurred)
(2) prevent an unmonitored release
 
Feedback K/A: 295023 K3.03 Knowledge of the reasons for the following responses as they apply to REFUELING ACCIDENTS:
Ventilation isolation (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.3/3.6 Objective:
CLS-LP-1 09A*01 d Identify the following as related to a Refueling Accident: Plant design features that mitigate the consequences of the accident.
 
==Reference:==
 
001-37.9, Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
With the high alarm in there is no auto start signal for SBGT or an isolation signal. The AOP states that if new or spent fuel damage is suspected then isolate secondary containment and start SBGT.
The RB HVAC system discharges to the RB Roof. Even though this is greater than 180 feet up this is not considered an elevated release point. The only elevated release point at Brunswick is the Main Stack (310 chimney).
SBGT is the normal mechanism employed under post transient conditions to maintain reactor building pressure negative with respect to the atmosphere since the exhaust from this system is processed and directed to an elevated release point before being discharged to the environment.
This question requires the operator to have knowledge of the reason for ventilation isolation as related to a refueling accident therefore matches the referenced KA statement.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the high high is a secondary containment isolation and SBGT start signal not the high alone.
Choice B: Plausible because the high high is a secondary containment isolation and SBGT start signal not the high alone. The RB HVAC is a monitored release path.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because it is required to be isolated and SBGT started. The RB HVAC is a monitored release path.
: 51. 295024G 2.02.37 001 Following a loss of feedwater, HPCI initiated on low reactor water level then tripped on high reactor water level.
Current plant conditions are:
Reactor water level                                  180 inches, steady HPCI TURB TRIP                                      alarm is sealed in HPCI TURB TRIP SQL ENER                              alarm is sealed in HPCI Initiation Signal/Reset white light            is LIT HPCI High Water Level Signal Reset white light      is LIT If drywell pressure rises to 3.0 psig with the above conditions present which one of the following is the minimum required operator action(s) (if any) to allow HPCI injection to the reactor?
A. No operator action is required.
B. Manually open E41-F006, HPCI Injection VIv.
C Depress the High Water Level Signal Reset push button.
D. Depress the High Water Level Signal Reset push button first and then manually open E41-F006, HPCI Injection VIv.
 
Feedback K/A: 295024G 2.02.37 Ability to determine operability and/or availability of safety related equipment.
High Drywell Pressure (CFR: 41 .7/43.5/45.12)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.6/4.6 Objective:
LOI-CLS-LP-19-A, Obj.3m Cog Level:
High Explanation:
A Reactor High Water Level trip is initiated and the signal seals-in when a high level is sensed by two instruments. Once the high level condition clears, the trip is reset by a subsequent Reactor Low Level 2 signal or upon depressing the Panel P601 High Level Trip Reset pushbutton. A High Drywell Pressure Initiation signal will not reset the High Water Level trip.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the high water level trip does automatically reset on LL2. If high water level is reset with an initiation signal (Hi DW Press), the system automatically aligns for injection without operator actions.
Choice B: Plausible because the high water level trip does automatically reset on LL2. Injection valve requires active initiation condition + Stop Valve (V8) & Steam Supply Valve (FOOl) not full closed to automatically open. Relay timing has caused HPCI initiation with injection valve not opening (LER 2-90-015).
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because high water level does not automatically reset due to Hi DW Press. Injection valve requires active initiation condition + Stop Valve (V8) & Steam Supply Valve (FOOl) not full closed to automatically open. Relay timing has caused HPCI initiation with injection valve not opening (LER 2-90-015)
: 52. 295025 A2.05 001 Unit One has been operating at rated power for the last 18 months.
A Loss of Off-site Power (LOOP) occurs and cannot be restored for 3 hours.
The RSP directs the following step:
                          /  STABILIZE PRESS BELOW N 1050 PSIG WITH ONE OR MORE OF THE FOLLOWING SYSTEM&
* MAiN TURBINE BYPASS VALVES
* MAIN STEAM LINE DRAINS
* RCIC
* HPCI
* SRV-IFA CONTINUOUS PNEUMATIC SUPPLY IS AVAILABLE USE OPENING 039 Which one of the following choices completes both statements below?
(1) are able to provide sufficient steam flow to stabilize reactor pressure after the LOOP (within the first 10 minutes).
Two hours later    (2)    can be used to maintain reactor pressure stable.
A. (1) OnlySRVs (2) MSL Drains B (1) Only SRVs (2) HPCI C. (1) HPCI and RCIC (combined)
(2) MSL Drains D. (1) HPCI and RCIC (combined)
(2) HPCI
 
Feedback K/A: 295025 A2.05 Ability to determine andlor interpret the following as they apply to HIGH REACTOR PRESSURE:
Decay heat generation (CFR: 41.10/43.5 / 45.13)
ROISRO Rating:
3.4/3.6 Objective:
CLS-LP-1 9*22c Given plant conditions, predict how a loss or malfunction of the HPCI System will affect the following:
Ability to remove decay heat
 
==Reference:==
 
001-37.3, Reactor Scram Procedure Basis Document Cog Level: High Explanation:
The amount of decay heat added depends on the power history of the reactor and the amount of time since the reactor was shut down. The number of fissions that have occurred determines the number of fission fragments in the core. Initial Decay Heat generation is equivalent to approximately 7% (beyond the capacity of HPCI) of the equilibrium power prior to the scram. 1 hour following the scram, Decay Heat generation is equivalent to approximately 1% power (within the capacity of HPCI and maybe RCIC).
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because only SRVs is correct and the use of MSL drains is desired but is dependent upon Off-site power availability (CWIP5 needed to allow the main condenser to be available as a heat sink), Group I isolation signal remains due to low condenser vacuum with no 1OP-25 or EOP guidance to bypass and reset the isolation signal. Reopening MSIVs would not be procedurally allowed due to Cond/FW and OW systems not having power.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because HPCI and RCIC combined capacity is below 7% and the use of MSL drains is desired but is dependent upon Off-site power availability (CWIP5 needed to allow the main condenser to be available as a heat sink), Group I isolation signal remains due to low condenser vacuum with no 1OP-25 or EOP guidance to bypass and reset the isolation signal.
Reopening MSIVs would not be procedurally allowed due to Cond/FW and CW systems not having power.
Choice D: Plausible because HPCI and RCIC combined capacity is below 7% and decay heat generation lowering is correct.
: 53. 295026 A1.01 001 An ATWS has occurred on Unit One with the following plant conditions:
Reactor power            3%, slowly lowering RPV water level          +60 inches, steady RPV pressure              300 psig Drywell pressure          3.0 psig Suppression pool temp    108&deg;F Which one of the following identifies the minimum RHR logic requirement(s), if any, to place Suppression Pool Cooling in service under the current plant conditions?
Suppression Pool Cooling can be placed in service:
A. without the use of the Think Switch or the 2/3 Core Height LPCI Initiation Override keylock switch.
B only by placing the Think Switch in Manual.
C. only by placing the Think Switch in Manual [jt and then placing the 2/3 Core Height LPCI Initiation Override keylock switch in Manual Override.
D. only by placing the 2/3 Core Height LPCI Initiation Override keylock switch in Manual Override t and then placing the Think Switch in Manual.
 
Feedback  -      -
K/A: 295026 A1.01 Ability to operate and!or monitor the following as they apply to SUPPRESSION POOL HIGH WATER TEMPERATURE:
Suppression pool cooling (CFR: 41.7 /45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.1/4.1 Objective:
LOl-CLS-LP-01 7A*009 Given an RHR pump or valve, list the interlocks, permissives and/or automatic actions associated with the RHR pump or valve, including setpoints.
 
==Reference:==
 
IOP-17, RHR System Operating Procedure, Page 282, Attachment 8 Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Reactor pressure is less than 410# with DW pressure greater than 2# which would be a LOCA signal.
With a LOCA signal present, RHR can be placed in SPC with the use of the THINK switch.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because if the LOCA signal was not present this would be correct.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because incorrect recognition of LOCA signal conditions and wrong order of Cooling/Spray logic switch manipulation.
Choice D: Plausible because incorrect recognition of LOCA signal conditions and correct order of Cooling/Spray logic switch manipulation.
: 54. 295028 K3.05 001 DRYWLLL AVIERAGE AIR TEMP RLACI4ES ORYWELI SPRAY RFQUIREO 10 INITIATE A REACTOR SCRAM AND ENTER EOP- 01 DWfT Ii Which one of the following identifies:
(1) the Drywell Average Air Temperature that requires Drywell Sprays in step DW/T-09 and (2) one of the reasons for initiating a reactor scram at step DWIT-1 I lAW 001-37.8, Primary Containment Control Procedure Basis Document?
AY (1) 300&deg;F (2) Operation at power with no recirc pumps operating is not allowed B. (1) 300&deg;F (2) when the drywell coolers are secured a high drywell pressure scram signal is imminent C. (1) 340&deg;F (2) Operation at power with no recirc pumps operating is not allowed D. (1) 340&deg;F (2) when the drywell coolers are secured a high drywell pressure scram signal is imminent
 
Feedback K/A: 295028 K3.05 Knowledge of the reasons for the following responses as they apply to HIGH DRYWELL TEMPERATURE:
Reactor SCRAM (CFR: 41.5 /45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.6/3.7 Objective:
CLSLP300L*005g Given the Primary Containment Control Procedure, determine the appropriate operator actions if any of the following limits are approached or exceeded: Drywell Design Temperature Limit
 
==Reference:==
 
001-37.8, Primary Containment Control Procedure Basis Document, STEPS DW/T-09 through DW/T-17 Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
A reactor scram is inserted once it has been determined that drywell temperature cannot be maintained below 300&deg;F and DW Spray is required. In order to spray the DW, the Reactor Recirculation Pumps and DW Coolers need to be secured. The reactor is not allowed operation at power without Recirculation Pumps in service. The scram requirement step satisfies shutting down the reactor to support tripping the Recirculation pumps.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because 300&deg;F Drywell temperature is correct. Locking out the DW coolers is an action in the DW spray procedure but is not the reason for scramming the reactor.
Choice C: Plausible because not being able to restore and maintain below 300&deg;F Drywell temperature means exceeding 300&deg;F is allowed without scram but is the step requiring emergency depressurization and tripping the recirc pumps is correct.
Choice D: Plausible because not being able to restore and maintain below 300&deg;F Drywell temperature means exceeding 300&deg;F is allowed without scram but is the step requiring emergency depressurization and Locking out the DW coolers is an action in the DW spray procedure but is not the reason for scramming the reactor.
 
55.295030K2.09001 The Safety Parameter Display System (SPDS) Plant Status Matrix indicates Suppression Pool level is -31 .5 inches.
Which one of the following identifies the color code displayed by SPDS due to Suppression Pool level?
SPDS Suppression Pool level color code is:
A. Green B. Yellow C Red D. Cyan
 
Feedback                                                              -
K/A: 295030 K2.09 Knowledge of the interrelations between LOW SUPPRESSION POOL WATER LEVEL and the following:
SPDS/ERFIS/CRIDS/GDS: Plant-Specific (C FR: 41.7 / 45.8)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.5/2.8 Objective:
CLSLP060*002e Describe the basic operation of the ERFIS/SPDS Computer: Monitor Display Color Code
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-60 Rev.2, ERFIS DATA ACQUISITION, PROCESSING, AND DISPLAY Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
Requires RO to know Tech Spec required Suppression Pool water level of -31 inches and -27 inches and that PCCP entry condition is SP level below -31 or above -27 (i.e. -31.2 or -26.8).
Knowing the specific level at which the display turns yellow just informs the operator that it is approaching the High/Low alarm (TS Limits).
SPDS display will be green when SP level is <-27.5 and > -30.5 the indication will turn yellow above
-27.5 or below -30.5 until the limit of -27 or -31is reached at which time the code turns red. The red code alerts the operator of possible PCCP entry condition. AOP-14 must be exited under these conditions.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because -31.5 is easily confused due to being a negative number which combined with greater than or equal signs make this value within the normal band and therefore Green.
Choice B: Plausible because for the same reason above except approaching alarm limit.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because a wrong assumption by the candidate beyond the stem of the question. All of the inputs to SPDS are operable.
: 56. 295031K3.03 001 Which one of the following completes the statement below lAW OEOP-01-UG, Users Guide?
Maintaining reactor water level at the jet pump suction with at least one core spray pump injecting into the reactor vessel at (1) gpm provides assurance that (2) exists.
A. (1) 4700 (2) adequate core cooling B. (1) 4700 (2) the minimum steam cooling water level C(1) 5000 (2) adequate core cooling D. (1) 5000 (2) the minimum steam cooling water level
 
Feedback K/A: 295031 K3.03 Knowledge of the reasons for the following responses as they apply to REACTOR LOW WATER LEVEL:
Spray cooling (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.1/4.4 Objective:
CLSLP300B*008 Define all EOP terms per the EOP definitions list in EOP-01-UG.
 
==Reference:==
 
EOP-01-UG, EOP Users Guide Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
The reason is adequate core cooling.
Adequate core cooling exists per EOP-UG if RPV level is at the jet pump suction with Core Spray injecting at @ 5000 gpm. Jet pump suction elevation is @ -59, specified in RVCP as -57.5 for instrument readability.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because 4700 gpm was the old flow requirement prior to EC#63657 and ACC is correct.
Choice B: Plausible because 4700 gpm was the old flow requirement prior to EC#63657 and MSCWL (LL4) is -30 inches (depressurized) and would not be applicable under these accident conditions.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because 5000 gpm is correct and MSCWL (LL4) is -30 inches (depressurized) and would not be applicable under these accident conditions.
 
57.295o32K2o2oo1 During accident conditions on Unit Two SCCP directed restarting Reactor Building HVAC lAW SEP-04, Reactor Building HVAC Restart Procedure.
Shortly following restart of the ventilation system the RO observes the following:
RX BLDG VENT TEMP HIGH                            in Alarm Rx Bldg Vent Exhaust Rad Monitor A indication      2.0 mR/hr Rx Bldg Vent Exhaust Rad Monitor B indication      3.5 mR/hr Based on the current conditions which one of the following:
(1) identifies the required action(s) and (2) the reason for these actions?
A. (1) Continue to operate Reactor Building HVAC (2) Performance of SEP-04 already defeated all isolation logic.
B. (1) Continue to operate Reactor Building HVAC (2) To ensure operability of the Rx Bldg Vent Exhaust Rad Monitors.
C. (1) Ensure auto isolation of Reactor Building HVAC (2) Performance of SEP-04 already defeated all isolation logic.
Dv (1) Ensure auto isolation of Reactor Building HVAC (2) The Rx Bldg Vent Exhaust Rad Monitor readings are no longer reliable.
 
Feedback K/A: 295032 K2.02 Knowledge of the interrelations between HIGH SECONDARY CONTAINMENT AREA TEMPERATURE and the following:
Secondary containment ventilation (CFR: 41.7 / 45.8)
ROISRO Rating:
3.6/3.7 Objective:
CLSLP300M(K)*o1 1 Given plant conditions involving Reactor Building HVAC system isolation and the Secondary Containment Control Procedure, determine if the Reactor Building HVAC system should be restarted.
 
==Reference:==
 
OEOP-01-SEP-04, Reactor Building HVAC Restart Procedure, Section 2.9 Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Rx Building Vent Temp Hi alarm indicates temperature in the exhaust duct 1 35&deg;F deg. This exceeds the EQ of the Exh rad monitors. SEP-04 defeats RPV Low level, Hi DW pressure, and Main Stack rad Hi.
Rx Bldg Vent Rad Hi-Hi and Vent Temp Hi remain active and should have isolated RBHVAC and started both SBGT trains. SEP-04 also provides verification of these actions should either condition occur.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because SCCP provided guidance to restart RB HVAC which can be interpreted to mean under any conditions. Not ALL isolation logic is bypassed.
Choice B: Plausible because SCCP provided guidance to restart RB HVAC which can be interpreted to mean under any conditions. Rad monitor readings not being reliable is correct.
Choice C: Plausible because isolating RB HVAC is correct, but not ALL isolation logic is bypassed.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 58. 295033 A1.05 002 Following a Reactor Scram on Unit Two due to a loss of Off-site power (LOOP) the following plant conditions exist:
AREA RAD PXBLDG HIGH                    In alarm SOUTH RHR RM FLOOD LEVEL HI            In alarm SOUTH CS RM FLOOD LEVEL HI              In alarm Reactor Building 20 Rad Level          Approaching Max Norm Operating Rad Reactor Building 20 Temperature        Approaching Max Norm Operating Temp Based on the conditions above which one of the following identifies:
(1) the source of the leak and (2) the operator action required lAW SCCP?
A. (1)SDV (2) Open seven ADS valves.
B. (1)RBCCW (2) Open seven ADS valves.
C (1) SDV (2) Cooldown within Technical Specification limits D. (1)RBCCW (2) Cooldown within Technical Specification limits
 
Feedback K/A: 295033 A1.05 Ability to operate andlor monitor the following as they apply to HIGH SECONDARY CONTAINMENT AREA RADIATION LEVELS:
Affected systems so as to isolate damaged portions (CFR: 41.7 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating: 3.9/4.0 Objective: CLSLP300M*08a
: 8. Given plant conditions and the Secondary Containment Control Procedure, determine if any of the following are required:
: a. Manual reactor scram
: b. Consider Anticipation of Emergency Depressurization
: c. Emergency Depressurization
 
==Reference:==
 
RSP, SCCP, 001-37.9 Cog Level: High Explanation:This meets the KA due to having to reset RPS to isolate the affected system (SDV leaking) thereby closing the scram valves which are the source of the leak causing the high rad levels in the reactor building.
Reactor Scram due to LOOP providing indications of SDV rupture.
The Maximum Normal Operating Values are the highest radiation levels expected to occur during normal plant operating conditions with all directly associated support and control systems functioning properly.
Separate radiation levels are provided for each Secondary Containment area.
Flood level Hi is MNOWL entry condition to SCCP. LOOP automatically provides Groups 1,2,3,6,8, & 10 isolations. No RWCU (Grp 3) isolation failure provided in stem. Based upon flood level status, along with rising 20 temperature and radiation leads to SDV rupture.
2 areas above MNOWL with primary system discharge requires Reactor Scram, cooldown <100 deg/hr, and consideration for anticipation of ED. No areas have reached Max Safe Operating Values, Emergency Depressurization is not required.
RPS can be reset and SCCP directs isolating the primary system discharge, main condenser not available due to LOOP Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the SDV is correct and if two areas above MSOWL with a primary system leak requires ED.
Choice B: Plausible because RBCCW leak could provide rising room levels, but area Rad and Temperature would not rise and if two areas above MSOWL with a primary system leak requires ED..
Choice C: Correct Answer Choice D: Plausible because RBCCW leak could provide rising room levels, but area Rad and Temperature would not rise and cooldown w/i TS limits is correct.
SRO Only Basis: N/A
: 59. 295035 A1.01 002 The unit is operating at rated power when the following alarms are received:
RXBLDG DIFF PRESS HIGH/LOW Which one of the following completes the statement below?
The RB Supply and Exhaust Fans (1) receive a trip signal and the SBGT System      (2) receive a start signal.
A. (1)will (2)will B (1)will (2)will not C. (1) will not (2) will D. (1)wilI not (2)wiIl not
 
Feedback                  -
K/A: 295035 A1.01 Ability to operate andlor monitor the following as they apply to SECONDARY CONTAINMENT HIGH DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE:
Secondary containment ventilation system (CFR: 41.7 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.6/3.6 Objective:
CLS-LP-037. 1 *06a List the signals that will cause the following to automatically stop: Reactor Building supply fans
 
==Reference:==
 
APP UA-12 3-3 and SD-37.1 Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
Fans trip on excessive building differential pressure (+4 inches or -4 inches) but SBGT does not start (APP UA-12 3-3)
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because RBHVAC will trip is correct and SBGT does not auto start.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because this alarm is easily confused with RB Static Press Duff Low which would not trip RB HVAC and SBGT trains auto starting to restore RB DP could be considered common sense but wrong.
Choice D: Plausible because this alarm is easily confused with RB Static Press Duff Low which would not trip RB HVAC and SBGT trains auto starting to restore RB DP could be considered common sense but wrong.
: 60. 295037 K1.03 002 Which one of the following identifies lAW LPC:
(1) the highest SLC tank level that will ensure the reactor is maintained shutdown during hot standby conditions and (2) the minimum pounds of Borax that will ensure the reactor will remain shut down irrespective of control rod position or reactor temperature?
A. (1)0%
(2) 2461 B. (1)32%
(2) 2461 C. (1)0%
(2) 6080 D (1)32%
(2) 6080
 
Feedbaek K/A: 295037 K1.03 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to SCRAM CONDITION PRESENT AND REACTOR POWER ABOVE APRM DOWNSCALE OR UNKNOWN:
Boron effects on reactor power (SBLC)
(CFR: 41.8 to 41.10)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.2/4.4 Objective:
CLSLP005*03 List the positive reactivity effects that must be overcome by SLC injection.
 
==Reference:==
 
001-37.5 Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
The Hot Shutdown Boron Weight (HSBW) is not a quantity which can be measured by the operator. An SLC tank level below 32% or approximately 2461 pounds of borax injected are equivalent to the HSBW.
The Hot Shutdown Boron Weight is defined to be the least weight of soluble boron which, if injected into the reactor vessel and uniformly mixed, will maintain the reactor shut down under hot standby conditions.
These values are determined in calculation OEOP-WS-16. It has been decided to use 32% to represent the Hot Shutdown Boron Weight in the procedure. This value can be read by the operator on the indication in the Control Room. The borax concentration for Hot Shutdown Boron Weight is calculated as approximately 2461 pounds.
The Cold Shutdown Boron Weight (CSBW) is not a quantity which can be measured by the operator. An SLC tank level of 0% or 6080 pounds of borax injected are equivalent to the CSBW. The Cold Shutdown Boron Weight is defined to be the least weight of soluble boron which, if injected into the reactor vessel and uniformly mixed, will maintain the reactor shut down under all conditions. This weight is utilized to assure the reactor will remain shut down irrespective of control rod position or reactor temperature.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because 0% is CSBW and 2461 is HSBW borax concentration Choice B: Plausible because 32% is correct HSBW and 2461 is HSBW borax concentration Choice C: Plausible because 0% is CSBW and 6080 is correct for CSBW.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 61. 295038 K2.10 002 Unit Two startup is in progress with both Mechanical Vacuum Pumps (MVPs) in service establishing main condenser vacuum when the following alarm is received:
MAIN STEAM LINE RAD HI-HI/INOP The operator determines that MSL A Rad Monitor, D12-RM-K603A, is exceeding the Hi-Hi setpoint and is the only cause for the alarm.
Which one of the following identifies the response of the MVPs?
A. MVP A will trip only.
Bk Both MVPs will remain running.
C. Both MVPs will trip and OG-V7, Hogging Valve, will close.
D. Both MVPs will trip and OG-V7, Hogging Valve, will remain open.
 
Feedback K/A: 295038 K2.10 Knowledge of the interrelations between HIGH OFF SITE RELEASE RATE and the following:
Condenser air removal.
(CFR: 41.7 / 45.8)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.2/3.4 Objective:
CLSLP30*1 lb Given the necessary plant conditions, describe the effect that a malfunction or loss of the Condenser Air Removal/Augmented Off-Gas System would have on the following: Radioactive Release Rates
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-30, Condenser Air Removal and Off-gas Recombiner System Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Hi-Hi trip on the MSL Rad channels will cause both Mechanical vacuum pumps to trip and OG-V7 valve to close. The logic trips the MVPs when a hi-hi condition is present in each division. The MVPs discharge via the 1.8 minute holdup line to the main stack. MSL rad high conditions directly impact off-site release rates with the MVPs in service due to no discharge path processing. MVPs are only allowed to be operated below 5% reactor power due no hydrogen explosion hazards present.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible due to MSL A Rad Hi-Hi causing MVP A trip (trip in one division trips a MVP).
Choice B: Correct answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible due to a single MSL Rad Hi-Hi in one division causing a complete isolation and would be correct if a second MSL Rad HI-Hi were received.
Choice D: Plausible due to a single MSL Rad Hi-Hi in one division causing a complete isolation and would be correct if a second MSL Rad HI-Hi were received and not recognizing trip impact on OG-V7.
: 62. 3000011K5.13 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power when plugging of C12-DOO6A, Supply Air Filter, causes the SCRAM VALVE PIL AIR HDR PRESS HI/LO alarm to be received.
Which one of the following identifies the impact of lowering scram air header pressure?
The CRD Scram Outlet Valves will fail (1) on a low scram air header pressure and the DW Lower Vent Dampers will reposition to the (2) position.
A (1)open (2)MAX B. (1)open (2) MIN C. (1)closed (2) MAX D. (1)closed (2) MIN
 
Feedback K/A: 300000 K5. 13 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to the INSTRUMENT AIR SYSTEM:
Filters (CFR: 41.5 / 45.3)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.9/2.9 Objective:
CLS-LP-08 Obj. 7d State the normal and fail position for the following components: CRD Scram Outlet Valves
 
==Reference:==
 
APP-A-07 SD-08, CRD Hydraulic System Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
Loss of the air supply will result in the in-service flow control valve closing. With no drive water pressure RMCS will not be able to move rods but they could still be scrammed. If air pressure would continue to lower below 40 psig the scram inlets and outlet valves would fail open on the loss of air. The lower DW dampers go to the MAX position on a scram as sensed by pressure switches in the scram air header.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation.
Choice B: Plausible since it does fail open and it may seem correct that more cooling would be needed in the upper part of the DW since hot air rises.
Choice C: Plausible because some valves do fail closed (CRD flow control valve) and the dampers do go to the MAX position Choice D: Plausible because some valves do fail closed (CRD flow control valve) and it may seem correct that more cooling would be needed in the upper part of the DW since hot air rises.
: 63. 4000001(4.01 001 Which one of the following choices completes the statements below?
The hicihest CSW system pressure that will auto start the standby CSW pump is (1) psig.
If pressure remains below this setpoint for at least (2) seconds the SW-V3(V4),
SW to TBCCW Hxs Otbd(lnbd) Isol, will reposition to their throttled positions.
A. (1)65 (2)30 B. (1)65 (2)70 C. (1)40 (2)30 D(1)40 (2)70 Feedback KJA: 400000 K4.01 Knowledge of CCWS design feature(s) and or interlocks which provide for the following:
Automatic start of standby pump (CFR: 41.7)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.4/3.9 Objective: CLS-LP-43 Obj 6d Given plant conditions, predict whether any of the following pumps should start: Conventional Service Water Pumps
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-43, Service Water System AOP-19, Conventional Service Water System Failure Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
The CSW pumps will auto start at 40 psig, the RCC pumps start at 65 psig.
The SW-V3/4 throttle to a mid position if the low pressure exists for 70 seconds.
The DG cooling valves swap to the opposite unit after low pressure for 30 seconds.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the RCC pumps auto start at 65 psig and the DG cooling valves swap to the opposite unit after low pressure for 30 seconds.
choice B: Plausible because the RCC pumps auto start at 65 psig.
Choice C: Plausible because the DG cooling valves swap to the opposite unit after low pressure for 30 seconds.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.
 
- 64. 6oo000K2.oI 001 Which one of the following completes both statements?
The SBGT Trains utilize        (1)  to indicate a fire in the filter bank.
If a valid fire signal is detected filter bank sprinkler flow      (2)  occur. (Assume no operator actions)
A. (1) temperature switches (2) will B (1) temperature switches (2) will not C. (1) ionization detectors (2) will D. (1) ionization detectors (2) will not
 
Feedback K/A: 600000 K2.01 Knowledge of the interrelations between PLANT FIRE ON SITE and the following:
Sensors / detectors and valves ROISRO Rating:
2.6/2.7 Objective:
CLS-LP-41 *21 Given plant conditions, predict the response of the Fire Suppression and Fire Detection Systems.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-lU, Standby Gas Treatment System, Section 3.2.5 Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
There are two temperature switches to monitor the temperature of each Carbon Filter in each SBGT train.(TS 3/4) Switches VA-TS-5302-1 (VA-TS-5302-2), and VA-TS-5297-1 (VA-TS-5297-2) monitor Carbon Filter Bank No. I and actuate at 210&deg;F, rising, to indicate a fire in the filter bank. Actuation of any switch will automatically open the Fire Suppression Systems deluge valve for the associated carbon bank (note that the associated isolation valves must be opened manually for this system to inject)
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because temperature switches is correct. High temperature trips the train with inlet temp < 180F but fire sprinkler flow will not occur until the local manual deluge vavle is opened.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because Ionization detectors detect the early products of combustion before they become visible smoke. High temperature trips the train with inlet temp < 180&deg;F but fire sprinkler flow will not occur until the local manual deluge valve is opened.
Choice D: Plausible because Ionization detectors detect the early products of combustion before they become visible smoke and will not is correct due to local valve manipulations required to flow water.
 
65 700000 K1.02 001 Unit Two operating at rated power with Main Generator MVAR loading at +300 MVARs.
Which one of the following completes the statement below based on these conditions?
The Main Generator component that could overheat is the (1) windings.
MVARs must be lowered to less than (2)        lAW 20P-27, Generator and Exciter System Operating Procedure.
A. (1) armature (stator)
(2) +70 B. (1) field (rotor)
(2) +70 C. (1) armature (stator)
(2) +170 D (1) field (rotor)
(2) +170
 
Feedback K/A: 700000 K1.02 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to GENERATOR VOLTAGE AND ELECTRIC GRID:
Over-excitation (CFR: 41.4,41.5,41.7,41.10/45.8)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.3/3.4 Objective:
CLSLP27*i if Given plant conditions, describe the effect that a loss or malfunction of the following may have on the Main Generator: Voltage regulator (including Under and Over-Excitation)
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-27, Main Generator and Exciter System, Section 2.17 Cog Level:
High Explanation:
The limitation placed on lagging MVARs (+ MVAR5) of the estimated capability curve, limits operation because of excessive heating that occurs in the generator field. Since the generator is operating in an overexcited condition, a larger field current is necessary to produce the extra KVAR being supplied to the system. with the conditions given, the generator is operating outside the capabilities curve. The minimum gross MVAR requirement is 70 (positive) while the maximum gross MVAR requirement is 170 (positive).
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the limitation placed on leading MVARs (- MVARs) of the estimated capability curve are less effected by Hydrogen pressure. We see that the curves come together sharply. As the system is required to supply more reactive power to the generator field, the flux in the air gap between the field and stator becomes more distorted. The distortion results in the exposed ends of the stator coils becoming overheated. As field strength is reduced, this heating accelerates. The +70 is the lower end of the operating band for the generator VARS.
Choice B: Plausible because overheating of the field is correct and the +70 is the lower end of the operating band for the generator VARS.
Choice C: Plausible because the limitation placed on leading MVARs (- MVARs) of the estimated capability curve are less effected by Hydrogen pressure. We see that the curves come together sharply. As the system is required to supply more reactive power to the generator field, the flux in the air gap between the field and stator becomes more distorted. The distortion results in the exposed ends of the stator coils becoming overheated. As field strength is reduced, this heating accelerates. The +170 is the high end of the operating band for the generator VARS.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 66. G2.O1.27OO1 Which one of the following is the purpose of the High Pressure Coolant Injection (HPCI) System lAW Technical Specifications Bases?
HPCI is designed to provide sufficient coolant injection to maintain the Reactor core covered during a    (1) Loss-Of-Coolant-Accident to maintain fuel cladding temperatures below    (2)
A. (1) small break (2) 1800&deg;F B (1) small break (2) 2200&deg;F C. (1) large break (2) 1800&deg;F D. (1) large break (2) 2200&deg;F
 
Feedback                -
K/A: G2.01.27 Conduct of Operations Knowledge of system purpose andlor function.
(CFR: 41.7)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.9/4.0 Objective:
CLS-LP-01 9*01 State the purpose of the High Pressure Coolant Injection (HPCI) System.
 
==Reference:==
 
U2 TS Bases SD-19, High Pressure Coolant Injection System (HPCI), Section 1.2 Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
The High Pressure Coolant Injection (HPCI) System was designed to provide sufficient coolant injection to maintain the Reactor core covered during a small line break Loss-Of-Coolant-Accident (LOCA) which does not result in rapid vessel depressurization, thus maintaining fuel cladding temperatures below 2200&deg;F. The original design basis of the HPCI System was to provide part of the Emergency Core Cooling System (ECCS) function. HPCI system operation mitigated small break LOCAs where the depressurization function [Automatic Depressurization System (ADS) I SRVs) was assumed to fail.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because small break is correct, and 1800&deg;F is the number for if adequate core cooling can not be maintained by core submergence.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because HPCI is a high capacity, high pressure injection system which is easily mistaken for large break LOCA makeup requirements, and 1800&deg;F is the number for if adequate core cooling can not be maintained by core submergence.
Choice D: Plausible because HPCI is a high capacity, high pressure injection system which is easily mistaken for large break LOCA makeup requirements, and 2200&deg;F is the temperature that cladding will not exceed with core submergence.
: 67. G2.0-1.31 001 LOCA conditions exist on Unit One. CREV has failed to auto start and the CRS has ordered CREV to be manually started per the Hard Card.
Which one of the following identifies:
(1) the minimum required action(s) to start the CB Emerg Recirc Fan and (2) the expected position indication for the CB Emerg Recirc Damper (VA-2J-D-CB) after the fan is started?
A. (1) Place the CB Emerg Recirc Fan control switch on Unit Two XU-3 panel to On (2) Closed B& (1) Place the CB Emerg Recirc Fan control switch on Unit Two XU-3 panel to On (2) Open C. (1) Simultaneously place both Units CB Emerg Recirc Fan control switches on their respective XU-3 panel to On (2) Closed D. (1) Simultaneously place both Units CB Emerg Recirc Fan control switches on their respective XU-3 panel to On (2) Open
 
Feedback K/A: G2.01.31 Conduct of Operations Ability to locate control room switches, controls, and indications, and to determine that they correctly reflect the desired plant lineup.
(CFR: 41.10 / 45.12)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.6/4.3 Objective:
CLS-LP-37, Obj 12d Explain the following: How to place the Control Room Ventilation system in Recirculation Mode.
 
==Reference:==
 
OOP-37, Control Building Ventilation System operating Procedure Cog Level:
High Explanation:
The controls for the CREV system are on U2 only. Indication for the CREV System is on both units. The emergency recirc damper will open when the fan is started and the open indication is red. The normal makeup damper closes on starting the fan in which the closed indication is green.
The Control Building Mechanical Equipment Room Vent Fans can only be stopped by simultaneously placing both Units control switches in OFF.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the control switch is located on U2, but the recirc damper will open. The normal makeup damper closes.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation.
Choice C: Plausible because the CB Mechanical Equipment Room Vent Fans can only be stopped by simultaneously operating both Units control switches and the normal makeup damper closes.
Choice D: Plausible because the CB Mechanical Equipment Room Vent Fans can only be stopped by simultaneously operating both Units control switches and the recirc damper does open.
: 68. G2.OL39OO1 Which one of the following describes the applicable guidance of 001.01.02, Operations Unit Organization and Operating Practices, Attachment 1, Operations Performance Standards?
When    moving a control rod    (1)  , the operator is required to stop one notch short, then single notch to  the final position unless the control rod is going to position 48 (full out).
When    moving a control rod    (2)  , the operator is required to perform separate single notch moves.
A. (1)3  notches or less (2) 4 notches or more B. (1)3  notches or less (2) 3 notches or less C. (1) 4  notches or more (2) 4 notches or more D (1) 4  notches or more (2) 3 notches or less
 
Feedback K/A: G2.0l.39 Conduct of Operations Knowledge of conservative decision making practices.
(CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.12)
ROISRO Rating:
3.6/4.3 Objective:
CLSLP201D*24f Explain the following regarding OPS-NGGC-1306 Reactivity Management Program:
The procedural requirements for positioning intermediate control rods.
 
==Reference:==
 
001-01.02, Conservative Decision Making and Reactivity Management, Attachment 1,Sectioh 5.10 Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
Control rod manipulations within the guidance of Attachment I are conservative decisions.
Per 001-01.02,
: 12) When moving a control rod four notches or more, stops one notch short, then single notches to final position unless control rod is going to position 48 (full out).
: 13) When moving a control rod three notch or less, performs separate single notch moves.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because since 3 notches provides for sufficient rod movement to allow for stopping conservatively one notch short and moving control rods 4 notches or more by single notch is conservative.
Choice B: Plausible because since 3 notches provides for sufficient rod movement to allow for stopping conservatively one notch short and 3 notches or less is correct.
Choice C: Plausible because 4 notches or more is correct and moving control rods 4 notches or more by single notch is conservative.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 69. G2.02.04 001 Which    one of  the following identifies where        the Electric Fire    Pump can  be started from?
The Electric Fire      Pump can      be  manually started      locally:
A. only.
B and    at the Unit One RTGB          only.
C. and      at the Unit Two RTGB          only.
D. and      at either  Unit One    or  Unit Two RTGBs.
Feedback K/A: G2.02.04 EQUIPMENT CONTROL (multi-unit license) Ability to explain the variations in control boardlcontrol room layouts, systems, instrumentation, and procedural actions between units at a facility.
(cFR:41.6/41.7/41.lo/45.1 /45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.6/3.6 Objective:
None
 
==Reference:==
 
OOP-41, Fire Suppression Systems Operating Procedure, Section 8.3 SD-41, Fire Suppression Systems, Section 3.2.2 cog  Level:
Low Explanation:
Ability to explain the variation is identifing the difference in location of the controls.
The Electric Fire Pump can be started
: 1. Automatically (Low system pressure)
: 2. Manually from the Control Room (Panel XU-69 which is only located on Unit One)
: 3. Manually from local control panel.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the majority of License Operator simulator training is performed on U2 simulator which does not have Panel XU-69.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because controls would exist on Unit Two however they do not. This is a difference between Units Choice D: Plausible because controls would exist on Unit Two however they do not. This is a difference between Units
: 70. G2.02.25 001 Which one of the following describes the bases for the Minimum Critical Power Ratio (MCPR) Safety Limit lAW Technical Specifications Bases 2.1.1, Reactor Core Safety Limits?
The MCPR Safety Limit ensures that:
A. the calculated total oxidation shall no where exceed 0.17 times the total cladding thickness before oxidation.
B. the calculated changes in core geometry shall be such that the core remains amenable to cooling.
C. cladding plastic strain remains less than 1%.
D during normal operation and during Anticipated Operational Occurrences, at least 99.9% of the fuel rods in the core do not experience transition boiling.
Feedback K/A: G2.02.25 EQUIPMENT CONTROL Knowledge of the bases in Technical Specifications for limiting conditions for operations and safety limits.
(CFR: 41.5 / 41.7 / 43.2)
ROISRO Rating:
3.2/4.2 Objective:
CLSLP200B*O3 State each TS Safety Limit and discuss the basis for each of the Safety Limits.
 
==Reference:==
 
U2 TS Bases Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
Requires knowledge of TS Safety Limit Bases and the ability to distinguish between Safety Limits and Operating Limits. The MCPR fuel cladding integrity SL ensures that during normal operation and during AOOs, at least 99.9% of the fuel rods in the core do not experience transition boiling.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because since this is ECCS acceptance criteria.
Choice B: Plausible because since this is ECCS acceptance criteria.
Choice C: Plausible because since this is the basis for the LHGR limit.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation
: 71. G2.02.39 001 Unit Two startup is in progress when the operating CRD Pump trips.
The following plant conditions exist:
CRD pumps                                  Unavailable Reactor Pressure                            850 psig Charging header pressure                    875 psig CRD ACCUM LO PRESS/HI LEVEL                In alarm Control Rod 18-19 Full core display        Amber Accumulator light is lit Control Rod 18-19 Full core display        Red Full Out light is lit Which one of the following describes the required action lAW Technical Specifications 3.1.5, Control Rod Scram Accumulators and OAOP-02.O, Control Rod Malfunction/Misposition?
A A manual reactor scram is required Immediately.
B. Restore charging water header to >950 psig within 20 minutes or insert a manual reactor scram.
C. Fully insert control rod 18-19 immediately and declare INOP within 1 hour.
D. A manual reactor scram is required Qjjjy if a second accumulator alarm is received.
 
Feedback K/A: G2.02.39 EQUIPMENT CONTROL Knowledge of less than or equal to one hour Technical Specification action statements for systems.
(CFR: 41.7/41.10/43.2/45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.9/4.5 Objective:
CLSLP008B*1 0 Given plant conditions, determine proper operator actions if no CRD pumps are operating.
 
==Reference:==
 
Unit 2 Tech Spec 3.1.5, Control Rod Scram Accumulators, Condition D Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Immediate scram required by Tech Spec 3.1.5, Conditions C & D.
The reactor must be immediately scrammed if either the Required Action and associated Completion Time associated with loss of the CRD charging pump (Required Actions B.1 and C.1)cannot be met. This ensures that all insertable control rods are inserted and that the reactor is in a condition that does not require the active function (i.e., scram) of the control rods.
Scram also required by supplemental actions of OAOP-02.0.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because with reactor pressure> 950 psig combined with charging header pressure
            <940 psig, 20 minutes is allowed for restoration of charging water header pressure.
Choice C: Plausible because accumulator alarm could be due to High water level which would still provide for sufficient accumulator pressure to fully insert the control rod. Revision 12 of 2AOP-02.0 provided guidance on time frame to IMMEDIATELY insert a manual scram upon receipt of the first HCU low pressure alarm (A-07 6-1, confirmed by amber light on Full Core Display).
Choice D: Plausible because waiting for the second accumulator is applicable to reactor pressures
            > 950 psig for restoration of charging water header pressure.
: 72. G2.03.14 002 Unit One is operating at 50% power with the HWC System operating in Auto.
Which one of the following choices completes the statements below?
The reactor power input to HWC System is determined by total (1) flow.
If reactor power is raised, the Turbine Building radiation levels will increase due to the increased production of (2)
A. (1)Steam (2) Ammonia (NH3)
B (1) Feedwater (2) Ammonia (NH3)
C. (1)Steam (2) Nitrates (N03)
D. (1) Feedwater (2) Nitrates (N03)
 
Feedback K/A: G2.03.14 Radiation Control Knowledge of radiation or contamination hazards that may arise during normal, abnormal, or emergency conditions or activities.
(CFR: 41.12/43.4 / 45.10)
RO/SRO Rating: 3.4/3.8 Objective: CLSLP59* 14
: 14. Explain why background radiation levels outside primary containment increase when the HWC System is placed in service.
: 15. State the parameter used for the reactor power level reference input to the hydrogen injection flow controller, and explain why it is used.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-59, Revision 14, Page 8, Section 1.3.2 Cog Level: Low Explanation:
The implementation of Hydrogen Water Chemistry (H2 injection) alters the Nitrogen-16 carryover ratio.
The net production of Nitrogen-16 is not influenced by Hydrogen injection. The excess Hydrogen injected into the reactor coolant creates the driving force to shift the Nitrogen-16 distribution ratio, resulting in a larger fraction of the Nitrogen-16 forming volatile Ammonia and a smaller fraction forming Nitrites and Nitrates. This additional volatile Ammonia is then carried over in the reactor steam resulting in higher background radiation levels. Any increase in Hydrogen injection rates will result in a proportional increase in background radiation levels and vice-versa. DFCS provides power input signals to systems (RWM, HWC, Recirc) via total steam flow and total feedwater flow.
HWC utilizes Feedwater flow from DFCS for power input Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because DFCS steam flow does provide power input to the RWM and is often confused with feedwater flow and increased production of Ammonia (NH3) is correct.
Choice B: Correct Answer Choice C: Plausible because DFCS steam flow does provide power input to the RWM and is often confused with feedwater flow and raising power with HWC in AUTO raises H2 injection rate which raises Ammonia (NH3) carryover. Increased Nitrates (N03) are removed by RWCU and do not cause TB rad levels to rise.
Choice D: Plausible because feedwater is correct and raising power with HWC in AUTO raises H2 injection rate which raises Ammonia (NH3) carryover. Increased Nitrates (NO3) are removed by RWCU and do not cause TB rad levels to rise.
SRO Only Basis: N/A
: 73. 02.03.15 001 Which one of the following identifies the current Drywell radiation level?
A. -2O RIh B 200 RIh C. 1000 RJh D. 10000 R/h
 
Feedback K/A: G2.03.15 Radiation Control Knowledge of radiation monitoring systems, such as fixed radiation monitors, portable survey instruments, personnel monitoring equipment, etc.
(CFR: 41.12/43.4/45.9)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.9/3.1 Objective:
CLS-LP-1 1.1 *03a Describe the function/operation of the following: Drywell High Range Radiation Monitors
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-I 1.1, Area Radiation Monitoring System, Section 2.5 Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
Drywell high range area monitors provide indications of gross fuel failure and are used to determine emergency plan emergency action level associated with abnormal core conditions. With the function switch in the E1-E4, meter readings are taken from the lower scale between 10- 10000 RJh. Current indication of 200 R/h Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible if function switch is not taken into account would be 20 R/h.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible if read directly off the upper scale Choice D: Plausible if read off the upper scale and adjusted by a factor of 10 for function switch position.
: 74. G2.04.01 002 Which one of the following radiation annunciators requires entry into RRCP?
A. RBCCW LIQUID PROCESS RAD HIGH B RXBLDG ROOF VENT RAD HIGH C. PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HIGH D. PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HI-HI Feedback K/A: G2.04.01 Emergency Procedures I Plan Knowledge of EOP entry conditions and immediate action steps.
(CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)
ROISRO Rating: 4.6/4.8 Objective: LOlCLSLP300N*002
: 2. Given plant conditions, determine if OEOP-04-RRCP should be entered.
 
==Reference:==
 
RRCP Cog Level: Low Explanation: Brunswick does not have any immediate operator actions in any EOP.
Annunciator requires immediate operator action of entry into RRCP. RRCP provides guidance to the operator for minimizing off-site radioactivity releases up to and including events involving substantial degradation of all of the fission product barriers (e.g., fuel, fuel clad, reactor vessel pressure boundary, primary containment, and secondary containment).
RRCP and SCCP are used concurrently to control releases from primary systems. This procedure controls non-primary system releases through actions incorporated in the non-PSTG legs of the procedure.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because SCCP entry would be appropriate.
Choice B: Correct Answer Choice C: Plausible because is easily confused with the roof vent alarm and is a SCCP entry condition.
Choice D: Plausible because this annunciator provides indication of Secondary Containment auto isolation setpoint and is easily confused with the roof vent alarm.
SRO Only Basis: N/A
: 75. G2.04.09 001 An ATWS has occurred on Unit One with the following plant conditions:
Reactor Water Level        130 inches (stable)
Injection Systems          CRD Reactor Power              APRM downscale lights are illuminated Control Rods              19 rods failed to insert SRVs                      All closed Reactor Pressure          920 psig and stable Suppression Pool Temp. 92&deg; F Which one of the following choices completes the statement below lAW LPC?
Reactor Recirculation pumps (1)      required to be tripped and the SLC Pumps (2) required to be started.
AY(1) are not (2) are not B. (1) are not (2) are C. (1) are (2) are not D. (1) are (2) are
 
Feedback K/A: G2.04.09 Emergency Procedures I Plan Knowledge of low power/shutdown implications in accident (e.g., loss of coolant accident or loss of residual heat removal) mitigation strategies.
(CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13) e.g. is an abbreviation for the latin phrase exempli gratia. When you mean that is use i.e. Since e.g.
indicates a partial list, it would be redundant to add etc. at the end of a list introduced by this abbreviation.
(from answerbag. corn) The recirc pumps and SLC pumps are used for mitigation of the A TWS.
RO/SRO Rating:
3.8/4.2 Objective:
CLSLP300E*01 7 Compare and contrast the operator actions for emergency depressurization with an ATWS condition present versus those with all control rods inserted.
 
==Reference:==
 
001-37.5 Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Reactor recirc pumps are evaluated during the ATWS and are tripped to reduce core flow thereby reducing reactor power. If power is less than 2% then tripping the pumps is not required. SLC is injected into the reactor to provide an alternate means of shutting down the reactor. It is required to be injected prior to exceeding 110&deg; F in the torus. With SRVs closed and temperature at 92 with no additional heat load to the torus SLC injection is not required.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation.
Choice B: Plausible because recirc pumps are not required to be shutdown is correct and if the torus was in jeopardy of reaching 110 then this would be correct.
Choice C: Plausible because if power was greater than 2% the recirc pumps are required to be shutdown is correct and the torus is not in jeopardy of reaching 110 so this is correct.
Choice D: Plausible because if power was above 2% and the torus temperature in danger of reaching 110 then these actions would be correct.
: 76. S204000 G2.0225 003 With Unit Two operating at power which one of the following choices completes the statements below lAW Technical Specification 3.6.1.3, Primary Containment Isolation Valves (PCIVs)?
If the G31-FOO1, RWCU Inlet Inboard Isolation Valve is inoperable, the line is required to be isolated in  (1)    and verify the affected penetration flow path is isolated once per 31 days.
This 31 day verification of the G31-F004, RWCU Inlet Outboard Isolation Valve, breaker and valve position    (2)
A. (1)2hours (2) may be accomplished remotely by Administrative means B (1)8 hours (2) may be accomplished remotely by Administrative means C. (1)2hours (2) must be accomplished by actual hands on verification at the components D. (1)8hours (2) must be accomplished by actual hands on verification at the components
 
Feedback KJA: 204000 G2.02.25 Knowledge of the bases in Technical Specifications for limiting conditions for operations and safety limits.
Reactor Water Cleanup System (CFR: 41.5 / 41.7/ 43.2)
There are no safety limits associated with RWCU system, so question is written directly to the TS.
RO/SRO Rating:
3.2/4.2 Objective:
CLS-LP-14, Obj. 13 Given plant conditions and Technical Specifications, including the Bases, TRM, ODCM, and COLR, determine the required action(s) to be taken in accordance with Technical Specifications associated with the RWCU system.
 
==Reference:==
 
Tech Spec 3.6.1.3 Primary Containment Isolation Valves (PCIV5)
Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
Tech Spec 3.6.1.3 PCIVs Condition A applies; Required Action A.1 must be completed within 8 hours; Required Action A.2 must be completed once per 31 days. Bases 3.6.1.3 allows completion of A.2 by administrative means for the given conditions.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because 2 hours is the required completion time for Required Action B.2 Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because 2 hours is the required completion time for Required Action B.2; plausible because hands on verification is required in areas other than high radiation areas Choice D: Plausible because hands on verification is required in areas other than high radiation areas SRO Basis:
10 CFR 55.43(b)-2, Facility operating limitations in the TS and their bases.
Knowledge of TS bases that is required to analyze TS required actions and terminology.
: 77. S212000 A2.12 002 Unit One is operating at full power when the following plant conditions occur:
        - Part time load shedding has been implemented
        - Load Reject Signal received
        - Line 31 (Whiteville Line) PCBs red lights are lit
        - Line 31 (Whiteville Line) white VOLT lights are not lit
        - All other line PCBs green lights are lit
        - 230 KV BUS IA BUS POT UNDER VOLTAGE is in alarm
        - 230 KV BUS lB BUS POT UNDER VOLTAGE is in alarm Which one of the following identifies the initial RPS trip signal and the procedure which contains the guidance to trip the Whiteville Line PCBs?
A. Turbine Control Valve Fast Closure; OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses.
B. Turbine Stop Valve Closure; OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses.
C. Turbine Control Valve Fast Closure; OAOP-22, Grid Instability.
D. Turbine Stop Valve Closure; OAOP-22, Grid Instability.
 
Feedback            -
K/A: 212000 A2.12 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the REACTOR PROTECTION SYSTEM ; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:
Main turbine stop control valve closure (C FR: 41.5 / 45.6)
ROISRO Rating:
4.0/4.1 Objective:
CLS-LP-03, Obj. 8.
List the RPS trip signals, including setpoints and how/when each signal is bypassed.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-03, Reactor Protection System AOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses Cog Level:
High Explanation:
A load reject signal at any reactor power level will cause a turbine control valve fast closure scram. The load reject signal does not input into the turbine stop valve closure scram logic. During a loss of offsite power, if the grid is lost all PCBs are opened per OAOP-36.1.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Incorrect Load reject initiates a TCV fast closure scram not a TSV. A misconception of the difference between TCV and TSV scrams may cause a student to select this answer.
Choice C: Incorrect. OAOP-22 does not have an action for loss of grid only for degraded conditions.
Choice D: Incorrect. Load reject initiates a TCV fast closure scram not a TSV. A misconception of the difference between TCV and TSV scrams may cause a student to select this answer.
OAOP-22 does not have an action for loss of grid only for degraded.
SRO Basis:
10 CFR 55.43(b)-5, Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.
: 78. S214000A2.03 00-I The Unit is at 30% power during reactor startup.
The operator withdraws control rod 26-27 to position 48.
The following indications are noted:
        - ROD DRIFT alarm seals in
        - ROD OVER TRAVEL alarm seals in
        -  Rod 26-27 full core display red light out Which one of the following identifies:
(1) the indication that would be displayed on the four-rod group display and (2) the minimum required action(s) for the inoperable control rod lAW Technical Specifications?
A. (1)48 (2) Fully insert control rod 26-27 and disarm the HCU B. (1)48 (2) Fully insert control rod 26-27 and disarm the HCU; verify >12 control rods are withdrawn and implement GP-1 1, Second Operator Rod Sequence Checkoff Sheets C (1) Blank (2) Fully insert control rod 26-27 and disarm the HCU D. (1) Blank (2) Fully insert control rod 26-27, disarm the HCU; verify >12 control rods are withdrawn, and implement GP-1 1, Second Operator Rod Sequence Checkoff Sheets
 
Feedback K/A: 214000 A2.03 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the ROD POSITION INFORMATION SYSTEM; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:
Overtravel/in-out (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.6/3.9 Objective:
CLS-LP-07 Obj 5b Given plant conditions, determine if the following conditions exist: Indications of an uncoupled control rod.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-07, Reactor Manual Control System Tech Spec 3.1.3, Control Rod Operability GP-1 1, Second Operator Rod Sequence Checkoff Sheets Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
If the control rod is in the overtravel out position, the corresponding digital indicator will be blank since the magnet will not be near any of the 00 to 48 reed switches. lAW TS the rod is declared inoperable then inserted to 00 (within 3 hours) and disarmed (within 4 hours). TS 3.1.6 if the RWM is inoperable then if
>12 control rods are withdrawn GP-1 1 would be implemented, unless the rod is at 00 and is not intended to be moved.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the full in and 00 indications are at the same point or the examinee may think that the rod may settle to the 48 position.
Choice B: Plausible because the full in and 00 indications are at the same point or the examinee may think that the rod may settle to the 48 position. These are TS actions for an inoperable RWM, not control rod.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation.
Choice D: Plausible because this is the correct indication but these are TS actions for an inoperable RWM, not control rod.
SRO Basis:
10 CFR 55.43(b)-2, Facility operating limitations in the technical specifications and their bases.
Application of required actions statements.
: 79. S217000 G2.04.08 002 Given the following ATWS conditions on Unit Two:
2A CRD Pump              Overcurrent trip 2B CRD Pump              Shaft uncoupled HPCI System              Under Clearance SLC                      Both squib valves failed to fire RCIC                      Running for LEP-03, Alternate Boron Injection, with an unisolable steam supply leak SRHR Equip Room            180&deg;F Suppression Pool Level    -24 inches Reactor Power            10%
Reactor Water Level      160 inches Which one of the following completes the statement below based on the conditions above?
The RCIC system must      (1)    which is required by    (2)
A. (1) be isolated (2) SCCP B. (1) be isolated (2) OAOP-05.0, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation, and Airborne Activity C (1) remain running (2) SCCP D. (1) remain running (2) OAOP-05.0, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation, and Airborne Activity
 
Feedback K/A: 217000 G2.04.08 Knowledge of how abnormal operating procedures are used in conjunction with EOPs.
Reactor Core Isolation Cooling System (RCIC)
(CFR: 41.10/43.5 /45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.8/4.5 Objective:
CLS-LP-300-B, Obj. 19 Given a situation where a conflict exists between AOP or ASSD requirements and EOP guidance, determine the correct operator action.
 
==Reference:==
 
AOP-05, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation and Airborne Activity SCCP Cog Level:
High Explanation:
EOP action that supercedes the AOP action is what the question is asking.
AOP-5 does have a step to isolate the system that is leaking, but SCCP overrides that if the system is required by EOPs. With the ATWS the RCIC system is required for alternate boron injection therefore should remain running per the direction from SCCP.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because SCCP/AOP-5 does have a step to isolate the system that is leaking and reasonable for the student to think this direction comes from SCCP.
Choice B: Plausible because SCCP/AOP-5 does have a step to isolate the system that is leaking Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible for student to think the direction to remain running comes from AOP-5.0.
SRO Basis:
10 CFR 55.43(b)-5, Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.
: 80. S233000 G2.04.06 001 Unit Two was operating at rated power with the following conditions:
        - A dual Unit Loss Of Offsite Power (LOOP)
        - Spent Fuel Pool level is lowering rapidly
      -  RRCP has been entered due to high rad conditions on the refuel floor Which one of the following is the first makeup source to be used for filling the fuel pool and identifies the procedure to perform the action?
A. Emergency Diesel Makeup Pump lAW OAOP-38.O, Loss of Fuel Pool Cooling B RHR B Loop lAW OAOP-38.O, Loss of Fuel Pool Cooling C. Emergency Diesel Makeup Pump lAW OEDMG-002, Spent Fuel Pool Makeup/Spray and Refuel Floor Enhanced Ventilation under Conditions of Extreme Damage D. RHR B Loop lAW OEDMG-002, Spent Fuel Pool Makeup/Spray and Refuel Floor Enhanced Ventilation under Conditions of Extreme Damage
 
Feedback K/A: 233000 G2.04.06 Knowledge of EOP mitigation strategies.
Fuel Pool Cooling and Clean-up (CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)
There are no direct EOP actions associated with FPC, a loss of level in the fuel pool will cause entry into RRCP which is an EOP. So these actions are mitigation strategies to RRCP.
RO/SRO Rating:
3.7/4.7 Objective:
CLS-LP-13, Obj.11 State the sources of makeup water for the Fuel Pool in order of preference.
 
==Reference:==
 
AOP-38.0, Loss of Fuel Pool Cooling EDMG-02, Spent Fuel Pool Makeup/Spray and Refuel Floor Enhanced Ventilation under Conditions of Extreme Damage Cog Level:
High Explanation:
The order of the makeup sources is from the normal fill, Demin water hose stations, Fire protection hose stations, demin water through RHR keepfill, and then other sources that are not service water. For a high capacity water source and the gates installed RHR Loop B would be used via the FPC system. With a LOOP the demin pumps have no power. If no other sources are available then the procedure has injection from the EDMP.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because although this is a makeup source it is not the preferred source (last resort per the procedure) and is performed per the EDMG procedures. Although upon entering the AOP there is a step to start lining this system up for injection because of the time required to get all of the hoses run in the procedure up to the fuel pool.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because although this is a makeup source it is not the preferred source (last resort per the procedure). Although upon entering the AOP there is a step to start lining this system up for injection because of the time required to get all of the hoses run in the procedure up to the fuel pool.
Choice D: Plausible because RHR is the high capacity source that will need to be used, but the EDMG procedure does not provide this guidance.
SRO Basis:
10 CFR 55.43(b)-5, Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.
: 81. S239002G2.02.25OfY2 With Unit Two at rated power, which one of the following identifies:
(1) the required number of SRVs with safety function operable lAW Technical Specification LCO 3.4.3, Safety/Relief Valves and (2) the overpressurization event that bounds this number of required operable SRVs lAW Technical Specification Bases 3.4.3, Safety/Relief Valves?
A. (1)9 (2) an ATWS with MSIV closure B (1) 10 (2) an ATWS with MSIV closure C. (1)9 (2) an MSIV closure with reactor scram D. (1)10 (2) an MSIV closure with reactor scram
 
Feedback                                        -                            -
KIA: 239002 G2.02.25 Knowledge of the bases in Technical Specifications for limiting conditions for operations and safety limits.
Safety Relief Valves (CFR: 41.5 /41.7 / 43.2)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.2/4.2 Objective:
CLS-LP-25, Obj. 10 Given plant conditions and TS, including the Bases, TRM, ODCM, and COLR determine the required actions to be taken in accordance with TS associated with the Reactor Recirculation System. (SRO only)
 
==Reference:==
 
TS 3.4.3 Safety/Relief Valves (SRV5) and bases document Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
TS 3.4.3 states 10 must be operational for the safety function, the bases states the reason, ATWS.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the bases states that 9 are required for the MSIV closure.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the bases states that 9 are required for the MSIV closure and the MSIV closure is not the binding failure mode.
Choice D: Plausible because 10 are required for the ATWS and the MSIV closure is not the binding failure mode.
SRO Basis:
10 CFR 55.43(b)-2, Facility operating limitations in the technical specifications and their bases.
This is knowledge of tech spec bases to determine the reason 10 are required.
: 82. S262002 G2.01.23 001 Both Units are operating at full power when the Main Stack Rad Monitor kst its normal power supply.
Which one of the following identifies the procedure that contains the steps to transfer the Main Stack Rad Monitor to its alternate power supply?
A. IOP-52, 120 Volt AC UPS, Emergency, and Conventional Electrical Systems Operating Procedure B 20P-52, 120 Volt AC UPS, Emergency, and Conventional Electrical Systems Operating Procedure C. 1APP UA-03 6-3, PROCESS SMPL OG VENT PIPE DNSC/INOP D. 2APP UA-03 6-3, PROCESS SMPL OG VENT PIPE DNSC/INOP
 
Feedback K/A: 262002 G2.01.23 Ability to perform specific system and integrated plant procedures during all modes of plant operation.
Uninterruptable Power Supply (A.C./D.C.)
(CFR: 41.10/43.5 / 45.2 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.3/4.2 Objective:
CLS-LP-11.0, 15a Given plant conditions and a trip or failure of one of the following Radiation Monitors, determine appropriate plant response and use procedures to determine the actions required to control and/or mitigate the consequences of the event: a. Main Stack.
 
==Reference:==
 
20P-52, Section 8.7 Stack Radiation Monitor UPS Power Supply Transfer Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
The normal power supply for the Main Stack Rad Monitor is from Unit Two. On a loss of power from the normal power supply the operators will need to transfer to the alternate power supply. This direction is only in the U2 procedure. There is no directions to perform this in the UI procedure or the APPs for either Unit.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible if the student wrongly believes the normal power supply is from Unit 1 rather than Unit 2.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation.
Choice C: Plausible because the downscale / mop annunciator will be actuated on a loss of power but the APPs do not address transfer of power to backup supply.
Choice D: Plausible because the downscale / mop annunciator will be actuated on a loss of power but the APPs do not address transfer of power to backup supply. U2 is the normal power supply to the rad monitor.
SRO Basis:
10 CFR 55.43(b)-5, Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.
: 83. S295006G 2.02.22 002 Following a reactor scram on Unit Two the following conditions exist:
0900 RHR Pump 2B tripped on overcurrent while placing Suppression Pool Cooling in service.
1100 The RSP is exited to OGP-05, Unit Shutdown, while in Mode 3.
Which one of the following completes the statement below?
The Technical Specification 3.5.1, ECCS Operating, LCO Action Statement is required to be entered at (1)    lAW OEOP.-01-UG, Users Guide.
RHR Loop B Operability is required to be restored within  (2)  lAW Tech Spec 3.5.1, ECCS Operating.
A. (1)0900 (2) 7 days Bb (1) 1100 (2) 7 days C. (1)0900 (2)l4days D. (1)1100 (2)l4days
 
Feedback KIA: S295006G 2.02.22 Knowledge of limiting conditions for operations and safety limits.
SCRAM (CFR: 41.5 / 43.2 /45.2)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.0/4.7 Objective:
CLSLP30OC*1 1 Given plant conditions, the Unit Shutdown Procedure (GP-05), and the Reactor Scram Procedure, determine if conditions allow exiting the Reactor Scram Procedure.
 
==Reference:==
 
OEOP-O1-UG, Revision 55, Page 31, Section 3.5 Tech Spec 3.5.1, ECCS Operating Cog Level:
High Explanation:
The EOPs authorize actions outside of technical specifications to mitigate the consequences of an emergency condition. The EOPs also provide for returning the system or component to service. If the system or component is not returned to its standby or operable condition prior to exiting the EOPs, then the appropriate limiting condition of operation shall be implemented in accordance with Technical Specifications. The starting time for the limiting condition of operation is the time that the EOPs were exited.
In order to exit EOP, compatibility with GP-05 along with active LCOs need to be implemented. RHR Pump 2B tripping on overcurrent requires declaring RHR Loop B Inoperable for LPCI (Modes 1,2 &3), TS 3.5.1 Condition A (Al )requires Restore low pressure ECCS injection/spray subsystem to OPERABLE status within 7 days.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because LCO start time is wrong (time occurred while executing EOP5) and 7 days is correct.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because LCO start time is wrong (time occurred while executing EOPs) and 14 days is wrong completion time (would be correct for HPCI within the same TS)
Choice D: Plausible because LCO start time is correct and 14 days is wrong completion time (would be correct for HPCI within the same TS)
SRO Basis:
Requires knowledge of EOP bases and greater than 1 hour TS completion times
: 84. soa A205 002 Following a scram on Unit Two, which one of the following identifies:
(1) the response of reactor water level when an SRV is opened and (2) the procedure that contains the following decision step?
CAN RETOR WA1R LEVEL BE UAJNTMNED    >
LESSTHANMSL    _-
A. (1)Shrink (2) RSP B. (1) Shrink (2) RVCP C (1)Swell (2) RSP D. (1)Swell (2) RVCP
 
Feedback K/A: 295008 A2.05 Ability to determine andlor interpret the following as they apply to HIGH REACTOR WATER LEVEL:
Swell (CFR: 41.10 / 43.5 / 45.13)
ROISRO Rating:
2.9/3.1 Objective:
CLS-LP-300-C, Obj.1 0 Given plant conditions and the RSP, determine the required operator actions.
 
==Reference:==
 
RSP RVCP 001-37.3, Reactor Scram Procedure Basis Document 001-37.4, Reactor Vessel Control Procedure Basis Document Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Opening of the SRV will cause the reactor water level to swell up due to the reduction in pressure in the vessel. The given decision block is from the RSP.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible if the examinee thinks that opening the SRV would reduce the water volume in the RPV.
Choice B: Plausible if the examinee thinks that opening the SRV would reduce the water volume in the RPV and that the given decision step is applicable to the level leg of RVCP.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because examinee may think that the given decision step is applicable to the level leg of RVCP.
SRO Basis:
10 CFR 55.43(b)-5, Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.
: 85. S295014G2.0I.25 001 Unit Two is operating at 74% power with the Feedwater Temperature at 405&deg;F.
The FW-V120, FW HTRS 4 & 5 BYP VLV, is inadvertently opened by mechanics.
The valve is bound in mid position and cannot be reclosed.
Conditions are now stable with reactor power at 81 % and Feedwater Temperature at 306&deg;F.
(Reference provided)
Which one of the following identifies whether continued operation is allowed including the required actions or procedures?
Continued operation:
A is not allowed and a reactor shutdown per OGP-05, Unit Shutdown, is required lAW 20P-32, Condensate and Feedwater System Operating Procedure.
B. is not allowed and a reactor shutdown per OGP-05, Unit Shutdown, is required lAW TS 3.1.2, Reactivity Anomalies.
C. is allowed provided that OGP-1 3, Increasing Unit Capacity At End Of Core Cycle, is implemented.
D. is allowed provided that the FWTR Power to Flow Map is implemented.
 
Feedback K/A: 295014 G2.01.25 Ability to interpret reference materials, such as graphs, curves, tables, etc.
Inadvertent Reactivity Addition (CFR: 41.10 / 43.5 / 45.12)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.9/4.2 Objective:
CLS-LP-34, Obj.1 ic Given plant conditions, describe the effect a loss/malfunction of the feedwater heaters will have on:
Feedwater Temperature
 
==Reference:==
 
20P-32, Attachment 4 (provided)
Cog Level:
High Explanation:
From Attachment 4 of 2OP-32 operation is outside of the allowable range (<110.3&deg;F) therefore not allowed and will require a Unit shutdown lAW GP-05 per the direction of 20P-32.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because the examinee may believe that the direction to shutdown is driven from Tech Spec 3.1.2, Reactor Anomalies Choice C: Plausible because the examinee could wrongly apply the direction of GP-1 3.
Choice D: Plausible because the examinee could believe that the use of the FWTR Power to Flow Map is applicable for the given situation.
SRO Basis:
Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations (43(b)(5) a. Assessement of the plant conditions and then prescribing the shutdown lAW the GP.
: 86. S295021 A2.03 002 While in Mode 4 a loss of Shutdown Cooling (S DC) occurs.
Which one of the following completes both statements?
The minimum required Reactor Water Level to support Natural Circulation is      (1) inches.
An Alert declaration is first required after an unplanned RPV pressure increase greater than    (2) psig due to a loss of RCS cooling.
A. (1) 200 (2) 135 B(1) 200 (2)10 C. (1) 254 (2) 135 D. (1) 254 (2) 10
 
Feedback                                              -
K/A: S295021 A2.03 Ability to determine and/or interpret the following as they apply to LOSS OF SHUTDOWN COOLING:
Reactor water level (CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.5/3.5 Objective:
CLS-LP-1 20*06 Describe how to determine when natural circulation exists within the Reactor Vessel.
 
==Reference:==
 
OAOP-15, Loss of Shutdown Cooling OPEP-2.1, EAL Flowcharts Cog Level:
High Explanation:
During conditions in which there is no circulation, the reactor vessel water level, as read on B21-LI-R605A(B), should be maintained between 200 and 220, or as directed by the Shift Superintendent based on plant conditions, until forced circulation is restored.
lAW PEP-2.1, Section CA3 Inability to Maintain Plant in Cold Shutdown an unplanned reactor pressure increase of >10 psig due to a loss of SDC requires an ALERT declaration.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because 135 psig reactor pressure is a setpoint associated with SDC that could be confused with the correct answer.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because 254 inches is the level of the MSLs and could be confused with Natural Circulation level due to the requirement to be at this level during alternate SDC.
Plausible because 135 psig reactor pressure is a setpoint associated with SDC that could be confused with the correct answer.
Choice D: Plausible because 254 inches is the level of the MSLs and could be confused with Natural Circulation level due to the requirement to be at this level during alternate SDC SRO Only Basis:
Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations (43(b)(5)a.
Requires assessing plant conditions (LOOP, Mode 3, power availability, impact of power losses) and prescribing correct section of a procedure to provide DHR.
: 87. S295023G 2.04.49 001 While performing refueling activities on Unit Two, a spent fuel bundle was dropped and the following alarms were received:
AREA RAD REFUEL FLOOR HIGH PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HIGH Which one of the following identifies:
(1) the required immediate operator action and (2) the bases for the performance of this action lAW OAOP-05.O Radioactive Spills, High Radiation and Airborne Activity, and Technical Specifications Bases?
A. (1) Manually start Standby Gas Treatment (SBGT)
(2) Ensures control room operators will not exceed 2 Rem TEDE B. (1) Manually start Standby Gas Treatment (SBGT)
(2) Ensures control room operators will not exceed 5 Rem TEDE C. (1) Manually start Control Room Emergency Ventilation (CREV)
(2) Ensures control room operators will not exceed 2 Rem TEDE D (1) Manually start Control Room Emergency Ventilation (CREV)
(2) Ensures control room operators will not exceed 5 Rem TEDE
 
Feedback K/A: S295023G 2.04.49 Ability to perform without reference to procedures those actions that require immediate operation of system components and controls.
Refueling Accidents (CFR: 41.10 / 43.2/45.6)
ROISRO Rating:
4.6/4.4 Objective:
CLSLP302J*02 Given plant conditions with spent fuel damage and a high airborne activity problem in progress, determine if the appropriate automatic actions have occurred in accordance with OAOP-5.0, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation, and Airborne Activity.
 
==Reference:==
 
AOP-05, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation and Airborne Activity Cog Level:
High Explanation:
OAOP-05 immediate action for a dropped or damaged fuel assembly is to ENSURE CREVS is in operation.
The dose consequence calculation for the fuel handling accident does not credit the secondary containment or automatic CREVS start, however, it does assume that CREVS is manually initiated within 20 minutes of a dropped/damaged fuel assembly. Based on this analysis, Technical Specifications do not require secondary containment or CREVS automatic initiation instrumentation except during Modes 1, 2, or 3 or during operations with the potential to drain the Reactor vessel. The CREV System is designed to maintain a habitable environment in the CRE for a 30 day continuous occupancy after a DBA without exceeding 5 rem total effective dose equivalent (TEDE).
Knowledge of DBA analysis initial conditions.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HIGH annunciator is easily confused with the auto start for SBGT verifying Auto actions can be confused with Immediate Actions. SBGT start is a supplemental action which will reduce control room dose and 2 Rem TEDE is a site administrative dose limit and can be confused with the actual Dose Analysis from FHA of 2.69 rem TEDE.
Choice B: Plausible because PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HIGH annunciator is easily confused with the auto start for SBGT verifying Auto actions can be confused with Immediate Actions. SBGT start is a supplemental action which will reduce control room dose and 5 Rem TEDE is correct.
Choice C: Plausible because CREV is correct and 2 Rem TEDE is a site administrative dose limit and can be confused with the actual Dose Analysis from FHA of 2.69 rem TEDE.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation SRO Only Basis:
Conditions and limitations in the facility license (43(b)(1)
 
SB. S295026 A2.03 001 An event on Unit One has resulted in the following plant conditions:
Reactor pressure                  1000 psig Reactor Water Level                120 inches Control Rod Positions              All unknown APRMs                              Downscale Drywell pressure                  3 psig Supp. Pool pressure                2 psig Supp. Pool water temp              1500 F Supp. Pool water level            -4 feet (Reference provided)
Which one of the following identifies the status of the Heat Capacity Temperature Limit (HCTL) and the required procedure for reactor pressure control?
HCTL                              Pressure Control Leg of Procedure A. has been exceeded                                          RVCP B has been exceeded                                          LPC C. has NOT been exceeded                                      RVCP D. has NOT been exceeded                                      LPC
 
Feedback K/A: S295026A2.03 Ability to determine andlor interpret the following as they apply to SUPPRESSION POOL HIGH WATER TEMPERATURE:
Reactor pressure (CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.9/4.0 Objective:
CLSLP300L*05a Given the PCCP, determine the appropriate actions if any of the following limits are approached or exceeded: Heat Capacity Temperature Limit
 
==Reference:==
 
Heat Capacity Temperature Graph only is given to examinee PCCP.
Cog Level:
High Previous Exam  - 11/08 Brunswick Explanation:
HCTL has been exceeded. With rods unknown the operator would be in LPC.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because rods are unknown, would be in LPC.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because HCTL has been exceeded. rods are unknown, would be in LPC Choice D: Plausible because HCTL has been exceeded.
SRO Basis:
Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations (43(b)(5)
 
8-9. S29502&A205001 Unit Two is operating at rated power when half of the Drywell (DW) Coolers are lost.
Which one of the following completes the statements below?
(Assume initial DW and Suppression Pool pressures are equal)
Suppression Pool pressure will rise at    (1)  DW pressure.
If DW Average Air Temperature is not restored to within the LCO limit in    (2) hours, the Unit is required to be in Mode 3 within the following 12 hours per TS 3.6.1.4 (Drywell Air Temperature).
A. (1) the same rate as (2) 8 B. (1) the same rate as (2) 12 C (1) a slower rate than (2) 8 D. (1) aslowerrate than (2) 12
 
Feedback K/A: S295028A2.05 Ability to determine and/or interpret the following as they apply to HIGH DRYWELL TEMPERATURE:
Torus/suppression chamber pressure: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.10 / 43.5 /45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.6/3.8 Objective:
CLSLP004A* I 5a Given plant conditions, determine the effects that the following will have on the Primary Containment, Primary Containment Ventilation and Primary Containment Monitoring: Loss of Drywell cooling.
 
==Reference:==
 
SD-04, Primary Containment Tech Spec 3.6.1.4, Drywell Air Temperature Cog Level:
High Explanation:Reduced DW cooling or rising DW temperature results in DW pressure increases whose severity is dependent upon plant conditions. OAOP-14.0, Abnormal Primary Containment Conditions provides guidance on indications to be monitored and actions to be taken which include verification of cooling system lineups and reductions in power to maintain average temperature below 150&deg;F. Failure to accomplish this may require entry into the OEOP-02-PCCP Primary Containment Control.
Elevated DW temperature causes DW pressure to rise. As DW pressure rises, SP water level rises causing a rise in SP pressure. Due to the downcomers extending 3 feet below the surface of the SP water level a differential pressure will always exist. Temperature response is different from LOCA response due to steam AND non-condensibles being forced into the SP steam condensing and non-condensibles collecting in SP air space.
TS 3.6.1.4 (DW Air Temperature) limit of< 150&deg;F, CONDITION A Drywell average air temperature not within limit, REQUIRED ACTION A.1 Restore drywell average air temperature to within limit has a COMPLETION TIME of 8 hours. If temperature is not restored to    < 150&deg;F, CONDITION B, REQUIRED ACTION B.1 Be in MODE 3 has a COMPLETION TIME of 12 hours.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because SP pressure is changed by the change in SP level only vs pressure, steam, and non-condensibles during a LOCA. The SP air space temperature is in equilibrium with SP water temperature (95&deg;Fmax during normal operations) rising DW pressure would have a direct impact on SP level. However during temperature only (no steam), the DW pressure increase is cushioned by SP water, small changes in SP water level provides small change in SP pressure. 8 hours to restore temperature is correct.
Choice B: Plausible because SP pressure is changed by the change in SP level only vs pressure, steam, and non-condensibles during a LOCA. The SP air space temperature is in equilibrium with SP water temperature (95&deg;Fmax during normal operations) rising DW pressure would have a direct impact on SP level. However during temperature only (no steam), the DW pressure increase is cushioned by SP water, small changes in SP water level provides small change in SP pressure. 12 hours is the time required to get to MODE 3 if not restored within the required Completion Time.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because rising at a slower rate is correct and 12 hours is the time required to get to MODE 3 if not restored within the required Completion Time.
SRO Basis:
Application of required actions (Section 3) and surveillance requirements (Section 4) in accordance with rules of application requirements (Section 1). (43(b)(2)
: 90. 8295029 &2.01 .07 002 The following plant conditions exist on Unit Two:
        - An ATWS with a spurious Group I Isolation has occurred
        - HPCI is injecting to the RPV to maintain RPV level
        - SUPPRESSION CHAMBER LVL HI-HI is in alarm Which one of the following identifies:
(1) the reason that HPCI is re-aligned from its current suction source and (2) the procedure that contains the steps to perform the actions to transfer the HPCI suction valves?
A. (I) To prevent pump bearing damage (2) 20P-19, High Pressure Coolant Injection System Operating Procedure B (1) To prevent pump bearing damage (2) SEP-10, Circuit Alteration Procedure C. (1) To prevent HPCI exhaust check valve damage (2) 20P-19, High Pressure Coolant Injection System Operating Procedure D. (I) To prevent HPCI exhaust check valve damage (2) SEP-I 0, Circuit Alteration Procedure
 
Feedback K/A: 295029 G2.01.07 Ability to evaluate plant performance and make operational judgments based on operating characteristics, reactor behavior, and instrument interpretation.
High Suppression Pool Water Level (CFR: 41.5 / 43.5 / 45.12 /45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.4/4.7 Objective:
CLS-LP-019-A, Obj. 26g:
Given plant conditions and one of the following events, use plant procedures to determine the actions required to control and/or mitigate the consequences of the event: High Suppression Pool water level
 
==Reference:==
 
20P-19, HPCI System Operating Procedure 001-37.5, Level/Power Control Procedure Basis Document SUPPRESSION CHAMBER LVL HI-HI APP Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Very high lube oil temperatures can result in loss of lubricating qualities in the oil and thus cause damage to the bearings. Suction for HPCI and RCIC is aligned to the Condensate Storage Tank (CST) if it is available. The HPCI automatic suction transfer logic can be defeated to allow this lineup if necessary provided suppression pool temperature is approaching 140&deg;F. Step RC/L-25 of LPC directs maintaining reactor water level with the systems listed in Table 1. HPCI with suction from CST if available is listed in Table I with the direction to defeat the Defeat HPCI Hi Suppression Pool level Suction Transfer if necessary per SEP-10.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because 20P-19 contains direction for transferring the HPCI suction from the torus to the CST. (Section 8.9)
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because RC/L-20 references potential HPCI equipment damage which could be interpreted as exhaust check valve damage. 20P-19 contains direction for transferring the HPCI suction from the torus to the CST. (Section 8.9)
Choice D: Plausible because RC/L-20 references potential HPCI equipment damage which could be interpreted as exhaust check valve damage.
SRO Basis:
10 CFR 55.43(b)-S Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.
: 91. S295038G 2.0242 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power when both SJAE Offgas Radiation monitor readings increase by 50% over their previous value.
Which one of the following completes the statement below?
lAW (1) surveillance requirements, the SJAE release rate must be confirmed within the limits within (2)
A. (1) ODCM 7.3.2, Radioactive Gaseous Effluent Monitoring Instrumentation (2) 4 hours B. (1) ODCM 7.3.2, Radioactive Gaseous Effluent Monitoring Instrumentation (2) 12 hours C (1) Technical Specification 3.7.5, Main Condenser Offgas (2) 4 hours D. (1) Technical Specification 3.7.5, Main Condenser Offgas (2) 12 hours
 
Feedback K/A: S295038G 2.02.42 Ability to recognize system parameters that are entry-level conditions for Technical Specifications.
High Off-Site Release Rate (CFR: 41.7 /41.10 /43.2 / 43.3 / 45.3)
ROISRO Rating:
3.9/4.6 Objective:
CLSLP3O*08 Given plant conditions and Technical Specifications, including the Bases, TRM, ODCM, and COLR, determine whether given plant conditions meet minimum Technical Specifications, TRM, or ODCM requirements associated with the Condenser Air Removal/Augmented Offgas System.
 
==Reference:==
 
101-03.1, Revision 10, Page 44, Item #57 (CODSR)
Cog Level:
High Explanation:
NOTIFY E&RC to confirm release rate is within limits within 4 hours following a monitor reading increase of greater than or equal to 50% without an accompanying increase in thermal power. SR 3.7.5.1 Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because the SJAE Rad Monitor operability is required by ODCM 7.3.2 and 4 hours is correct.
Choice B: Plausible because the SJAE Rad Monitor operability is required by ODCM 7.3.2 and 12 hours is a timeframe for another Required Action in this spec.
Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because TS 3.7.5 is correct and 12 hours is a timeframe for another Required Action in this spec.
SRO Basis:
Application of Surveillance Requirements and timeframe greater than 1 hour.
: 92. S300000A2.01 001 The following plant conditions exist on Unit Two due to a malfunction of the Air Dryer:
        - SERVICE AIR PRESS-LOW is in alarm
        - RB INSTR AIR RECEIVER 2A PRESS LOW is in alarm
        - RB INSTR AIR RECEIVER 2B PRESS LOW is in alarm
        - Instrument Air pressure is 93 psig and recovering Based on the above indications, which one of the following identifies:
(1) the status of the Service Air Dryer Bypass Valve, SA-PV-5067, and (2) the procedure that contains the steps to close the Reactor Building Inboard and Outboard Isolation Valves (BFIVs)?
A(1) open (2) OAOP-20.O, Pneumatic (Air/Nitrogen) System Failures B. (1) open (2) 2APP-UA-O1, Se,vice Air Press-Low C. (1) closed (2) OAOP-20.O, Pneumatic (Air/Nitrogen) System Failures D. (1) closed (2) 2APP-UA-O1, Service Air Press-Low
 
Feeilback K/A: 300000 A2.01 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the INSTRUMENT AIR SYSTEM and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal operation:
Air dryer and filter malfunctions (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.9/2.8 Objective:
CLS-LP-46, 07i:
Given plant conditions, determine if the following automatic actions should occur: Air Dryer is bypassed.
 
==Reference:==
 
RB INSTR AIR RECEIVER 2B PRESS LOW(UA-01 1-2)
SERWCE AIR PRESS LOW(UA-01 5-4)
OAOP-20, Pneumatic (Air/Nitrogen) System Failures Cog Level:
High Explanation:
The air dryer malfunction has caused air pressure to lower. The Service Air low pressure alarms comes in at 107 psig. At 105# decreasing the Service Air system isolates, thus the 0 psig indication on Service Air.
The alarms for the receivers low pressure come in at 95# and are located in the Reactor Building. With these alarms in the operators are required to close the BFIVs while there is still sufficient air pressure remaining to make the secondary containment isolation valves close in accordance with the AOP supplemental actions.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because the air dryer bypass valve is open, but the guidance for closure of the BFIVs is contained in the AOP or RB INSTR AIR RECEIVER 2A(B) PRESS LOW APP.
Choice C: Plausible because the AOP is the correct procedure for closure of the BFIVs, but the air dryer bypass valve would be open (requires system knowledge to know the setpoint for the bypass opening).
Choice D: Plausible because the student may not know the setpoint of the bypass valve opening and the guidance for closure of the BFIVs is contained in the AOP or RB INSTR AIR RECEIVER 2A(B)
PRESS LOWAPP.
SRO Basis:
10 CFR 55.43(b)-5 Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.
The first part of the question is RO knowledge (setpoint for the auto opening of the air dryer bypass valve the second part is Assessing plant conditions (normal, abnormal, or emergency) and then prescribing a procedure to mitigate, recover, or with which to proceed.
: 93. S600000G 2.02.37 002 Unit Two is operating at rated power when a fire in the Unit Two Reactor Building 20 North is confirmed.
Which one of the following identifies the impact on safety related equipment and the procedure(s) required to be entered under the above plant conditions?
A fire on the Unit Two Reactor Building 20 North will impact    (1)  Availability.
The Unit CRS is required to enter (2)
A. (1) RHRL0opA (2) OPFP-013, General Fire Plan, only B(1) RHRL00pA (2) OPFP-013, General Fire Plan, and OASSD-01, Alternative Safe Shutdown Procedure Index C. (1) RHRLoopB (2) OPFP-013, General Fire Plan, only D. (1) RHRL00pB (2) OPFP-013, General Fire Plan, and OASSD-01, Alternative Safe Shutdown Procedure Index
 
Feedback K/A: S600000G 2.02.37 Ability to determine operability andlor availability of safety related equipment.
Plant Fire On Site (CFR: 41.7 / 43.5/45.12)
ROISRO Rating:
3.6/4.6 Objective:
 
==Reference:==
 
OAP-025, BNP Integrated Scheduling, Section 3.1 Cog Level:
High Explanation:
2PFP-RB identifies safety related electrical equipment by red or green color coding. (Div I or II respectively) The north side of Unit 2 RB 20 has Div I related MOOs identified which provide power to RHR system motor operated valves. There are no Div II designated MCCs identifies for the same location. of PFP-013 Senior Control Operator Fire Actions directs the SCO to enter PFP-013 and ASSD-01.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because RHR Loop A is correct and OPFP-013 directs entry into both PFP-013 and ASSD-01.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because RHR Loop B can be impacted bya fire in RB South and OPFP-013 directs entry into both PFP-013 and ASSD-01.
Choice D: Plausible because RHR Loop B can be impacted by a fire in RB South and part 2 is correct.
SRO Basis:
Knowledge of administrative procedures that specify implementation, and/or coordination of plant normal procedures.
: 94. soioi.oooi Which one of the following choices completes the statement below?
If the ASSD staffing composition is less than the minimum required, establish an    (1)    lAW (2)
A (1) ASSD Impairment (2) OPLP-1 .5, Alternative Shutdown Capability Controls B. (1) LCO for T.S. 5.2.2, Facility Staff Organization, (2) OPLP-1 .5, Alternative Shutdown Capability Controls C. (1) ASSD Impairment (2) 001-01 .01, BNP Conduct of Operations Supplement D. (1) LCO for T.S. 5.2.2, Facility Staff Organization, (2) 001-01.01, BNP Conduct of Operations Supplement
 
Feedback K/A: SG2.01.05 Conduct of Operations Ability to use procedures related to shift staffing, such as minimum crew complement, overtime limitations, etc.
(CFR: 41.10 / 43.5 /4512)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.9/3.9 Objective:
CLSLP304M*1 3m Given ASSD procedures and plant conditions that require use of ASSD procedures, determine the following: The manpower required to support the ASSD actions.
 
==Reference:==
 
ASSD-00, ASSD Users Guide, Section 5.3.3 Cog Level:
Low Explanation:
The ASSD staffing composition may be less than the minimum requirements for a period of time not to exceed two hours in order to accommodate unexpected absence of on-duty shift crew members provided immediate action is taken to restore requirements to within the minimum requirements of the shift ASSD staffing. If the ASSD staffing composition is less than the minimum required, establish an Alternative Safe Shutdown Impairment in accordance with OPLP-1 .5, Alternative Shutdown Capability Controls, and OFPP-020, Impairment Notification.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because an impairment is the same as LCO (001-01.01) but impairments are not established against TS 5.2.2 and ASSD User Guide is correct.
Choice C: Plausible because ASSD impairment is correct and 001-01.01 provides staffing requirements for TS 5.2.2 but directs use of OASSD-00 procedure use for required staffing.
Choice D: Plausible because Plausible because an impairment is the same as LCO (001-01.01) but impairments are not established against TS 5.2.2 and 001-01.01 provides staffing requirements for TS 5.2.2 but directs use of OASSD-00 procedure use for required staffing.
SRO Basis:
Requires knowledge of TS 5.2.2 Facility Staff Organization and prescribes the procedure required for guidance during periods of ASSD minimum complement not maintained.
: 95. SG2.0 1.42 001 Which one of the following core loading sequences establishes a neutronic bridge as described in OFH-11?
Four fuel bundles are loaded around    (1)  then fuel is loaded in all fuel cells in a line between SRMs      (2)
A. (1) SRMs A and D only (2) A and D B. (1) SRMs B and D only (2) B and D C. (1) eachofthefourSRMs (2) A and D D. (1) each of the four SRMs (2) B and D
 
Feedback K/A: SG2.0l.42 Conduct of Operations Knowledge of new and spent fuel movement procedures.
(CFR: 41.10/43.7/45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
2.5/3.4 Objective:
 
==Reference:==
 
OFH-1 1, Refueling, Section 4.37 Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Provide ENP-24-12, Figure 1 as a reference From FH-1 1, 4.37 To help ensure that an unmonitored criticality will not occur, control rod withdrawal is not allowed during the core reload sequence until a neutronic bridge is established. The neutronic bridge ensures that two SRMs are neutronically coupled, thus monitoring the loaded area of the core. The reload sequence has three basic steps. Four fuel bundles are loaded around each of the four SRMs, the neutronic bridge is established and a spiral reload of the other fuel bundles completes the sequence. The neutronic bridge is established by loading fuel in all fuel cells in a line between two SRMs. These SRMs must be on opposite sides of the core and the line of loaded fuel cells must intersect the center of the core (A to D would not intersect the center, B to D would).
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because loading fuel around 2 SRMs and a line between them would establish a neutron bridge (between those 2 SRM5) but not lAW OFH-1 1 and A&D are adjacent.
Choice B: Plausible because loading fuel around 2 SRMs and a line between them would establish a neutron bridge (between those 2 SRM5) but not lAW OFH-1 1 and A&D are adjacent.
Choice C: Plausible because loading fuel around all SRMs is correct but A&D are adjacent.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation SRO Basis:
IOCFR55.43.6 Procedures and limitations involved in initial core loading, alterations in core configuration, control rod programming, and determination of various internal and external effects on core reactivity.
10CFR55.43.7 Fuel handling facilities and procedures.
: 96. SG2.02.15 001 With Unit Two operating at power, Annunciator RCIC TURBINE STM LINE DRN POT LEVEL HI alarms and the RO observes the E51-F054, F025, & F026 indications on Panel P601 are green and the valves cannot be re-opened.
Which one of the following completes the statements below?
(Reference provided)
These valves are closed due to loss of (1)
After 5 minutes the appropriate actions in the annunciator procedure have been taken and the system (2)
A. (1) pneumatics (2) remains Operable B (1) pneumatics (2) is Inoperable C. (1) DC Power (2) remains Operable D. (1) DC Power (2) is Inoperable
 
Feedback KJA: SG2.02.15 EQUIPMENT CONTROL Ability to determine the expected plant configuration using design and configuration control documentation, such as drawings, line-ups, tag-outs, etc.
(CFR: 41.10 /43.3 /45.13)
ROISRO Rating:
3.9/4.3 Objective:
CLS-LP-01 6*1 5e Given plant conditions, predict the RCIC System response to the following conditions: DC power failure.
 
==Reference:==
 
2APP A-03 3-5, Page 44 Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Valves fail closed on loss of DC power or Pneumatics, however with a loss of power, position indication on P601 will also be lost. Per APP A-03, 3-5 If either E51-F025 or E51-F026 has been failed closed for more than 5 minutes, perform the following:
: a. Close Turbine Trip and Throttle Valve, E51-V8, to prevent water hammer damage from a RCIC auto start.
: b. If RCIC must be started, proceed to OP-16.
this would still make RCIC available for use per the procedure but it is inoperable because it will not auto start as required.
This will make the RCIC system inoperable but available to be restarted per the procedure.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because loss of pneumatics only is correct and the system will not start in auto when required, but could be manually started.
Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because a loss of power will cause valves to fail closed, but with loss of power position indication will be lost and the system will not start in auto when required.
Choice D: Plausible because pneumatics and power will cause valves to fail closed, but with loss of power position indication will be lost and it is available to start per the procedure which makes it available.
SRO Basis:
Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, emergency conditions.
: 97. SG2.02.22 002 Unit One is operating at 88% power with the following conditions:
Jet Pump Flow Loop A (B21-R61 IA)      29 Mlbs/hr Jet Pump Flow Loop B (B21-R611B)      33 Mlbs/hr Total Core Flow (UICPWTCF)            62 Mlbs/hr Which one of the following completes the statements below lAW T.S. 3.4.1, Recirculation Loops Operating, and Bases?
The current Jet Pump Flow Mismatch      (1)
When Jet Pump Flows are not matched within limits, then the ioop with the (2) must be considered not in operation.
A. (I) is within limits (2) lower flow B. (1) is within limits (2) higher flow Cv (1) is not within limits (2) lower flow D. (I) is not within limits (2) higher flow
 
Feedback K/A: SG2.02.22 Equipment Control Knowledge of limiting conditions for operations and safety limits.
(CFR: 41.5 /43.2/45.2)
RO/SRO Rating:
4.0/4.7 Objective:
CLSLPO02*34 Given plant conditions and Technical Specifications, including the Bases, TRM, ODCM, and COLR determine the required action(s) to be taken in accordance with Technical Specifications associated with the Reactor Recirculation System. (SRO/STA only)
 
==Reference:==
 
Unit 1 Tech Spec 3.4.1, Recirculation Loops Operating and BASES Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Two recirculation loops are normally required to be in operation with their flows matched within the limits specified in SR 3.4.1.1 to ensure that that during a LOCA caused by a break of the piping of one recirculation loop the assumptions of the LOCA analysis are satisfied.
Jet pump loop flow mismatch should be maintained within the following limits:
  - jet pump loop flows within 10% (maximum indicated difference 7.5 xl 0 lbs/hr) with total core flow less than 58 x10 lbs/hr
  - jet pump loop flows within 5% (maximum indicated difference 3.5 xl 06 lbs/hr) with total core flow greater than or equal to 58 x10 6 lbs/hr Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because flow mismatch is within limits for lower reactor power level.
Choice B: Plausible because flow mismatch is within limits for lower reactor power level and because the belief that the higher flow loop will experience excessive vibration could cause them to select the higher flow response Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because the belief that the higher flow loop will experience excessive vibration could cause them to select the higher flow response SRO Basis:
Application of Required Actions and Knowledge of TS Bases.
 
98.-sG2.3.11 001 Following a small steam line break in the drywell plant conditions are as follows:
Drywell pressure:                  20 psig and rising Drywell Temperature:                305&deg;F Drywell hydrogen:                  1.8%
Suppression Chamber hydrogen:      1 .5%
Suppression Chamber level:          +5 inches Which one of the following identifies the procedure required lAW PCCP?
A. SEP-01 Section 1, Venting Primary Containment Irrespective of Off Site Release rate B SEP-01, Section 2, Venting Primary Containment via the Suppression Chamber within Site Release Rate Limit C. SEP-01, Section 3, Venting Primary Containment via the Drywell within Site Release Rate Limit D. OEDMG-003, Containment Venting Under Conditions of Extreme Damage Irrespective of Off Site Release Rates
 
Feedback K/A: SG2.03.ll Radiation Control Ability to control radiation releases.
(CFR: 41.11 /43.4/45.10)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.8/4.3 Objective:
CLSLP300L*08d Given the Primary Containment Control Procedure and plant conditions, determine if the following actions are required: Venting the primary containment IRRESPECTIVE of radioactivity release rate limits
 
==Reference:==
 
001-37.8, Primary Containment Control Procedure Basis Document Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Following the H2 leg of the PCCP with the given conditions will drive you to step PC/H-14 which directs you to Vent the Suppression Chamber per Section 2 of Primary Containment Venting (EOP-0 1-SEP-01)
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible if examinee determines that PCPL-A is being challenged out of the pressure leg of the PCCP Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible if examinee determines that the appropriate vent path is from the drywell vs. the suppression chamber.
Choice D: Plausible because EDMG-03 provides alternative venting strategies which may be directed from SEP-01 in needed.
SRO Basis:
Detailed knowledge of diagnostic steps and decision points in the EOPs that involve transitions to emergency contingency procedures.
: 99. SG2.04.17_002 Which one of the following identifies the bases for the Minimum Number of SRVs Required for Emergency Depressurization and the required procedure utilized if this number of SRVs open cannot be achieved?
The Minimum Number of SRVs Required for Emergency Depressurization is based on the low pressure ECCS system with the lowest head being capable of making up the SRV steam flow at the (1)
If the minimum number of SRVs cannot be opened while performing LPC, then (2) is required to be entered.
A. (1) Reactor Flooding Pressure (2) SAMG-O1, SAMG Primary Containment Flooding Procedure B. (1) Reactor Flooding Pressure (2) OEOP-O1-AEDP, Alternate Emergency Depressurization Procedure C. (1) Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure (2) SAMG-O1, SAMG Primary Containment Flooding Procedure D (1) Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure (2) OEOP-O1-AEDP, Alternate Emergency Depressurization Procedure
 
Feedbick K/A: SG2.04.17 Emergency Procedures I Plan Knowledge of EOP terms and definitions.
(CFR: 41.10/45.13)
ROISRO Rating:
3.9/4.3 Objective:
CLSLP300H*002 Given plant conditions and the Emergency Operating Procedures, determine if execution of the Alternate Emergency Depressurization Procedure is required.
 
==Reference:==
 
OEOP-01 -UG, Attachment 5 (Definitions)
RVCP Cog Level:
High Explanation:
The Minimum Number of SRVs Required for Emergency Depressurization (5) is defined to be the least number of SRVs which correspond to a Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure sufficiently low that the ECCS with the lowest head will be capable of making up the SRV steam flow at the corresponding Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure. If the number of SRVs specified cannot be opened, the reactor must be depressurized by other means. A list of alternate systems that can be used for depressurizing the reactor is included in the Alternate Emergency Depressurization Procedure, EOP-01 -AEDP.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Plausible because Minimum Reactor Flooding Pressure is easily confused with Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure and Primary Containment Flooding requires exiting all EOPs which is wrong for the given conditions.
Choice B: Plausible because Minimum Reactor Flooding Pressure is easily confused with Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure and AEDP is correct.
Choice C: Plausible because Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure is correct and Primary Containment Flooding requires exiting all EOPs which is wrong for the given conditions.
Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation SRO Basis:
Detailed knowledge of diagnostic steps and decision points in the EOPs that involve transitions to emergency contingency procedures.
 
100. SG2.04.35- 002 An ATWS has occurred on Unit Two:
ARI has been actuated No blue lights are lit on the Full Core Display Suppression Pool Temperature is 112&deg; F The 2A SLC pump has a red light indication The 2B SLC pump has a green light indication The SLC A Squib Valve Continuity white light is lit The SLC B Squib Valve Continuity white light is extinguished Which one of the following identifies the procedure that an AD is required to perform?
A Perform LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion, Section 2.
B. Perform LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion, Section 6.
C. Perform LEP-03, Alternate Boron Injection, Section 2.
D. Perform LEP-03, Alternate Boron Injection, Section 3.
 
Feedback K/A: SG2.04.35 Emergency Procedures I Plan Knowledge of local auxiliary operator tasks during an emergency and the resultant operational effects.
(CFR: 41.10/43.5 /45.13)
RO/SRO Rating:
3.8/4.0 Objective:
CLSLP300J*005 Given plant conditions and the Local Emergency Procedures, determine which sections of the Alternate Control Rod Insertion Procedure should be utilized for Control Rod Insertion (EOP-01-LEP-02).
 
==Reference:==
 
OEOP-01-LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion Cog Level:
High Explanation:
Based on the conditions given, determines that scram valves have not opened (no blue lights on full core display) and that Boron is injecting with A pump running (red light on) and B squib valve opened (white light extinguished) so LEP-03 is not required. The pumps discharge into a common header before going to the squib valves. Requires assessment of alternate control rod insertion sections and determines venting the scram air header is appropriate.
Distractor Analysis:
Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because venting of the over piston area will insert the control rods but would be the inappropriate decision for rod insertion given the conditions. The operational effect is reactor shutdown with control rod insertion.
Choice C: Plausible because suppression pool temperature is greater than 110&deg; F and boron injection is required. With A pump running but the A squib valve not open and no B pump a common misconception is that SLC flow will not occur to the Reactor. this would be correct under different conditions in the stem. The operational effect is reactor shutdown with boron injection.
Choice D: Plausible because suppression pool temperature is greater than I 10&deg; F and boron injection is required. With A pump running but the A squib valve not open and no B pump a common misconception is that SLC flow will not occur to the Reactor. this would be correct under different conditions in the stem. The operational effect is reactor shutdown with boron injection.
SRO Basis:
Assessing plant conditions and prescribing a section of a procedure with which to proceed.}}

Latest revision as of 00:25, 12 March 2020

Initial Exam 2010-301 Final SRO Written Exam
ML101240859
Person / Time
Site: Brunswick  Duke Energy icon.png
Issue date: 04/20/2010
From:
NRC/RGN-II
To:
References
Download: ML101240859 (190)


Text

ES-401 Site-Specific SRO Written Examination Form ES-401-8 Cover Sheet US. Nuclear Regulatory Commission Site-Specific SRO Written Examination Applicant Information Name:

Date: 04/2012010 Facility/Unit: Brunswick Units 1 & 2 Region: I LI i nt LI iv LI ReactorType: WL] CE LI BWL] GE Start Time: Finish Time:

Instructions Use the answer sheets provided to document your answers. Staple this cover sheet on top of the answer sheets. To pass the examination you must achieve a final grade of at least 8000 percent overall, with 70.00 percent or better on the SRO-only items if given in conjunction with the RO exam; SRO-only exams given alone require a final grade of 80.00 percent to pass. You have 8 hours9.259259e-5 days <br />0.00222 hours <br />1.322751e-5 weeks <br />3.044e-6 months <br /> to complete the combined examination, and 3 hours3.472222e-5 days <br />8.333333e-4 hours <br />4.960317e-6 weeks <br />1.1415e-6 months <br /> if you are only taking the SRO portion.

Applicant Certification All work done on this examination is my own. I have neither given nor received aid.

Applicants Signature Results RO/SRO-Only/Total Examination Values / / Points Applicants Scores / / Points Applicants Grade / 1 Percent

Written Exam Reference Index

1. 20P-32, Condensate and Feedwater System Operating Procedure, Attachment 4, Final Feedwater Temperature Vs Power
2. RCIC System Partial P&ID
3. OEOP-O1-UG, Users Guide, Attachment 5, Heat Capacity Temperature Limit

1R531 ATTACHMENT4 Information Page 1 of 2 Use Final Feedwater Temperature Vs Power NOTE: The reactor thermal power)temperature data in this table are NOT intended for determining reactor power level. The data are based on final feedwater temperature (FFWT) operating data scaled to theoretical plant thermal performance and do NOT incorporate degraded performance. Reference Precaution and Limitation 3.10.

RX PWR Nominal FW Temp Nominal FW Temp I 1O.3F Reduced Reduced 1OF FW Temp 100% 431.4 421.4 321.1 99% 430,5 420,5 320.5 98% 429.6 419.6 319.9 97% 428.7 418.7 319.3 96% 427.8 417.8 318.7 95% 426.9 416.9 318.1 94% 426.0 416.0 317.5 93% 425.1 415.1 316.9 92% 424.1 414.1 316.2 91%

  • 423.2 413.2 315.6 90% 422.2 412.2 315.0 89% 421.2 411.2 314.3 88% 420.3 410.3 313.7 87% 419.3 409.3 313.0 86% 418.3 408.3 312.3 85% 417.3 407.3 311.7 84% 416.2 406.2 311.0 83% 415.2 405,2 j 310.3 82% 414.2 404,2 1 309.6 81% 413.1 403.1 308.9 80% 412.0 402.0 308.2 79% 411.0 401.0 307.5 78% 409.9 399.9 306.7 77% 408.8 398.8 306.0 76% 407.7 397.7 305.3 75% 406.5 396.5 304.5 74% 405.4 395.4 303.7 73% 404.2 394,2 303.0 72% 403.0 393.0 302.2 71% 401.9 391.9 301,4 70% 400.7 390.7 300,6 69% 399.4 389.4 299.8 68% 398.2 388.2 298.9 67% 396.9 386.9 298.1 20P-32 Rev. 168 Page 296 of 309

ATTACHMENT 4 Page 2of2 Final Feedwater Temperature Vs Power RX PWR

[ Nomina FW Temp Nominai FW Temp Reduced 1OF 1 10.3F Reduced FW Temp 66% 395.7__ 385.7 297.3 65% 394.4 384.4 296.4 64% 393.1 383.1 295.5 63% 391.7 381.7 294.6 62% 390.4 - 380,4 293.7 61% 389.0 379.0 I 292.8 60% 387.6 377.6 1 291.9 59 386.2 376.2 290.9 58% 384.7 374.7 290.0 57% 383.3 373.3 289.0 56% 381.8 371.8 288.0 55% 380,3 370.3 287.0 54% 378.7 368.7 286.0 53% 377.2 367.2 284.9 52% 375.6 365.6 283,8 51% 373.9 363.9 282.8 50% 372.3 362.3 281.6 49% 370.6 360.6 280.5 48% 368.8 358.8 279.4 47% 367.1 357.1 278,2 46% 365.3 355.3 277.0 45% 363.4 353.4 275,7 44% 361.5 351.5 274.5 43% 359.6 349.6 273.2 42% 357.6 347.6 271.9 41% 355. 345.6 270.5 40% 353.5 343.5 269,1 39% 351A,,, 341.4 267.7 38% 349.2 339.2 37% 347.0 337.0 264.8 36% 344.6 334,6 263.2 35% 342.3 332.3 261.6 339.8 329.8 1 337.3 327.3 258.3 32% 334.7 324.7 256.6 332.0 322.0 I 254.8

,,,,,,,329.2 319.2 252.9 29% 326.3 316.3 251.0 28% 323.3 313.3 249.0 27% 320.2 310.2 246,9

, 317,0 307.0 244.8 313.6 303,6 242.5 24% 310,1 300,1 240.2 306.5 237J 20P-32 Rev. 168 Page 297 of 309

RCIC STEAM POT Partial P&ID (D-02529 Sheet 1) bU j:yri P&ø1 DRAIN.

TI POT F 045 LE D59 L) S 60 OlE a)

DRA1 \j H

si 4

i964 AS CS SI 0

P60 A

ATTACHMENT 5 Page 18 of 27 FIGURE 3 Heat Capacity Temperature Limit LL 210 UNSAFE ABOVE 1- *_._

SELECTED LINE

< 200-\---

190 LU c 170--- :::m (-)025FT

(-)1.25FT

< 160 -1 1

__i%N()25OFT 150 zI:: :: : : = HH1E : :c:EE c EE- (-)3.25 FT o l o

4 j:: - [:

j 1 H425Fr Z 130 sEL.cTEDLJNE:çE Li) EE::::_E:+/- E::E:L::

I -1,150 100 300 500 700 900 1,100 0 200 400 600 800 1,000 REACTOR PRESSURE (PSIG)

SUPPRESSION POOL WATER TEMPERATURE IS DETERMINED BY:

- CAC-TR-4426-IA, POINT WTR AVG OR

- CAC-TR-4426-2A, POINT WTR AVG OR

- COMPUTER POINT G050 OR

- COMPUTER POINT G051 OR

- CAC-TY-4426-1 OR

- CAC-TY-4426-2 SELECT GRAPH LINE IMMEDIATELY BELOW SUPPRESSION POOL WATER LEVEL AS THE LIMIT.

OEOP-O1-UG Rev. 57 Page 77 of 151

1.201001A1030c11 Unit Two was operating at rated power when the running CRD Pump tripped, the CRD system is being restarted lAW 20P-08, Control Rod Drive Hydraulic System Operating Procedure, with the following plant conditions:

2A CRD pump Running C12-FOO2B, Flow Control Valve 2B Auto CRD system flow 45 gpm C12-PCV-F003, Drive Pressure Vlv Full open The operator is directed to throttle the C12-PCV-F003 to establish drive water DP between 260 and 275 psid.

Which one of the following choices completes the statement below?

As the operator throttles closed the C12-PCV-F003, the C12-FOO2B will throttle (1) and drive water DP will (2)

A. (1)open (2) lower B. (1)closed (2) lower C (1)open (2) rise D. (1)closed (2) rise

Feedback K/A: 201001 A1.03 Ability to predict andlor monitor changes in parameters associated with operating the CONTROL ROD DRIVE HYDRAULIC SYSTEM controls including:

CRD system flow (CFR: 41.5 / 45.5)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.9/2.8 Objective:

CLS-LP-08, Obj 6c Given plant and CRDHS conditions, predict the values for the following CRDH system parameters:

CRDHS Total System Flow Rate

Reference:

SD-08, CRD Hydraulic System Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

With the given conditions (F003 full open) the drive water pressure will be low. The closing of the F003 would reduce the size of the hole in the flowpath thereby raising pressure. With the F002 in auto, it would have to open to maintain the desired flowrate. All of the plausibilities deal with the relationship of the flow control valve to the pressure control valve making any of them possible depending on where the student thinks the valves are.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the F002 will open and if the F003 is in a different portion of the flowpath the pressure would drop.

Choice B: Plausible because if the F002 and F003 were in a different alignment in the flowpath this would be possible.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because if the F002 was in a different alignment this would be possible, i.e. on the drive water header.

2. 2&1002 K6.01 001 Which one of the following identifies how the Reactor Manual Control System will be affected by a total loss of the Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS)?

Control rods (1)

Control rod position (2)

A. (1)can be inserted using the Emergency Rod In Notch Override switch (2) cannot be determined from Full Core Display, 4 Rod group Display, ERFIS, or the process computer B (1) cannot be inserted by any method other than scram (2) cannot be determined from Full Core Display, 4 Rod group Display, ERFIS, or the process computer C. (1)can be inserted using the Emergency Rod In Notch Override switch (2) can be determined only from ERFIS or the process computer D. (1)cannot be inserted by any method other than scram (2) can be determined only from ERFIS or the process computer

Feedback -

K/A: 201002 K6.01 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the following will have on the REACTOR MANUAL CONTROL SYSTEM:

Select matrix power (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)

ROISRO Rating:

2.5/2.6 Objective:

CLS-LP-07 Obj 12 List the power supplies to the Reactor Manual Control and Rod Position Indication Systems.

Reference:

SD-52, 120 VAC Electrical System SD-07, Reactor Manual Control System Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

This meets the ka by a loss of UPS which is the power supply to the select matrix and then asking how rods can be moved.

UPS provides power to the select matrix. With no rod being able to be selected, the operator can only insert rods via a scram. UPS also provides power to the Full core and four rod displays, which would be lost. RPIS is also lost. With the rod position indication gone then ERFIS / process computer will display show unknown (??)for each rod.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the Emergency In switch bypasses the RMCS logic, but there is no power to select a rod to move. There is no power to the indications (full Core/4 rod) and no RPIS input to the process computer or ERFIS.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the Emergency In switch bypasses the RMCS logic, but there is no power to select a rod to move. ERFIS/process computer has power but the RPIS input is lost.

Choice D: Plausible because ERFIS/process computer has power but the RPIS input is lost.

3.2olooOK5.olool Which one of the following defines the purpose of the Rod Worth Minimizer (RWM) lAW Technical Specifications?

A. Ensures that fuel enthalpy does not exceed 280 cal/gm during a control rod drop accident when power is> 19.1%.

B Ensures that fuel enthalpy does not exceed 280 cal/gm during a control rod drop accident when reactor power is 8.75%.

C. Ensures that the MCPR remains 1 .11, while withdrawing control rods, when power is> 19.1%.

D. Ensures that the MCPR remains ?1 .11, while withdrawing control rods, when reactor power is 8.75%.

Feedback K/A: 201006 K5.01 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to ROD WORTH MINIMIZER SYSTEM (RWM) (PLANT SPECIFIC):

Minimize clad damage if a control rod drop accident (CRDA) occurs P-Spec (Not-BWR6) (CFR: 41.5 / 45.3)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.3/3.7 Objective:

CLS-LP-07.1 Obj. 1 State the purpose of the RWM.

Reference:

Tech Spec 3.3.2.1 Control Rod Block Instrumentation Bases Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

OPERABILITY of the RWM, is required in MODES 1 and 2 when THERMAL POWER is 8.75% RTP.

When THERMAL POWER is> 8.75% RTP, there is no possible control rod configuration that results in a control rod worth that could exceed the 280 cal/gm fuel damage limit during a CRDA.

Since the failure consequences for UO2 have shown that sudden fuel pin rupture requires a fuel energy deposition of approximately 425 cal/gm, the fuel damage limit of 280 cal/gm provides a margin of safety from significant core damage which would result in release of radioactivity. Generic evaluations of a design basis CRDA (i.e., a CRDA resulting in a peak fuel energy deposition of 280 cal/gm) have shown that if the peak fuel enthalpy remains below 280 cal/gm Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the RWM enforces control rod movement from all rods full-in to the Low Power Setpoint (LPSP). (19.1%)

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the RWM enforces control rod movement from all rods full-in to the Low Power Setpoint (LPSP). (19.1%) and the RBM ensures MCPR limits.

Choice D: Plausible because the RBM is what ensures the MCPR limits.

4. 203000 K1.&2002 Unit One is operating at rated power with RHR Loop A operating in suppression pool cooling at a flowrate of 11,500 gpm due to entry into PCCP.

A LOCA inside primary containment subsequently occurs. Plant conditions are:

RPV level Below TAF RPV pressure 20 psig Drywell pressure 18 psig Which one of the following is the expected response of RHR Loop A?

A. Pumping to the reactor only at 11,500 gpm.

B Pumping to the reactor only at 17,000 gpm.

C. Pumping to the suppression pool only at 11,500 gpm.

D. Pumping to both the reactor and the suppression pool at 17,000 gpm.

Feedback K/A: 203000 K1.02 Knowledge of the physical connections andlor cause effect relationships between RHRILPCI:

INJECTION MODE (PLANT SPECIFIC) and the following:

Suppression Pool (CFR: 41.2 to 41.9 / 45.7 to 45.8)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.9/3.9 Objective:

CLS-LP-17 Obj 7 Given plant conditions, determine if the RHR System should automatically initiate in the LPCI mode.

Reference:

sd-17 Cog Level:

High Explanation: With SPC in operation at 11,500 gpm requires two pump operation. Single pump operation limited to 10,000 gpm. When the Loca Signal occurs the LPCI system will re-aline for injection to the vessel and the SPC flowpath will isolate. Two pump operation will provide 17,000 gpm. The RPV pressure is low enough to provide for the valve manipulations and full flow to the vessel.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because previous flow was at 11500.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the overrides could have prevented the transfer to the vessel.

Choice D: Plausible because with overrides the SPC valves would not close thus providing two flowpaths.

5. 205000 G2.04.21 002 The following conditions exist on Unit Two following a forced outage shutdown:

Reactor pressure 100 psig MSIVs closed RHR Loop B in shutdown cooling with a cooldown in progress RHR Loop A in standby lineup Which one of the following describes how the plant will be affected if 2B RPS MG set trips? (assume no operator action)

Reactor pressure will (1)  ; a mode change fZ) occur.

A. (1) continue to lower (2) will B. (1) continue to lower (2) will not C. (1)rise (2)will D (1) rise (2)will not

Feedback K/A: 205000 G2.04.21 Knowledge of the parameters and logic used to assess the status of safety functions, such as reactivity control, core cooling and heat removal, reactor coolant system integrity, containment conditions, radioactivity release control, etc.

Shutdown Cooling System (RHR Shutdown Cooling Mode)

(CFR: 41.7 / 43.5/45.12)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.0/4.6 Objective:

CLS-LP-200-B Obj. 05 Given a set of plant conditions, determine the plant MODE

Reference:

TS Cog Level:

High Explanation:

U2 Loss of RPS MG Set B will cause F008 to close thereby tripping the RHR pump. With a loss of SDC pressure will rise. With the unit at 100 psig the reactor will be in Mode 3 and will stay in mode 3 as the reactor heats up.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because if there is no effect the pressure will continue to lower and a mode change will occur.

Choice B: Plausible because if there is no effect the pressure will continue to lower and the student could think that a mode change would occur from Mode 4 to 3.

Choice C: Plausible because pressure will rise and the student could think that a mode change would occur from Mode 4 to 3.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.

6.206000 K4.02 001 Unit One is at rated power when a steam line break causes the temperatures in the ECCS pipe tunnel to exceed 203°F two minutes ago.

Which one of the following identifies the current status of the Group 4 and Group 5 isolation valves?

A Group 4 valves closed only.

B. Group 5 valves closed only.

C. Both Group 4 and Group 5 valves closed.

D. Neither Group 4 nor Group 5 valves closed.

Feedback K/A: 206000 K4.02 Knowledge of HIGH PRESSURE COOLANT INJECTION SYSTEM design feature(s) andlor interlocks which provide for the following:

System isolation: BWR-2,3,4 (CFR: 41.7)

ROISRO Rating:

3.9/4.0 Objective:

cLS-Lp-o12-A Obj 6 Given plant conditions, determine if a Group Isolation should occur.

Reference:

SD-12, Primary Containment Isolation System Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

RCIC Group 5 has 27 mm time delay to allow HPCI isolation to occur and possibly isolate the leak leaving RCIC available.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because it may be thought that the time delay is on the Grp 4 instead of the Grp 5.

Choice C: Plausible if they do not apply any time delays.

Choice D: Plausible if they do apply the time delay to both groups.

7. 209001 K3.01 001 A Dual Unit Loss of Offsite Power occurs with DGI under clearance and the following electrical plant lineup:

4 kV E-Busses Energized from their respective available DGs 480 V E-Busses E5 and E8 only are de-energized Then a LOCA signal is received on Unit Two.

Which one of the following completes the statement below concerning the ability of Unit Two Core Spray to restore reactor water level?

The Core Spray Pump(s) in (1) running and injection flow is available through the (2) , Core Spray Inboard Injection Valve.

A. (1) Loop A only is (2) 2E21-FOO5A B. (1)LoopBonlyis (2) 2E21-FOO5B C (1) both Loops are (2) 2E21-FOO5A D. (1) both Loops are (2) 2E21-FOO5B

Feedback K/A: 209001 K3.01 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the LOW PRESSURE CORE SPRAY SYSTEM will have on following:

Reactor water level (CFR: 41.7 / 45.4)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.8/3.9 Objective:

CLS-LP-18 Obj.13b List the power supplies for each of the following Core Spray System components: MOVs

Reference:

SD-I 8, Core Spray System Cog Level:

High Explanation:

This meets the KA because the power loss is causing a loss of CS and then determining what loops are available to inject (raise reactor water level) based on this loss.

A Core Spray Initiation Signal is present and power is available to both Core Spray pumps, E3 and E4 are energized. With the power loss to E8, MCC 2XD will not have power and the B loop Core Spray valves will be de-energized. So both pumps would be running and injection would only be available from A Loop of Core Spray.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because loop A pump is running and the injection path is available through A loop.

Wrong because the B loop pump is also running.

Choice B: Plausible because the loop pump has power but the injection valve does not. May think that valve power comes from the opposite unit same division similar to the RHR arrangement. The configuration of RHR pumps has power from the opposite unit for the pumps so with a loss of El makes a loss of CS pump A plausable.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because both pumps do have power but the B injection valve does not. May think that valve power comes from the opposite unit same division like RHR does.

8. 209001 K3.03 001 CS Pump 1A is running for surveillance testing when the CS Pump IA control power fuses blow inside its 4KV breaker compartment.

A Loss of Off-Site Power then occurs.

Which one of the following choices completes the statement below?

DGI (1) auto tie onto El because the (2)

A. (1) will still (2) DG1 output breaker logic will not recognize that the CS Pump IA breaker is closed B. (1) will still (2) CS Pump lA breaker will still auto trip open C (l)will not (2) CS Pump IA breaker fails to trip open D. (l)will not (2) DG1 output breaker has no control power

Feedback K/A: 209001 K3.03 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the LOW PRESSURE CORE SPRAY SYSTEM will have on following:

Emergency generators (CFR: 41.7 /45.4)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.9/3.0 Objective:

CLS-LP-39 Obj.12 Given plant conditions, determine if permissives are satisfied for the DG output breaker to close.

Reference:

SD-39, Emergency Diesel Generators Cog Level:

High Explanation:

This meets the KA because the malfunction (loss of control power to the CS pump) causes the DG not to be able to automatically close onto the E-bus.

CS pump 1A is powered from bus El and must load strip prior to EDG #1 0/P breaker closure.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible if examinee believes the blown control power fuse has effected the DGI output breaker logic Choice B: Plausible if examinee believes that the blown control power fuse will not prevent the CS Pump IA breaker from tripping on the LOOP Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible if examinee believes the blown control power fuse has effected the DGloutputt breaker logic

9.211000 K1,01 001 Which one of the following identifies the relationship between the SLC system and Core Spray Line Break Detection differential pressure instrument?

The (1) leg of this DP instrument senses (2) core plate pressure via the SLC/Core Differential Pressure penetration.

A. (1)variable (2) below B. (1)variable (2) above C. (1)reference (2) below D(1)reference (2) above Feedback K/A: 211000 K1.01 Knowledge of the physical connections and/or cause effect relationships between STANDBY LIQUID CONTROL SYSTEM and the following:

Core spray line break detection: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.2 to 41.9 /45.7 to 45.8)

ROISRO Rating:

3.0/3.3 Objective:

CLS-LP-18 Obj. 10 Explain the principle of operation of the CS Line Break Detection Instrumentation

Reference:

SD-i 8, Core Spray System Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

This system is comprised of a differential pressure detector which provides Control Room annunciation on detected high DP. The high pressure reference leg of this instrument is exposed to above core plate pressure via the SLC/Core Differential Pressure penetration. The low pressure of this instrument is normally exposed to above core pressure via the Core Spray injection line. This results in the instrument normally measuring core DP (not including core plate DP).

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the examinee may confuse the reference and variable legs and SLC does discharge below the core plate Choice B: Plausible because the examinee may confuse the reference and variable legs Choice C: Plausible because it is the reference leg and SLC does discharge below the core plate.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

10. 212000 K2.01 001 Which one of the following identifies which RPS MG Set and EPA breakers that trip on a loss of 480 VAC Substation E7?

RPS MG Set (1) EPA breakers (2)

A. (1)A (2) 1 & 2 only B. (1)B (2)3&4only C(1)A (2) 1 & 2 and alternate source EPA breakers 5 & 6 D. (1)B (2) 3 & 4 and alternate source EPA breakers 5 & 6

Feedback K/A: 212000 K2.01 Knowledge of electrical power supplies to the following:

RPS motor-generator sets (CFR: 41.7)

ROISRO Rating:

3.2/3.3 Objective:

CLS-LP-03 Obj 1 8a State the power supplies for the following: RPS MG Set A

Reference:

SD-03, Reactor Protection System Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Power for the Motor Generator Sets is tapped off two phases of the normal 480 VAC MC 1 CA/I CB (2CN2CB) power supply for the motor through a stepdown transformer (480V to 120V) from E5/E6 (E7/E8). Selectable reserve power to the Bus is provided from 120 VAC I E5(2E7) or 1 E6(2E8), and is normally selected to Division I. In the event that either RPS M-G Set fails to operate, the alternate power source must be manually selected.

Two EPAs in series are installed downstream of the generator output breaker for each Motor Generator Set and the alternate power supply for the RPS buses. Bus A is protected by EPA-I and -2; Bus B by EPA-3 and -4. Alternate power is protected by EPA-5 and -6 Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because A MG set is lost along with EPA breakers 1 & 2, but these are not the only EPA breakers to trip.

Choice B: Plausible if the examinee picks the wrong power supply and EPA breakers 3 & 4 are powered from RPS MG Set B.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible if the examinee picks the wrong power supply and EPA breakers 3 & 4 are powered from RPS MG Set B.

11.214000 A3.o4odn A control rod is notched out from position 12.

The operator observes the 12 indication on the four rod display goes out, comes back on, and then goes out again.

The operator then observes the 13 indication come on and then go out.

No additional rod position is displayed on the four rod display.

Which one of the following identifies the rod position that will be displayed on the RWM? (assume no additional operator action)

A. Position 12 in inverse video.

B. FE with an inferred position of 12.

C. Position 14 in inverse video.

D FE with an inferred position of 14.

Feedback K/A: 214000 A3.04 Ability to monitor automatic operations of the ROD POSITION INFORMATION SYSTEM including:

RCIS: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.5/3.8 Objective:

CLS-LP-07.1 Obj. 8 Explain how control rod position is inferred and substituted in the RWM

Reference:

SD-07.1, Rod Worth Minimizer System Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

For Brunswick the rod control system is RWM which supplies rod blocks and such and indications of the selected rod and position of that rod.

On a rod withdrawal if the even notch position (in this case 14) is failed, as long as RWM detects the previous odd reed switch (13) RWM will provide an inferred position of 14 since RWM also receives data from RMCS that the operator initiated a withdraw motion. If there is an inferred position available, it will not be automatically substituted into RWM. A substitute rod position will be displayed on RWM in inverse video.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Incorrect since 12 will not be displayed but is plausible since position 12 was the last good even position sensed by RWM Choice B: Incorrect since position 13 was detected but is plausible since no inferred position would be available if 13 failed or if no rod motion command was sensed by RWM and the last sensed reed switch was odd Choice C: Incorrect since RWM will not automatically substitute inferred position but plausible since the rod is actually at 14, and this would be the display once the operator accepts the inferred position Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

12. 215003 A2.02 001 A plant startup is in progress when the high voltage power supply for IRM G failed low.

All IRMs are on range 1. (Mode switch is in Startup)

Which one of the following choices completes the statements below?

The expected plant response is a (1)

The action required lAW the annunciator procedure(s) is to place the (2)

A. (1) rod block only (2) joystick on P603 for IRM G to Bypass B. (1) rod block only (2) operate switch on the IRM G drawer to STANDBY C (1) rod block with a half scram (2) joystick on P603 for IRM G to Bypass D. (1) rod block with a half scram (2) operate switch on the IRM G drawer to STANDBY

Feedback K/A: 215003 A2.02 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the INTERMEDIATE RANGE MONITOR (IRM)

SYSTEM; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:

IRM mop condition (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.5/3.7 Objective:

CLS-LP-09.1 Obj. 13c Given plant conditions and one of the following events, use plant procedures to determine the actions required to control and/or mitigate the consequences of the event: IRM mop alarm

Reference:

1 APP-A-05 SD-9.1, Neutron Monitoring System (SRM/IRM)

Cog Level:

High Explanation:

A loss of power to the high voltage supply is an mop trip of the IRM. This will cause a half scram and rod block. In order to clear the cause of this alarm per the annunciator procedure would be to place the IRM in bypass using the joystick on the P603 panel. The question can not state lAW the specific procedure because that would give the answer to the first part of the question.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the actions are correct and rod block will occur, but also a half scram will occur.

Choice B: Plausible becasue a rod block will occur and some components placing it in standby will remove the signal from the trip circuit (i.e. standby gas in standby removes the train from the logic).

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible becasue these will occur and some components placing it in standby will remove the signal from the trip circuit (i.e. standby gas in standby removes the train from the logic).

F3. 215004 K5.03 001 A plant startup is in progress. A control rod block has occurred. The following nuclear instrument indications are noted:

SRM Counts Position IRM Counts Range A 5 3x10 Full In A 25/125 3 B 190 Mid Position B 65/125 2 C 4 6x10 Full In C 35/1 25 3 D 125 Mid Position D 15/125 3 E 12/125 2 F 55/125 2 G 30/125 3 H 25/125 3 Which one of the following is the minimum required action(s) that will clear the control rod block?

A Withdrawing SRM A only.

B. Ranging IRM E to range 3.

C. Withdrawing SRM A and C.

D. Ranging IRM B and F to range 3.

Feedback K/A: 215004 K5.03 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to SOURCE RANGE MONITOR (SRM) SYSTEM:

Changing detector position (CFR: 41.5 / 45.3)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.8/2.8 Objective:

CLS-LP-09.1 Obj. 9a Describe the insertion/withdrawal of the SRM detectors, including the following:

Reason for maintaining counts between 125 and 2x10 .

5

Reference:

SD-09.1, Neutron Monitoring System (SRM/IRM)

Cog Level:

High Explanation:

To clear the rod block SRM must be below 2x10 5 or IRMs must be> range 7. The retract permit is bypassed with IRMs> range 3. Withdrawing SRM A will cause the rod block to clear when less than 5

2x10 Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because IRM E is the only Div I IRM below range 3. If all Div I IRMs are above range 3 then the rod block from SRM Retract Permissive in would be bypassed, not the signal from SRM upscale. Also ranging IRM E to range 3 will cause a IRM downscale which is a rod block.

Choice C: Plausible because SRM A does need to be withdrawn and C is above the old setpoint for the upscale alarm. (recent change, old setpoint was 5x10).

4 Choice D: Plausible because IRM B & F are the only Div II IRMs below range 3 and these do meet the requirements for ranging them to 3. If all Div II IRMs are above range 3 then a rod block from SRM Retract Permissive would be bypassed on Div II, not the signal from SRM upscale.

14. 215005 A2.04 001 Which one of the following identifies the impact a loss of RPS MG Set B will have on the Unit One Power Range Neutron Monitoring system and identifies the action required to energize RPS B from its alternate power supply?

Power will be lost to (1) 2 and 4.

In order to re-energize RPS B lAW I OP-03, Reactor Protection System Operating Procedure, the RPS Power Source Select Switch on Panel P610 is required to be placed in the (2) position.

A. (1)APRMs (2)ALTA B. (1)APRMs (2)ALTB C. (I) Voters (2)ALTA Dv (1) Voters (2)ALTB

Feedback K/A: 215005 A2.04 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the AVERAGE POWER RANGE MONITOR!

LOCAL POWER RANGE MONITOR SYSTEM; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:

SCRAM trip signals (CFR: 41.5 /45.6)

ROISRO Rating:

3.8/3.9 Objective:

CLS-LP-09.6 Obj.12b Given plant conditions, predict the response of the PRNMS to a malfunction/failure of the following systems/components: 120 VAC Distribution

Reference:

SD-09.6, Power Range Neutron Monitoring System Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Each APRM instrument receives power from two power supplies, LVPS I and LVPS 4. LVPS 1 is fed from RPS Bus A while LVPS 4 is fed from RPS Bus B. Therefore, a loss of an RPS Bus will not affect operation of the APRM NUMACS. Each of the four VOTERS corresponds to a channel of the Al, A2, Bi, and B2 RPS logic. The VOTER outputs to the RPS logic are: Al (VOTER I), A2 (VOTER 3), BI (VOTER 2), and B2 (VOTER 4). Voters 2 and 4 are powered from RPS B. OP-03 contains the steps to re-energize the RPS MG Set in which transferring to alternate power supply can be performed. If this is done then the switch will be placed in Alt B position. Some confusion usually happens as this procedure is performed because the light above the Alt B position is unlit. Students usually think then that Alt B has no power available to energize the RPS Bus and want to take the switch to Alt A which is the energized bus.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the APRM lose one power source but have a redundent power supply. The procedure action is plausible because the ALT A is a position switch that is used for transferring the A RPS to alternate. The student may confuse this with transferring to the A RPS power supply because the light will be extinguished above the Alt B position and be on above the Alt A position.

Choice B: Plausible becasue the APRM lose one power source but have a redundent power supply. Alt B is the correct switch position for the transfer switch.

Choice C: The procedure action is plausible because the ALT A is a position switch that is used for transferring the A RPS to alternate. The student may confuse this with transferring to the A RPS power supply because the light will be extinguished above the Alt B position and be on above the Alt A position.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.

15. 215005 A2.05 001 Unit One is at 94% power when one recirc flow input to APRM 2 fails downscale (zero).

Which one of the following identifies:

(1) the OPRM response to the recirc flow failure and (2) the required action lAW the annunciator procedures?

A (1) OPRM 2 only is enabled.

(2) Bypass APRM 2.

B. (1) OPRM 2 only is enabled.

(2) Verify RBM B auto transfers to APRM 3.

C. (1)AIl OPRMs are enabled.

(2) Bypass APRM 2.

D. (1) All OPRMs are enabled.

(2) Verify RBM B auto transfers to APRM 3.

- Feedback K/A: 215005 A2.05 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the AVERAGE POWER RANGE MONITOR!

LOCAL POWER RANGE MONITOR SYSTEM ; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:

Loss of recirculation flow signal (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.5/3.6 Objective:

CLS-LP-09.6 Obj 12g Given plant conditions, predict the response of the PRNMS to a malfunction/failure of the following systems/components: Recirc Flow Module

Reference:

SD-9.6, Power Range Neutron Monitoring System 1 APP-A-06 Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Each Numac processes the signals from one sensor in Loop A and one in Loop B and averages the signals to obtain total recirc flow rate. If one of the two recirc flow signals to an APRM failed to a zero signal with reactor power at 100%, its OPRM becomes enabled because the calculated flow is reduced to one half of its initial value. The other APRM/OPRMs will be unaffected. The RBM has a primary reference from APRM 2 with the primary alternate from APRM 4 and a secondary alternate from APRM 3. Transfer to the alternate alternate requires a critical self test fault on the alternate.

The APP direction is to bypass the effected APRM.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because the RBM B will transfer from APRM 2 to its alternate reference which is APRM 4 or its secondary alternate of APRM 3.

Choice C: Plausible because the alarm for OPRM enabled will be in alarm, and the Voters will see the OPRM enabled on all 4 voters for only OPRM 2 though.

Choice D: Plausible because the alarm for OPRM enabled will be in alarm, and the Voters will see the OPRM enabled on all 4 voters for only OPRM 2 though. The RBM B will transfer from APRM 2 to its alternate reference which is APRM 4 or its secondary alternate of APRM 3.

16. 216000K2.O1 001 Which one of the following identifies the power supply to the Unit One RPS A analog trip cabinets?

A. 125 VDC Panel 3A B. 125 VDC Panel 4A C 125 VDC Panel hA D. 125 VDC Panel 12A

Feedback K/A: 216000 K2.01 Knowledge of electrical power supplies to the following:

Analog trip system: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.7)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.8/2.8 Objective:

CLS-LP-03 Obj 1 8h State the power supplies for the following: Analog Trip System Logic Cabinets

Reference:

SD-03, Reactor Protection System Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

There are four cabinets for the RPS, each housing a separate channel (XU-65 through XU-68). Cabinets receive power from DC panels 1 1A(B) for Unit I and DC panels 12A(B) for unit 2. An NLI /Topaz (backup) inverter and a Lambda power supply are located in each cabinet. In order to meet the complete redundancy criteria, the power supplies are designed to be shared in the event of a power supply failure in one cabinet. These four cabinets cause a trip on a loss of power.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because this is the feed to the Unit 2 Div 1 ESS trip cabinet Choice B: Plausible because this is the feed to the Unit 1 Div 1 ESS trip cabinet Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because this is the feed to Unit two analog trip system cabinets.

17. 217000 A1.01 001 Following a loss of feedwater, RCIC automatically initiated and subsequently shut down on high reactor water level.

Current plant status is:

Reactor water level is 170 inches RCIC flow controller in Auto set at 200 gpm The RO opens the E51-F045 and then depresses the PF push button on the RCIC flow controller. No other actions are performed.

Which one of the following identifies the indicated flow on the RCIC flow controller that would be observed for these conditions?

A 0 gpm B. 200 gpm C. 400 gpm D. 500 gpm

Feedback K/A: 217000 Al .01 Ability to predict andlor monitor changes in parameters associated with operating the REACTOR CORE ISOLATION COOLING SYSTEM (RCIC) controls including; RCIC flow (CFR: 41.5 / 45.5)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.7/3.7 Objective:

CLS-LP-016-A Obj.12a Given plant conditions, with RCIC controlled from the RTGB, determine if the following automatic actions should occur: RCIC System Initiation

Reference:

SD-16, Reactor Core Isolation Cooling System (RCIC)

Cog Level:

High Explanation:

The RCIC Injection Valve will automatically open upon receiving a low reactor water level signal (LL2) provided that neither the Turbine Trip and Throttle Valve, E51-V8, nor the Turbine Steam Supply Valve, E51-F045, is full closed. Located on the controller face is a PF (programmable function) pushbutton.

When depressed an automatic transfer from MANUAL to AUTOMATIC at a predetermined setpoint of 400 GPM will result. NOTE: This button (PF) has no function if the controller is already in AUTOMATIC.

Since reactor level is above the LL2 setpoint, and the LL2 initiation relays do not seal in, the injection valve F013 will not auto open. The turbine will develop speed and discharge pressure causing the mm flow valve to open, but this flow will not be reflected on the flow indication since the flow instrument is located downstream of the mm flow line.

An operator that does not have knowledge of the interlocks associated with the RCIC injection valve, or who has misconceptions about the operation of the RCIC flow controller could easily choose any of the incorrect choices.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because this would be correct if the operator also opened F013, or if reactor level dropped below LL2.

Choice C: Plausible because this would be correct if the operator also opened FOl 3, or if reactor level dropped below LL2, and if the operator placed the controller in Manual prior to depressing the PF push button.

Choice D: Plausible because the PF push button would raise RCIC flow to rated (400 gpm) and not maximum per procedure (500 gpm). Achieving 500 gpm would require the flow control setpoint to be manually raised.

1-8. 217-0O&A1.04 001 Given the following plant conditions with RCIC in pressure control mode:

RCIC controller output 70%

Bypass to CST Vlv, E51-F022 Throttled RCIC Flow 300 gpm RPV pressure 990 psig, slowly rising RCIC controller Automatic set @ 300 gpm Which one of the following identifies two independent actions that will stabilize RPV pressure?

The RO can throttle the E51-F022 in the (1) direction, or by (2) the RCIC Flow Controller auto setpoint.

A. (1)open (2) lowering B. (1)open (2) raising C. (1)closed (2) lowering Db (1) closed (2) raising

Feedback K/A: 217000 A1.04 Ability to predict andlor monitor changes in parameters associated with operating the REACTOR CORE ISOLATION COOLING SYSTEM (RCIC) controls including:

Reactor pressure (CFR: 41.5 / 45.5)

ROISRO Rating:

3.6/3.6 Objective:

CLS-LP-016-A Obj. 17b Describe how the following evolutions are performed during operation of the RCIC system:

Adjusting RCIC flow in the reactor pressure control mode.

Reference:

RCIC Hard Card Cog Level:

High Explanation:

There are two ways to reduce the RPV pressure with the conditions given. One way is to close the 22 valve, thereby decreasing the size of the hole and forcing the turbine to work harder to deliver the same flowrate. The second is to raise the controller setpoint thereby causing the turbine to work harder by forcing more flow through the same size hole..

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible becasue these are the opposite of the actual answers and if the operator was trying to raise RPV pressure this would be correct.

Choice B: Plausible because raising is correct and the operator could have a misconception about the 22 valve.

Choice C: Plausible because closing the 22 is correct and the operator could have a misconception about the flow controller.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.

19.2lgoooK3.oloo2 Unit One is operating at power with CS pump I B under clearance.

A small break LOCA occurs simultaneously with a Loss of Off-site Power to both units.

Only DG2 and DG3 start and tie onto their respective E bus.

The following plant conditions exist on Unit One:

AUTO DEPRESS TIMERS INITIATED In alarm REACTOR LOW WTR LEVEL INITIATION In alarm RPV pressure 600 psig Drywell pressure 13 psig Based on the conditions above, which one of the following:

(1) identifies the status of ADS and (2) how RPV water level restoration is established?

A. (1) ADS will auto initiate.

(2) Level will be recovered with RHR Loop A.

B. (I) ADS will auto initiate.

(2) Level will be recovered with RHR Loop B.

C (1) ADS will not auto initiate.

(2) When ADS is manually initiated level will be recovered with RHR Loop A.

D. (1) ADS will not auto initiate.

(2) When ADS is manually initiated level will be recovered with RHR Loop B.

Feedback K/A: 218000 K3.01 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the AUTOMATIC DEPRESSURIZATION SYSTEM will have on following:

Restoration of reactor water level after a break that does not depressurize the reactor when required (CFR: 41.7 I 45.4)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.4/4.4 Objective:

CLS-LP-20 Obj. 16b Given plant conditions, predict how the following will be affected by a loss or malfunction of ADSISRVs:

b. Reactor water level

Reference:

SD-20, Automatic Depressurization System (ADS)

Cog Level:

High Explanation:

With the loss of offsite power and 1 B CS pump under clearance this would leave only one pump available in each RHR loop. Therefore ADS logic is lost. Level will continue to lower until the ADS valves are manually opened (emergency depressurization) at which time the running low pressure pumps will be able to add water. Injection would be from the A Loop of RHR as the B Loop injection valves do not have power.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because ADS does have initiation conditions except that the logic will not have the appropriate pumps lined up for injection.

Choice B: Plausible because ADS does have initiation conditions except that the logic will not have the appropriate pumps lined up for injection. B Loop of RHR does not have power to the injection valves Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation.

Choice D: Plausible because ADS will not auto initiate but the B Loop of RHR does not have power to the injection valves.

20. 2230&2 A3.03 001 Reactor Recirculation pumps have tripped due to a low level condition.

G31-FOO1, RWCU Inboard Isol Vlv, is Closed.

G31-F004, RWCU Outboard Isol VIv, is Open.

Which one of the following identifies what the Group 3 Isolation Status Box on ERFIS will display in five minutes?

A A green GROUP ISOL B. A red NO GROUP ISOL C. A yellow GROUP ISOL CMND D. A green NO GROUP ISOL CMND Feedback K/A: 223002 A3.03 Ability to monitor automatic operations of the PRIMARY CONTAINMENT ISOLATION SYSTEM/NUCLEAR STEAM SUPPLY SHUT-OFF including:

SPDS/ERIS/CRIDS/GDS: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)

ROISRO Rating:

2.5/2.8 Objective:

CLS-LP-060-A Obj 4d Describe the methods used to do the following on the ERFIS/SPDS Computer:

Obtain Group Isolation status including valve position

Reference:

SD-60, ERFIS Data Aquisition, Processing and Display Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

ERFIS relies on the isolation signal to determine if an isolation is required. Since RWCU did receive a signal, ERFIS will recognize a valid isolation signal with at least one valve closed in the penetration path and remain Green and display GROUP ISOL.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation.

Choice B: Plausible because this is what would be expected with an isolation signal and no valves closed.

Choice C: Plausible because the isolation signal and valve closure time has not expired and can be confused with an incomplete isolation of the penetration flow path (both valves not closed).

Choice D: Plausible because the candidate does not recognize Recirc pump trip is LL2 (same as RWCU) would be indicated if no isolation signal present.

21. 23000&A1.06 001 Given the following small break LOCA conditions on Unit Two:

Drywell pressure 14.8 psig Suppression chamber pressure 12.5 psig Which one of the following identifies the response of suppression pool water level after initiating suppression pool sprays?

The CAC-Ll-4177, Suppression Pool Level, indication will (1) slightly due to the (2) DP between the drywell and suppression pool.

A. (1)lower (2) higher B. (1)lower (2) reduced C (1) rise (2) higher D. (1)rise (2) reduced

Feedback K/A: 230000 Al .06 Ability to predict and/or monitor changes in parameters associated with operating the RHRILPCI:

TORUSISUPPRESSION POOL SPRAY MODE controls including:

Suppression pool level (CFR: 41.5 /45.5)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.3/3.3 Objective:

N/A

Reference:

SD-04, Primary Containment Cog Level:

High Explanation:

With the SP at 12.5 psig and then sprays initiated the pressure will lower in the SP and this will cause the higher delta pressure between the DW and SP to force some water down the downcomers to slightly raise the water level in the SP due to the Higher dP. The pumps take a suction from the SP and then spray back to the SP.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because a higher d/p would be developed from the spray initiation, but level would not lower based ondP.

Choice B: Plausible if the student has backward thinking of what is occurring with d/p. Lower pressure is lowering dP.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because a lower d/p would cause level to rise but the d/p will increase when sprays are initiated.

22. 234000 A4.02 002 Given the following conditions on Unit One with the Mode Switch in Refuel:

-Control rod 26-27 is withdrawn to position 48 for blade removal lAW 1 OP-08, Control Rod Drive Hydraulic System Operating Procedure.

-RWM is in Bypass Which one of the following completes the statement below if Rod Select power is turned off?

When Rod Select Power is turned back on (1) can be selected and the Withdraw Permissive white light (2) be lit.

A. (1) any control rod (2) will B (1) any control rod (2) will not C. (1) only Control Rod 26-27 (2) will D. (1) only Control Rod 26-27 (2) will not

Feedback KJA: 234000 A4.02 Ability to manually operate andlor monitor in the control room:

Control rod drive system (CFR: 41.7 /45.5 to 45.8)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.4/3.7 Objective:

CLS-LP-07 Obj. 9e Describe the conditions which will energize the following indicating lights: Withdraw Permissive

Reference:

SD-07, Reactor Manual Control System Cog Level:

High Explanation:

The rod select circuit is designed so that the rod selection is locked in unless power is removed from the select panel. If rod select power is turned off and back on with a rod withdrawn, the interlock will allow selection of other rods, but will generate a rod block if the rod selected is different than the withdrawn rod.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because any rod may be selected but the withdraw permissive light will not be lit.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation.

Choice C: Plausible because it is a misconception that no other rod may be selected. the withdraw permissive light will not be lit.

Choice D: Plausible because it is a misconception that no other rod may be selected.

23. 239002 A4.04 001 -

The following annunciators are received while performing OPT-I 1.1.2, Automatic Depressurization System and Safety Relief Valve Operability Test:

SPTMS DIV I BULK WTR SETPOINT TSI SPTMS DIV II BULK WTR SETPOINT TSI Which one of the following identifies the minimum Suppression Pool temperature required to receive the above annunciators?

A 95°F.

B 100°F C 105°F D. 110°F.

Feedback K/A: 239002 A4.04 Ability to manually operate andlor monitor in the control room:

Suppression pool temperature (CFR: 41.7 / 45.5 to 45.8)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.3/4.3 Objective:

CLS-LP-302M Obj. 1 Given plant conditions, determine if the following AOPs should be entered: AOP-30

Reference:

APP UA-12 5-4(5-5)

Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

This alarm setpoint is 95°F.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because this is a homogeneous setpoint distractor Choice C: Plausible because this is the setpoint for SPTMS DIV I BULK WTR TEMP SETPT TMAX Choice D: Plausible because this is the setpoint for Boron Injection Initiation Temperature (BIIT)

24. 259001 A2.06 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power. The DFCS control signal input to 2A RFP has been lost. The RD observes the following:

RFP A CONTROL TROUBLE alarm is received RFPT A Man/DFCS control switch is in DFCS DFCS Control light for REP A on XU-1 is out Which one of the following describes how REP 2A will respond, and what operator action is required by RFP A CONTROL TROUBLE, to adjust the speed of REP 2A?

REP2Aspeedwill (1)

The operator can control REP A speed by (2)

A. (1) drop to the idle speed setpoint (2) operating the REPT A Man/DECS Raise/Lower control switch B (1) remain at the last known demand (2) operating the REPT A Man/DECS Raise/Lower control switch C. (1) drop to the idle speed setpoint (2) placing the C32-SIC-R6OIA, REPT A Sp Ctl, in Manual and adjusting the output demand D. (1) remain at the last known demand (2) placing the C32-SIC-R6OIA, REPT A Sp Ctl, in Manual and adjusting the output demand

Feedback K/A: 259001 A2.06 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the REACTOR FEEDWATER SYSTEM ; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:

Loss of A.C. electrical power (CFR: 41.5 I 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.2/3.2 Objective:

CLS-LP-32.3 Obj. lOj Given plant conditions and one or more of the following events use plant procedures to determine the actions required to control and/or mitigate the consequences of the event:

Loss of signal from the DFCS

Reference:

UA-13 6-5 SD-32.3, RFP Turbine Speed Control Cog Level:

High Explanation:

UPS supplies power to the controls.

From OP-32, Section 5.7.2 (Notes)

IF RFPT B(A) MAN/DFCS selector switch is in DFCS, AND the DFCS control signal subsequently drops below 2450 rpm, OR increases to greater than 5450 rpm, THEN Woodward 5009 digital controls will automatically assume RFPT speed control and maintain current speed. In this condition, the RFPT will only respond to LOWER/RAISE speed control switch commands From APP UA-13 6-5 (RFP A Control Trouble)

IF RFPT 2A DFCS CTRL light on RTGB XU-1 is NOT illuminated, THEN attempt to control RFP turbine speed as necessary using the LOWER/RAISE speed control switch Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the woodward manual control signal automatically tracks the DFCS output signal. An operator without this knowledge could believe the RFP speed would drop to minimum woodward control speed with the DFCS control signal failed Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the DFCS control signal has failed. with the DFCS Control light out, the REP is under manual control of the woodward governor and adjusting the output of the individual REP Speed Controller will have no effect. An operator without understanding of the hierarchy of the REP control system could believe this choice is correct.

Choice D: Plausible because the DFCS control signal has failed, with the DECS Control light out, the REP is under manual control of the woodward governor and adjusting the output of the individual REP Speed Controller will have no effect. An operator without understanding of the hierarchy of the REP control system could believe this choice is correct.

25. 2-5900zK6.o400r Unit One is operating at rated power when the Feedwater Flow B indicator has drifted upscale.

Which one of the following identifies the effect this failure has on reactor water level and DFCS control? (Assume no operator actions)

A RPV water level will initially lower and then return to the current setpoint DFCS transfers to 1-element control B. RPV water level will initially rise and then return to the current setpoint DFCS transfers to 1-element control C. RPV water level will initially lower and then return to the current setpoint DFCS remains in 3-element control D. RPV water level will initially rise and then return to the current setpoint DFCS remains in 3-element control

Feedback K/A: 259002 K6.04 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the following will have on the REACTOR WATER LEVEL CONTROL SYSTEM:

Reactor feedwater flow input (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.1/3.1 Objective:

CLS-LP-32.2 Obj 7b Given plant conditions, determine the response of the DFCS to the following events:

Loss of any feed flow input

Reference:

APP A-07 4-2, FW CTL SYS TROUBLE SD-32.2, Digital Feedwater Control System Cog Level:

High Explanation:

DFCS is going to see the false rise in feed flow and compensate with higher steam flow drawing more inventory from the vessel causing level to initially drop.

The following signals are the permissives to operate in 3 element control:

All steam flows (4) outputs are valid (within 10% of avg)

All feed flows (2) outputs are valid (within 10% of both)

Master control station in Automatic At least one (1) Feed pump control station is in Automatic Reactor Power is > 20%

Feed flow and Steam flow matched with the feed flow failure this will transfer to I element control. Level will be maintained based on level only Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because the examinee may misinterpret the feed flow indication rise as an actual rise in feedflow which would raise vessel level.

Choice C: Plausible because level will ultimately be maintained at the current setpoint but it will transfer to single element control on greater than 10% difference between feed flow signals.

Choice D: Plausible because the examinee may misinterpret the feed flow indication rise as an actual rise in feedflow which would raise vessel level. Plausible because level will ultimately be maintained at the current setpoint but it will transfer to single element control on greater than 10% difference between feed flow signals.

26. 261000 A3.01 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power with Standby Gas Treatment (SBGT) System controls aligned as follows:

Train A in SYST A PREF Train B in STBY Drywell cooling is lost and the reactor scrams on high drywell pressure. Reactor water level drops to 130 inches and is now rising.

Given these plant conditions, which one of the following choices predicts the SBGT system flow indications at the XU-51 panel?

SBGT Train A flow (Fl-3150-1) is (1) SCFM.

SBGT Train B flow (Fl-3151-1) is (2) SCFM.

A. (1)0 (2)0 B. (1)0 (2) 3300 C (1)3300 (2) 0 D. (1)3300 (2) 3300

Feedback K/A: 261000 A3.01 Ability to monitor automatic operations of the STANDBY GAS TREATMENT SYSTEM including:

System flow (CFR: 41.7 /45.7)

ROISRO Rating:

3.2/3.3 Objective:

CLS-LP-10 Obj. 4 Given plant conditions determine if SBGTs should have initiated.

Reference:

SD-i 0, Standby Gas Treatment System OP-I 0, Standby Gas Treatment System Operating Procedure Cog Level:

High Explanation:

With the B SBGT train in STBY it will not auto start, this is more like an Off position. There is an auto start signal from high DW pressure and flow should be verified to be greater than 3000 scfm. The control room indicators scale is from 0 to 4500 scfm. Normal system flow is 3300 scfm.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because if there was not an initiation signal this would be correct.

Choice B: Plausible because there is an initiation signal but only one train will operate. If the examinee thinks only B only will start then it would indicate 3300 scfm.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because there is a initiation signal and the examinee may think that both trains would initiate. The standby position is a common misunderstanding, this is actually an OFF position.

27. 262001 K6.01 001 Which one of the following identifies how the manually initiated, automatically executed fast bus transfer capability is affected following a loss of 125V DC Panel 9A?

The fast bus transfer will (1) if attempted for 4 KV Bus I B.

The fast bus transfer will (2) if attempted for 4 KV Bus IC.

A. (1)occur (2) occur B (l)occur (2) not occur C. (1)notoccur (2) occur D. (I)notoccur (2) not occur Feedback K/A: 262001 K6.01 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the following will have on the A.C.

ELECTRICAL DISTRIBUTION:

D.C. power (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)

ROISRO Rating:

3.1/3.4 Objective:

CLS-LP-50.1 Obj 7 Given plant conditions, predict the effect a loss of DC control power will have on the 4160 VAC System.

Reference:

01-50, 125/250 and 24/48 VDC Electrical Load Lists SD-50.1, 4160 VAC Electrical System Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

BOP Bus I B has AUTO control power transfer capability where 1 C and 1 D do not.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the auto transfer of control power will occur on I B, but will not on IC and D.

Recent plant mods have removed some of the auto transfer capabilities on some of the DC control power arrangements (E-busses require a manual transfer of control power).

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation.

Choice C: Plausible because the examinee may have the logics reversed.

Choice D: Plausible because the auto bus transfer will not occur on IC and D, but it will on lB. Recent plant mods have removed some of the auto transfer capabilities on some of the DC control power arrangements.

28. 262001 K6.02 001 Which one of the following completes the statements below if a Loss of Offsite Power (LOOP) occurs on Unit Two with DG4 under clearance?

RHR Pump 2B (1) lost its power supply.

The 2-E11-FOI5B, LPCI Inboard Injection Valve, (2) lost its power supply.

A. (1)has (2) has BY (1) has (2) has not C. (1) has not (2) has D. (1)hasnot (2) has not Feedback K/A: 262001 K6.02 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the following will have on the A.C.

ELECTRICAL DISTRIBUTION:

Off-site power (CFR: 41.7 / 45.7)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.6/3.9 Objective:

CLS-LP-39 Obj 9c Describe the effects on the plant if one or more of the EDGs failed to start during the following conditions:

LOOP

Reference:

SD-17, Residual Heat Removal System Cog Level:

High Explanation:

B RHR Pump receives power from E4 which is feed by DG #4. since it has failed then E4 would be de-energized and the B RHR Pump would have no power. The B Loop injection valves are powered from the same division, but opposite units E Bus. That would be E2, which does have power for the injection valves and D RHR pump.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible the B Pump has lost power and one would logically think that the B Loop would be powered by the Div II power source, which is correct except that it is from Unit 1 Div II.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the D RHR has not lost power and one would logically think that the B Loop would be powered by the Div II power source, which is correct except that it is from Unit 1 Div Choice D: Plausible because the D RHR has not lost power and the injection valve has not lost power.

29. 2620&2G2.04.11 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power when a complete loss of Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) occurs.

Which one of the following completes both statements below?

After the loss of UPS, (1) of the symptoms listed in OAOP-02.O, Control Rod Malfu nction/Misposition, will be present.

lAW OAOP-12.O, Loss of Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) the TCC-V117, Main Turbine Oil Coolers TBCCW Outlet Isolation Valve, is required to be throttled (2)

A. (1)some (2) opened B (1)some (2) closed C. (1)none (2) opened D. (1)none (2) closed

Feedback KJA: 262002 G2.04.11 Knowledge of abnormal condition procedures.

Uninterruptable Power Supply (A.C./D.C.)

(CFR: 41.10 /43.5/45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.0/4.2 Objective:

CLS-LP-302G Obj. 4a Given plant conditions and any of the following AOPs, determine the required supplemental actions:

AOP-12.0, Loss of Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS)

Reference:

OAOP-12.0, Loss of Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS)

Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

AOP-12 directs reference to AOP-02. the loss of four rod and the full core display are symptoms for AOP-02. An action in AOP-12 is IF necessary, THEN THROTTLE CLOSED MAIN TURBINE OIL COOLERS TBCCW OUTLET ISOLATION VALVE, TCC-V117, to maintain normal turbine lube oil temperature Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because some of AOP-02 symptoms are present but the TCC valve is closed not opened.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation.

Choice C: Plausible because it is not readily apparent that AOP-02 would be entered, and the TCC valve is throttled closed not open.

Choice D: Plausible because it is not readily apparent that AOP-02 would be entered.

3&. 263000 1(201 001 Which one of the following identifies the power supply to the Main Turbine Emergency Bearing Oil Pump (EBOP)?

A. 125 VDC Division I B. 125 VDC Division II C. 250 VDC Division I D 250 VDC Division II Feedback K/A: 263000 K2.01 Knowledge of electrical power supplies to the following:

Major D.C. loads (CFR: 41.7)

ROISRO Rating:

3.1/3.4 Objective:

CLS-LP-26.1 Obj. 5c Identify the electrical distribution system which powers the following: Emergency Bearing Oil Pump

Reference:

SD-26.1, Main Turbine Lube Oil and Lube Oil Storage and Conditioning Systems Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

The emergency bearing oil pump (EBOP) is provided to supply oil to the bearings of the main turbine when all ac power is lost. The EBOP is driven by a dc motor powered from 250 VDC 2(1)B.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because 125 VDC Div I is a potential DC source for an emergency pump Choice B: Plausible because 125 VDC Div II is a potential DC source for an emergency pump Choice C: Plausible because 250 VDC Div 1 is a potential DC source for an emergency pump Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

31. 264000 A1.01 002 During monthly load testing of DG3, engine outlet lube oil temperature stabilizes at 182° F. A manual adjustment to LO-TCV-2077, Lube Oil Automatic Temperature Control Valve, causes DG3 to trip and lockout on high lube oil temperature.

Prior to the lockout being reset, a line break in the drywell results in the following plant conditions:

RPV water level +40 inches RPV pressure 430 psig Drywell pressure 14.5 psig Bus E3 Energized from Off-Site power Which one of the following would be the response of DG3?

DG3 will:

A auto start and run with no operator action.

B. auto start only after the lockout relay is manually reset.

C. remain tripped because no auto start signal is present.

D. remain tripped because of the high lube oil temperature trip.

Feedback K/A: 264000 Al .01 Ability to predict andlor monitor changes in parameters associated with operating the EMERGENCY GENERATORS (DIESELIJET) controls including:

Lube oil temperature (CFR: 41.5 /45.5)

ROISRO Rating:

3.0/3.0 Objective:

CLS-LP-39 Obj. 18 Describe the effect of an auto start signal on a diesel generator that was tripped and locked out.

Reference:

SD-39, Emergency Diesel Generators OP-39, Emergency Diesel Generators Operating Procedure Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Engine lockout is auto reset by any auto start signal. LOCA start signal present based on hi drywell pressure concurrent with low reactor pressure. The hi lube oil temperature trip is bypassed with any auto start signal present.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible for the examinee to think the lockout must be reset prior to D/G auto start Choice C: Plausible because the examinee may not diagnose the presence of a LOCA start signal Choice D: Plausible for the examinee to think the high lube oil temp trip would prevent an engine start for engine protection

32. 264000 K1:07 001 During accident conditions on Unit Two the following sequence of events occur:

Time (seconds) Event 0 Drywell pressure rises above the scram setpoint 2 Complete Loss of Off-site Power occurs 8 Reactor pressure is 400 psig 10 DGs energize their respective E Buses 15 Reactor water level drops below LL3 Which one of the following identifies the earliest time that the LPCI pumps will auto start?

A. 10 seconds B. 15 seconds C. 18 seconds Dv 20 seconds

Feedback K/A: 264000 K1.07 Knowledge of the physical connections and/or cause effect relationships between EMERGENCY GENERATORS (DIESEL/JET) and the following:

Emergency core cooling systems (CFR: 41.2 to 41.9 I 45.7 to 45.8)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.9/4.1 Objective:

CLS-LP-17 Obj 07 Given plant conditions, determine if the RHR System should automatically initiate in the LPCI mode.

Reference:

SD-17, Residual Heat Removal System Cog Level:

High Explanation:

The RHR System will automatically start in the LPCI mode of operation in response to either of two initiation signals: reactor vessel low level (LL 3) or drywell high pressure coincident with reactor vessel low pressure.

All RHR Pumps automatically start 10 seconds from receipt of the initiation signal if the Emergency busses are energized (off-site power available). If off-site power is not available, the pumps automatically start 10 seconds from the time the Emergency Diesel Generators re-energize the busses.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because this is when LPCI power becomes available with a LOCA signal present Choice B: Plausible because this is when the initiation signal is present from LL3.

Choice C: Plausible because this is applying the 10 second time delay from when the initiation signal is present from hi DW pressure and low reactor pressure and would have started the pumps if electrical power was present.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.

33. 272000K3.05 002 Unit One is operating with the AOG system bypassed.

The AOG-HCV-1 02, AOG Bypass Valve, control switch is in Auto.

At 0800 hours0.00926 days <br />0.222 hours <br />0.00132 weeks <br />3.044e-4 months <br /> the B SJAE Rad Monitor loses power.

At 0820 hours0.00949 days <br />0.228 hours <br />0.00136 weeks <br />3.1201e-4 months <br /> the A SJAE Rad Monitor reaches its hi hi radiation setpoint due to a valid condition.

Which one of the following identifies the earliest time that the AOG Bypass Valve will auto close?

A. 0800 B. 0815 C. 0820 Dv 0835 Feedback K/A: 272000 K3.05 Knowledge of the effect that a loss or malfunction of the RADIATION MONITORING System will have on following:

Offgas system (cFR: 41.5 / 45.3)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.5/3.7 Objective:

CLS-LP-11.0 Obj 5c Explain the effect that a loss/malfunction of the PRM System will have on the following: AOG System

Reference:

SD-i 1.0, Process Radiation Monitoring System Cog Level:

High Explanation:

AOG-HCV-102, AOG Bypass Valve, will auto close on a valid HI-HI, Lo or lnop trip signal from both detectors after a 15 minute time delay.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the examinee may believe that a loss of power to one rad monitor will initiate an isolation signal and not remember the 15 minute time delay.

Choice B: Plausible because the examinee may believe that a loss of power to one rad monitor will initiate an isolation signal and remember the 15 minute time delay.

Choice C: Plausible because the examinee may recognize the valid isolation signal but forget the 15 minute time delay.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.

34. 288000 K1.0 0tH Given the following plant conditions after a Loss of Off-Site Power to Unit One:

DGI Running at 3575 KW load DG2 Running at 3680 KW load RB HVAC Isolated The operator is directed to restart Reactor Building HVAC using three (3) supply fans (75 KW each) and three (3) exhaust fans (45 KW each).

Which one of the following identifies the impact on Diesel Generator loading if:

two supply fans and two exhaust fans are sequentially started from MCC 1XG and one supply fan and one exhaust fan are sequentially started from MCC 1XH?

A. DGI only maximum load will be exceeded.

B. DG2 only maximum load will be exceeded.

C. DGI and DG2 maximum load will be exceeded.

Dv DGI and DG2 will remain within maximum load limits.

Feedback K/A: 288000 KI .04 Knowledge of the physical connections and/or cause effect relationships between PLANT VENTILATION SYSTEMS and the following:

AC Electrical (CFR: 41.2 to 41.9 / 45.7 to 45.8)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.6/2.6 Objective:

CLS-LP-39 Obj. 17a Given plant conditions, OP-39, OP-50.1, AOP-36.2, and/or ASSD procedures, determine the limits for the following DG parameters: Generator kW.

Reference:

AOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or 480V E-Buses Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Max loading during LOOP is 110% of rated (3500KW x 110% = 3850KW). 2 sets from MCC IXG (DGI) adds 240 kw for total of 3815 KW. 1 set from MCC 1XH (DG2) adds 120KW for total of 3800 KW.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible if the examinee adds the wrong values for the fans, supply vs exhaust, then this answer would be correct.

Choice B: Plausible if the examinee thinks that 1XG is from DG2, then this answer would be correct.

Choice C: Plausible if the examinee considers the rated value instead of the emergency value for the answer.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.

35. 290002 G2.04.46 002 Two is at rated power when the following alarm is received:

RPVFLANGE SEAL LEAK Which one of the following identifies:

(1) the 0-ring that has failed and (2) the type of instrumentation used to detect the failure?

A. (1)outer (2) pressure switch B. (1)outer (2) temperature switch C (1) inner (2) pressure switch D. (1)inner (2) temperature switch

Feedback K/A: 290002 02.04.46 Ability to verify that the alarms are consistent with the plant conditions.

Reactor Vessel Internals (CFR: 41.10 /43.5 / 45.3 / 45.12)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.2/4.2 Objective:

CLS-LP-01 Obj 3 Describe the plant conditions that could cause RPV Flange Seal Leak (Annunciator A-02, window 5-6) to annunciate.

Reference:

SD-01 .2, Reactor Vessel Instrumentation Cog Level:

High Explanation:

The head to vessel flange seal is made up by two concentric 0-rings that are installed in grooves. A drilled passage connects the annulus between the two 0-rings to a pressure switch. If the pressure rises to 600 psig due to the inner 0-ring leaking, an annunciator, A-02 5-6 RPV FLANGE SEAL LEAK, will alarm by the pressure switch closing. Failure of both flange seals is detected by the primary containment leak detection system.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible if examinee has a misconception of the 0-ring configuration Choice B: Plausible if examinee has a misconception of the 0-ring configuration.

Plausible because some plant leakage detection systems monitor for system process temperature indications rather than pressure.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because some plant leakage detection systems monitor for system process temperature indications rather than pressure.

36. 290003 K4.01 001 Which one of the following valid alarm conditions will result in an auto start of the CREV System?

A. PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HI-HI B. AREA RAD RADWASTE BLDG HIGH C. REACTOR VESS LO LEVEL TRIP D PRI CTMT PRESS HI TRIP Feedback K/A: 290003 K4.0l Knowledge of CONTROL ROOM HVAC design feature(s) andlor interlocks which provide for the following:

System initiations/reconfiguration: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.7)

ROISRO Rating:

3.1/32 Objective:

CLS-LP-37 Obj. 4a Given plant conditions determine if signals exist that would cause the following to automatically start/open:

Emergency Recirculation Fans

Reference:

SD-37, Control Building HVAC System Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

An automatic start signal is initiated by any of the following:

a. Any one of three Area Radiation Monitors (1) Control Room (Channel 1)1 mr/hr +/- .O5mr increasing (2) Control Building Ventilation Intake (Channel 2 or 3) 7 mr/hr +/-.O5mr increasing
b. LOCA Signal detected by one of the following:

(1) Reactor Water Low Level 2 (2) Drywell Pressure High Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the LOCA signal that does start CREV comes from the same device that initiates the Group 6 isolation and the RB HI HI Rad is an input into the Group 6 isolation logic and not into the start logic for CREV.

Choice B: Plausible because radwaste is located below the main control room and control room rad signals do initiate CREV.

Choice C: Plausible since this is a low level scram setpoint and not the LL2 signal that would initiate CREV.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

37. 295001 K1.03 002 Which one of the following completes the statement below?

A single recirculation pump trip from rated power will cause the value of Critical Power to (1) and Thermal Limits (2) required to be adjusted lAW Technical Specification 3.4.1, Reactor Coolant System (RCS), for continued power operation.

(Assume operation greater than 24 hours2.777778e-4 days <br />0.00667 hours <br />3.968254e-5 weeks <br />9.132e-6 months <br />)

A. (1) rise (2) are B. (1) rise (2) are not C (1) lower (2) are D. (1) lower (2) are not

Feedback K/A: 295001 K1.03 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to PARTIAL OR COMPLETE LOSS OF FORCED CORE FLOW CIRCULATION:

Thermal limits (CFR: 41.8 to 41.10)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.6/4.1 Objective:

CLS-LP-1 06A*1 3B Describe how a change in each of the following affects critical power: Mass flow rate

Reference:

OPS-FUN-LP-104-I (Thermal Limits)

Tech Spec 3.4.1, Reactor Coolant System (RCS)

Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Critical Power is equal to the bundle power at which OTB occurs. As actual power goes down, void fraction increases. This causes critical power to lower, although not as significantly as actual power.

Since actual power drops further than critical power, the Critical Power Ratio gets larger.

CPR= CP/AP LCO 3.4.1 states:

Two recirculation loops with matched flows shall be in operation, OR One recirculation loop may be in operation provided the following limits are applied when the associated LCO is applicable:

a. LCO 3.2.1, AVERAGE PLANAR LINEAR HEAT GENERATION RATE (APLHGR), single loop operation limits specified in the COLR;
b. LCO 3.2.2, MINIMUM CRITICAL POWER RATIO (MCPR), single loop operation limits specified in the COLR;
c. LCO 3.2.3, LINEAR HEAT GENERATION RATE (LHGR), single loop operation limits specified in the COLR; and
d. LCO 3.3.1.1, Reactor Protection System (RPS) Instrumentation, Function 2.b (Average Power Range Monitors Simulated Thermal PowerHigh), Allowable Value of Table 3.3.1.1-1 is reset for single loop operation.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible if examinee has a misconception of Critical Power and the effects of lower core flow on CP. Part (2) is correct.

Choice B: Plausible if examinee has a misconception of Critical Power and the effects of lower core flow on CP. Plausible if the examinee is not aware of the requirements of TS 3.4.1 or is not familiar with the time requirement for the applicable action statement.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible if the examinee is not aware of the requirements of TS 3.4.1 or is not familiar with the time requirement for the applicable action statement.

38.295003 A2.05 001 Both Units were operating at rated power when ALL switchyard PCB position indications turn green.

Diesel Generator status:

DG1 Running loaded DG2 Under clearance DG3 Running loaded DG4 Tripped on low lube oil pressure Which one of the following identifies the AOP(s) that Unit One and Unit Two are required to perform?

Unit One is required to perform (1)

Unit Two is required to perform (2)

A (1) OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV EBuses (2) OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses B. (1) OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses (2) OAOP-36.2, Station Blackout C. (1) OAOP-36.2, Station Blackout (2) OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses D. (1) OAOP-36.2, Station Blackout (2) OAOP-36.2, Station Blackout

Feedback K/A: 295003 A2.05 Ability to determine andlor interpret the following as they apply to PARTIAL OR COMPLETE LOSS OF A.C. POWER:

Whether a partial or complete loss of A.C. power has occurred (CFR: 41 .10/43.5/45.13)

ROISRO Rating:

3.9/4.2 Objective:

LOlCLSLP303A*001 Given plant conditions and control room indications, determine if AOP 36.2, Station Blackout Procedure, should be entered.

Reference:

AOP-36.2, Station Blackout AOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or 480V E-Buses Cog Level:

High Explanation:

This meets the KA because the student will have to determine that all green lights is a LOOP on BOTH Units then determine that neither unit is in Station Blackout since each unit has a running and loaded DIG available.

Switchyard PCB green position indication shows all PCB are OPEN, which indicates Loss of J offsite power.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because examinee could misdiagnose unit specific DIG availability Choice C: Plausible because examinee could misdiagnose unit specific DIG availability Choice D: Plausible because examinee could confuse a loss of off-site power on both units as an entry condition for AOP-36.2 on both units

39. 295004 At02 001 Following a loss of feedwater on Unit Two, HPCI and RCIC are being used to restore Reactor water level to the normal band.

Then a loss of Battery Bus 2A-1 and 2A-2 occurs.

Which one of the following completes the statement below due to the conditions above?

(1) continues to operate and if RPV water level reaches 211 inches (2)

A. (1)HPCI (2) HPCI will still auto trip B. (1) HPCI (2) HPCI will not auto trip C. (1)RCIC (2) RCIC will still auto shutdown D (1) RCIC (2) RCIC will not auto shutdown

Feedback K/A: 295004 A1.02 Ability to operate and/or monitor the following as they apply to PARTIAL OR COMPLETE LOSS OF D.C. POWER:

Systems necessary to assure safe plant shutdown (CFR: 41.7 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.8/4.1 Objective:

CLS-LP-1 9*26B Given plant conditions and one of the following events, use plant procedures to determine the actions required to control and/or mitigate the consequences of the event: Loss of DC power CLS-LP-1 6*1 5E Given plant conditions, predict the RCIC System response to the following conditions:DC power failure

Reference:

AOP-39.0, Loss of C Power 01-50, 125/250 and 24/48 VDC Uectrical Load Lists Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Division I DC is required for HPCI start and operation. A loss of Division I DC will make the RCIC inboard isolation logic inoperable which results in failure of the steam supply valve closure on high vessel level.

A loss of Div II DC would make RCIC fail and allows for HPCI vessel high water level trip logic to be partially made up (one out of two).

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because HPCI and RCIC are impacted by a loss of either Division of DC. A loss of Div II DC will allow HPCI to continue to operate and will trip on high vessel water level. RCIC flow would be lost on loss of Div II DC.

Choice B: Plausible because HPCI and RCIC are impacted by a loss of either Division of DC. A loss of Div II DC will allow HPCI to continue to operate and will trip on high vessel water level. RCIC flow would be lost on loss of Div II DC.

Choice C: Plausible because HPCI and RCIC are impacted by a loss of either Division of DC. RCIC would continue to inject but would not trip on high vessel water level with a loss of Div I DC.

HPCI flow would be lost.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

40. 295005 AI:07 001 Unit One is operating at rated power with DGI running loaded for a monthly load test.

A fault trips the Main Generator Primary Lockout relay.

BOP Bus IC fails to transfer on the generator lockout due to failure of the SAT supply breaker to close.

Which one of the following identifies the status of the El Bus that would be reported to the CRS?

El is energized from:

A. DGI with off-site power available.

B. both DGI and from off-site power.

C. DGI with off-site power unavailable.

D off-site power with DGI running unloaded.

Feedback K/A: 295005 A1.07 Ability to operate and/or monitor the following as they apply to MAIN TURBINE GENERATOR TRIP:

AC. electrical distribution (CFR: 41.7 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.3/3.3 Objective:

CLSLP27*05 State the effect that actuation of a main generator lockout relay will have on the Main Generator and station loads.

CLS-LP-39 /Objectives 3, 7, 12 Given plant conditions, determine if EDGs will automatically start.

Given plant conditions, determine if:

a. EDG output breaker will trip
b. E Bus Master/Slave breakers will trip with the EDG in manual mode Given plant conditions, determine if permissives are satisfied for the EDG output breaker to close (either automatically or manually).

Reference:

SD-39, Emergency Diesel Generators, Sections 3.2.4, 3.2.6, 3.2.7, and 3.2.10 Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Based on the conditions the RO will have to determine the status in order to report to the CRS which meets the monitoring AC electrical on a generator trip.

Generator primary lockout is a loss of off-site power signal to DG auto start logic. All four DGs will auto start. The DG1 auto start signal will trip the DG1 output breaker to allow the DG to transfer from the manual to auto mode of operation (governor, voltage regulator, trip circuits). The DG will then tie back onto the bus once the bus stripped interlock and bus undervoltage interlock is satisfied. Otherwise it will continue to run unloaded. Bus 1C fails to transfer from UAT to SAT on the trip. This results in loss of BOP bus IC but this bus feeds E2, not El so Bus El will remain powered from off-site power (BOP bus).

DG2 will auto start, tie to bus E2. Bus El is being powered from off-site power via BOP bus ID and the DG1 is running unloaded Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because if the peaking relays on the E Bus actuated and tripped the master/slave breakers. Peaking relays could actuate during a fast transfer with a DG in parallel if the turbine had tripped resulting in a backup lockout rather than a primary.

Choice B: Plausible because this would be the most likely configuration if the turbine tripped resulting in a backup generator lockout instead of a primary lockout (would not produce a LOOP signal).

Choice C: Plausible because since this would be the configuration if the BOP bus that failed to transfer to the SAT was bus 1 D rather than 1 C.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

41. 295006 K1.02 002 A scram has occurred on Unit Two with the following control rod positions:

Control Rods Fully inserted with the following exceptions:

26-31 02 26-23 02 22-35 02 22-27 02 18-23 02 18-39 02 30-23 02 30-35 02 34-31 02 Which one of the following choices completes the statement below?

The reactor (1) remain shutdown under all conditions without boron.

The operator must insert the control rods (2) lAW LEP-02.

AY (1)will (2) by driving rods using RMCS B. (1)will (2) by placing the individual scram test switches to the Scram position C. (1)will not (2) by driving rods using RMCS D. (1)will not (2) by placing the individual scram test switches to the Scram position

Feedback K/A: 295006 K1.02 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to SCRAM:

Shutdown margin (CFR: 41.8 to 41.10)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.4/3.7 Objective:

Reference:

01-37.4, Reactor Vessel Control Procedure Basis Document LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

The given conditions state that 9 control rods are at position 02. All other control rods are fully inserted.

Per 01-37.4, Analysis has also shown that the reactor will remain shutdown under all conditions if no more than 10 control rods are withdrawn to or beyond position 02.

These conditions are meet making the correct response to part (1) The reactor WILL remain shutdown under all conditions without boron.

Step 23 of the Reactor Scram Procedure directs Alternate Control Rod Insertion per LEP-02.

The steps in LEP-02 will guide you to Section 1.0 which will direct driving control rods using RMCS.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because attempting to insert control rods using the Scram Test Switches is an option available in LEP-02 applicable to other ATWS conditions.

Choice C: Plausible if the examinee is unsure of the number of allowable rods at 02 to satisfy the shutdown under all conditions without boron statement.

Choice D: Plausible if the examinee is unsure of the number of allowable rods at 02 to satisfy the shutdown under all conditions without boron statement.

Plausible because attempting to insert control rods using the Scram Test Switches is an option available in LEP-02 applicable to other ATWS conditions.

42. 295008 K1.01 001 Which one of the following completes the statement below?

Excessive moisture carryover is caused by (1) reactor water level and will result in (2)

A. (1) high (2) increased jet pump vibrations B (1) high (2) increased erosion wear of turbine blades C. (1) low (2) reduced Reactor Recirc pump NPSH D. (1) low (2) increased erosion wear of turbine blades

Fcedback K/A: 295008 K1.01 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to HIGH REACTOR WATER LEVEL:

Moisture carryover (CFR:41.8to41.10)

ROISRO Rating:

3.0/3.2 Objective:

CLSLP01*08 With regard to moisture carryover:

a. Define the term.
b. Describe how it is affected by reactor water level.
c. Describe the adverse affects.

Reference:

SD-01, Nuclear Boiler System, Section 2.1.14.a Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Moisture carryover is defined as that moisture entrained in the steam exiting the Reactor Pressure Vessel.

The amount of carryover is affected by the reactor water level. If the water level is too high, the water draining out of the separators tends to back up resulting in increased moisture out the top of the separators. Too much moisture will overload the steam dryers with a resultant decrease in steam quality exiting the reactor vessel. This decreased steam quality will cause increased erosion of turbine blades.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible if examinee confuses the effects of excessive carryover with the effects of moisture carryunder.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible if examinee confuses carryover with carryunder and if examinee confuses the effects of excessive carryover with the effects of moisture carryunder.

Choice D: Plausible if examinee confuses carryover with carryunder.

-43. 295014 A2.03 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power when the following conditions are observed by the RO:

Core Thermal Power initially drops below and then stabilizes slightly above 100%.

Main Generator electrical output (MWe) lowers.

Which one of the following events caused the parameter changes observed above?

A. A single control rod drop.

B An open Safety Relief Valve.

C. Reactor Recirculation Pump 2A speed step change of 2%.

D. 4A Feedwater Heater Extraction steam isolation.

Feedback K/A: 295014 A2.03 Ability to determine andlor interpret the following as they apply to INADVERTENT REACTIVITY ADDITION:

Cause of reactivity addition (CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.0/4.3 Objective:

CLSLP302M*01 c Given plant conditions, determine if the following Abnormal Operating Procedure(s) (AOP5) should be entered: OAOP 30.0, Safety/Relief Valve Failures

Reference:

SD-20, Automatic Depressurization System (ADS)

Cog Level:

High Explanation:

An SRV opening initially reduces reactor pressure (increasing Voids) causing reactor power to lower. The EHC system senses lower PAM pressure and reduces TCV position to restore pressure. This causes reduced steam flow to the Main Turbine and lower Generator MW output throughout. Reduced steam flow to MT causes less extraction steam flow to FWHs, causing reduction in final feedwater temperature to the reactor, which combined with pressure restoration, raises reactor power above the initial power level.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because a control rod drop does provide positive reactivity addition. Generator MWe would also increase.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because 2A RR pump speed rising would provide positive reactivity addition.

Generator MWe would also increase.

Choice D: Plausible because extraction steam isolation does cause feedwater temperature reduction positive reactivity addition. Generator MWe would also increase. A FWH tube leak would look similar to the SRV opening which is different from the extraction isolation.

44. 295015 K3.01 002 Which one of the following choices completes both statements lAW LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion?

The RWM is bypassed using a (1)

The reason that the RWM is bypassed is because the (2)

A (1) keylock switch (2) Emergency Rod In Notch Override switch will not work when an Insert Block exists B. (1) joystick (2) Emergency Rod In Notch Override switch will not work when an Insert Block exists C. (1) keylock switch (2) Mode Switch in Shutdown generates a Control Rod Block D. (1) joystick (2) Mode Switch in Shutdown generates a Control Rod Block

Feedback -

K/A: 295015 K3.0l Knowledge of the reasons for the following responses as they apply to INCOMPLETE SCRAM:

Bypassing rod insertion blocks (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)

ROISRO Rating:

3.4/3.7 Objective:

CLSLP007*02d State the purpose(s) of the following RWM components: Bypass Switch

Reference:

LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

LEP-02 is the procedure the we use to insert rods that have failed to insert on a scram. Direction is given to bypass the RWM which is accomplished by using a keylock switch in the RWM display console.

The RWM is bypassed to override the RWM Enforced Insert Block, allowing rods to be inserted using the Emergency Rod In Notch Override Switch.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because many other components are bypasses using a joystick controller.

Choice C: Plausible if examinee confuses the Shutdown withdraw block with an insert block.

Choice D: Plausible because many other components are bypasses using a joystick controller.

Plausible if examinee confuses the Shutdown withdraw block with an insert block.

45: 295016G 2.04.01 002 Control Room evacuation has been directed by the Shift Manager due to toxic gas.

Which one of the following identifies the next required immediate operator action that must be performed lAW OAOP-32.0, Plant Shutdown From Outside the Control Room, (for Unit One) once the main turbine has tripped?

A. Wait until steam flow is less than 3 x 106 lb/hr, then place the reactor mode switch to Shutdown.

B Immediately place the reactor mode switch to Shutdown C. Trip both Reactor Recirculation Pumps D. Manually Scram the reactor

Feedback K/A: 295016G 2.04.01 Knowledge of EOP entry conditions and immediate action steps.

Control Room Abandonment (CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)

There is no EOP for Control Room Abandonment; AOP-32. 0 does have entry conditions and immediate actions. K/A applied to A OP.

RO/SRO Rating:

4.6/4.8 Objective:

CLSLP302E*002 List the Immediate Operator Actions required in accordance with OAOP-32.0, Plant Shutdown from Outside Control Room.

Reference:

AOP-32.0, Plant Shutdown from Outside Control Room Cog Level:

High Explanation:

AOP-32 immediate actions are to be performed in a specific order so as to not challenge equipment.

1. MANUALLY SCRAM the reactor.
2. TRIP the main turbine.
3. OBSERVE auxiliary power transferred to the SAT.
4. Unit 1 only: PLACE the Reactor Mode Switch to SHUTDOWN.
5. Unit 2 only: WHEN steam flow is less than 3 x 106 lb/hr, THEN PLACE the Reactor Mode Switch to SHUTDOWN.
6. TRIP both Reactor Recirculation Pumps.
7. REDUCE reactor pressure to approximately 700 psig using the bypass valve opening jack.
8. WHEN reactor pressure reaches approximately 700 psig, THEN PLACE the control switches for the INBOARD and OUTBOARD MSIVS to CLOSE.
9. PLACE Mode Selector Switches for Condensate Booster Pumps in MAN.
10. PLACE Mode Selector Switches for the Condensate Pumps in MAN.
11. GO TO I (2)EOP-01.-RSP AND PERFORM CONCURRENTLY as many of the actions as possible prior to evacuation.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because this is a required action and the examinee may confuse the required sequence of actions.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because this is a required action and the examinee may confuse the required sequence of actions.

Choice D: Plausible because this is a required action and the examinee may confuse the required sequence of actions.

46. 295018 A1.02 001 A manual reactor Scram was performed on Unit Two following a complete loss of RBCCW.

Which one of the following identifies the allowances for operating a CRD Pump under these conditions without cooling water flow lAW OAOP-1 6.0, RBCCW System Failure?

The CRD Pump can be operated:

A. for a maximum of 1.5 minutes B. for a maximum of 10 minutes C for a maximum of 20 minutes D. Indefinitely Feedback K/A: 295018A1.02 Ability to operate andlor monitor the following as they apply to PARTIAL OR COMPLETE LOSS OF COMPONENT COOLING WATER:

System loads (CFR: 41.7 / 45.6)

ROISRO Rating:

3.3/3.4 Objective:

CLSLP3O2H*O1 2a Given plant conditions and entry into any of the following AOPs, explain the basis for a specific caution, note, or series of procedure steps: OAOP-16.O, RBCCW System Failure

Reference:

OAOP-16, RBCCW System Failure Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

A loss of RBCCW will result in elevated CRD pump component temperatures and could possibly lead to CRD pump failure. Both pumps should be tripped if a total loss of RBCCW occurs, but may be run for up to 20 minutes without RBCCW Cooling if directed by the SRO for rod insertions or RPV level control.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because Reactor Recirculation pumps must be shutdown within 90 seconds (1.5 minutes) with a loss of seal injection and seal cooling flow.

Choice B: Plausible because Reactor Recirculation pumps are allowed continued operation for a maximum of 10 minutes with no RBCCW cooling flow.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because plant OE has shown that a CRD pump can run indefinitely without RBCCW cooling.

47. 2950 19G 2.02.37 002 Unit Two is operating at rated power. The Non-Interruptible Air (RNA) header pressure has lowered to 65 psig due to a leak.

Which one of the following predicts how the Outboard MSIVs will be affected if the RNA header pressure remains at this value, including the reason?

The Outboard MSIVs will:

A. remain open due to the Pneumatic Nitrogen System supplying the valve actuators in Model.

B. remain open due to the Backup Nitrogen System automatically re-aligning to the valve actuators.

C eventually drift closed due to the diminishing pneumatic supply to the valve actuators.

D. immediately close due to an automatic isolation signal.

Feedb-ack KJA: 295019G 2.02.37 Ability to determine operability and/or availability of safety related equipment.

Partial or Complete Loss of Instrument Air (CFR: 41.7 /43.5 / 45.12)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.6/4.6 Objective:

CLSLP25*08b Given plant conditions, predict the effect that the following will have on the Main Steam System: Loss of Reactor Non-interruptible Air (RNA)/PNS/Backup Nitrogen.

Reference:

SD-46, Pneumatic Systems, Section 4.2.4 Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

The pneumatic sources for the outboard MSIVs are Reactor Building Non-Interruptible Air (RNA) System Division I and Division II. The pneumatic sources for the inboard MSIVs are Pneumatic Nitrogen System (PNS) Division I and Division II when operating in mode I and (RNA) System Division I and Division II when shutdown. Unlike the SRVs, a loss of PNS does not result in lining up the BU N2 System to the pneumatic operators. An air accumulator located between the MSIV air operator and the check valves provides backup operating air. The capacity of the accumulator is sufficient for the air operator to exercise the valve through one-half of a cycle (open-to-closed or closed-to-open) should the supply air to the operator be interrupted.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible if examinee confuses Inboard pneumatic supply with Outboard pneumatic supply.

Choice B: Plausible because backup nitrogen is capable of supplying the Inboard valves but not the Outboard.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible there are automatic component isolations associated with the plant Pneumatic System. This is not one.

48. 295020G 204.01 001 Unit Two has entered the RSP due to an inadvertent Group I isolation.

RCIC is the only injection source available.

SRVs are being used for pressure control.

Reactor water level is 160 inches and lowering.

Which one of the following is the first Suppression Pool Temperature that requires POOP entry and which additional EOPs (if any) are required to be entered given these conditions?

A. 95°F None B 95°F RVCP C. 105°F None D. 105°F RVCP

Feedback K/A: 295020G 2.04.01 Knowledge of EOP entry conditions and immediate action steps.

Inadvertent Containment Isolation (CFR: 41.10 /43.5 /45.13)

The EOPs at Brunswick do not have any immediate operator actions, so the question is written for only the EOP entry conditions.

RO/SRO Rating:

4.6/4.8 Objective:

LOl-CLS-LP-300-L Obj. 2 Given plant conditions, determine if the Primary Containment Control Procedure should be entered

Reference:

PCCP and RVCP Cog Level:

High Explanation:

EOP-02-PCCP requires entry at 95 degrees SP temperature or 105 degrees if testing is in progress. RSP requires entry into RVCP if level can not be maintained greater than 170 inches. There are no immediate operator actions for EOP entries.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because SPT is 95°F which is PCCP entry condition. Level is an entry into RVCP.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because SPT at 105°F is PCCP entry condition while testing. Though no testing is in progress. Level is an entry into RVCP.

Choice D: Plausible because SPT at 105°F is PCCP entry condition while testing. Though no testing is in progress.

- 49. 295021 A2.02 002 Following a loss of normal shutdown cooling, alternate shutdown cooling using SRVs is being performed per OAOP-1 5.0, Loss of Shutdown Cooling. Plant conditions are:

Reactor water level 400 (NO27NB)

Reactor pressure 175 psig Suppr chamber press 0.1 psig Suppr pool temp 80°F SRVs I open RHR Pumps 2A injecting to the RPV, 2D in suppression pool cooling Based on these plant conditions which one of the following is an action that is required lAW OAOP-15.0?

A. Reduce reactor water level.

B Open an additional SRV.

C. Reduce RHR injection flowrate.

D. Start2CRHRPump.

Feedback K/A: 295021 A2.02 Ability to determine and/or interpret the following as they apply to LOSS OF SHUTDOWN COOLING:

RHR/shutdown cooling system flow (CFR: 41.10 /43.5 / 45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.4/3.4 Objective:

CLSLP302L*01 a Given plant conditions, determine if the following Abnormal Operating Procedure(s) (AOP5) should be entered: AOP-15.0, Loss of Shutdown Cooling

Reference:

OAOP-15, Loss of Shutdown Cooling, Page 2 Symptoms Cog Level:

High Explanation:

With the given conditions, reactor pressure is greater than 164 psig than SP pressure. This requires an additional SRV to be opened to make sure that there is sufficient RHR flow through the core to provide cooling.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the student may think that lower level would solve the RHR head pressure concerns.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because they may think that RHR is pressurizing the reactor.

Choice D: Plausible because they may think that starting a second pump would allow more flow through the core.

50. 295023 K3.03 001 A spent fuel bundle has been dropped on the refuel floor. The following alarm is received:

PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HIGH Which one of the following predicts the status of Secondary Containment lAW OAOP-05.0, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation, and Airborne Activity and the reason?

Secondary Containment (1) in order to (2)

A. (1) has auto isolated and SBGT has auto started (2) provide an elevated/filtered release point B. (1) has auto isolated and SBGT has auto started (2) prevent an unmonitored release C (1) is required to be manually isolated and SBGT manually started (even though no auto actions have occurred)

(2) provide an elevated/filtered release point D. (1) is required to be manually isolated and SBGT manually started (even though no auto actions have occurred)

(2) prevent an unmonitored release

Feedback K/A: 295023 K3.03 Knowledge of the reasons for the following responses as they apply to REFUELING ACCIDENTS:

Ventilation isolation (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.3/3.6 Objective:

CLS-LP-1 09A*01 d Identify the following as related to a Refueling Accident: Plant design features that mitigate the consequences of the accident.

Reference:

001-37.9, Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

With the high alarm in there is no auto start signal for SBGT or an isolation signal. The AOP states that if new or spent fuel damage is suspected then isolate secondary containment and start SBGT.

The RB HVAC system discharges to the RB Roof. Even though this is greater than 180 feet up this is not considered an elevated release point. The only elevated release point at Brunswick is the Main Stack (310 chimney).

SBGT is the normal mechanism employed under post transient conditions to maintain reactor building pressure negative with respect to the atmosphere since the exhaust from this system is processed and directed to an elevated release point before being discharged to the environment.

This question requires the operator to have knowledge of the reason for ventilation isolation as related to a refueling accident therefore matches the referenced KA statement.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the high high is a secondary containment isolation and SBGT start signal not the high alone.

Choice B: Plausible because the high high is a secondary containment isolation and SBGT start signal not the high alone. The RB HVAC is a monitored release path.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because it is required to be isolated and SBGT started. The RB HVAC is a monitored release path.

51. 295024G 2.02.37 001 Following a loss of feedwater, HPCI initiated on low reactor water level then tripped on high reactor water level.

Current plant conditions are:

Reactor water level 180 inches, steady HPCI TURB TRIP alarm is sealed in HPCI TURB TRIP SQL ENER alarm is sealed in HPCI Initiation Signal/Reset white light is LIT HPCI High Water Level Signal Reset white light is LIT If drywell pressure rises to 3.0 psig with the above conditions present which one of the following is the minimum required operator action(s) (if any) to allow HPCI injection to the reactor?

A. No operator action is required.

B. Manually open E41-F006, HPCI Injection VIv.

C Depress the High Water Level Signal Reset push button.

D. Depress the High Water Level Signal Reset push button first and then manually open E41-F006, HPCI Injection VIv.

Feedback K/A: 295024G 2.02.37 Ability to determine operability and/or availability of safety related equipment.

High Drywell Pressure (CFR: 41 .7/43.5/45.12)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.6/4.6 Objective:

LOI-CLS-LP-19-A, Obj.3m Cog Level:

High Explanation:

A Reactor High Water Level trip is initiated and the signal seals-in when a high level is sensed by two instruments. Once the high level condition clears, the trip is reset by a subsequent Reactor Low Level 2 signal or upon depressing the Panel P601 High Level Trip Reset pushbutton. A High Drywell Pressure Initiation signal will not reset the High Water Level trip.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the high water level trip does automatically reset on LL2. If high water level is reset with an initiation signal (Hi DW Press), the system automatically aligns for injection without operator actions.

Choice B: Plausible because the high water level trip does automatically reset on LL2. Injection valve requires active initiation condition + Stop Valve (V8) & Steam Supply Valve (FOOl) not full closed to automatically open. Relay timing has caused HPCI initiation with injection valve not opening (LER 2-90-015).

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because high water level does not automatically reset due to Hi DW Press. Injection valve requires active initiation condition + Stop Valve (V8) & Steam Supply Valve (FOOl) not full closed to automatically open. Relay timing has caused HPCI initiation with injection valve not opening (LER 2-90-015)

52. 295025 A2.05 001 Unit One has been operating at rated power for the last 18 months.

A Loss of Off-site Power (LOOP) occurs and cannot be restored for 3 hours3.472222e-5 days <br />8.333333e-4 hours <br />4.960317e-6 weeks <br />1.1415e-6 months <br />.

The RSP directs the following step:

/ STABILIZE PRESS BELOW N 1050 PSIG WITH ONE OR MORE OF THE FOLLOWING SYSTEM&

  • SRV-IFA CONTINUOUS PNEUMATIC SUPPLY IS AVAILABLE USE OPENING 039 Which one of the following choices completes both statements below?

(1) are able to provide sufficient steam flow to stabilize reactor pressure after the LOOP (within the first 10 minutes).

Two hours later (2) can be used to maintain reactor pressure stable.

A. (1) OnlySRVs (2) MSL Drains B (1) Only SRVs (2) HPCI C. (1) HPCI and RCIC (combined)

(2) MSL Drains D. (1) HPCI and RCIC (combined)

(2) HPCI

Feedback K/A: 295025 A2.05 Ability to determine andlor interpret the following as they apply to HIGH REACTOR PRESSURE:

Decay heat generation (CFR: 41.10/43.5 / 45.13)

ROISRO Rating:

3.4/3.6 Objective:

CLS-LP-1 9*22c Given plant conditions, predict how a loss or malfunction of the HPCI System will affect the following:

Ability to remove decay heat

Reference:

001-37.3, Reactor Scram Procedure Basis Document Cog Level: High Explanation:

The amount of decay heat added depends on the power history of the reactor and the amount of time since the reactor was shut down. The number of fissions that have occurred determines the number of fission fragments in the core. Initial Decay Heat generation is equivalent to approximately 7% (beyond the capacity of HPCI) of the equilibrium power prior to the scram. 1 hour1.157407e-5 days <br />2.777778e-4 hours <br />1.653439e-6 weeks <br />3.805e-7 months <br /> following the scram, Decay Heat generation is equivalent to approximately 1% power (within the capacity of HPCI and maybe RCIC).

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because only SRVs is correct and the use of MSL drains is desired but is dependent upon Off-site power availability (CWIP5 needed to allow the main condenser to be available as a heat sink), Group I isolation signal remains due to low condenser vacuum with no 1OP-25 or EOP guidance to bypass and reset the isolation signal. Reopening MSIVs would not be procedurally allowed due to Cond/FW and OW systems not having power.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because HPCI and RCIC combined capacity is below 7% and the use of MSL drains is desired but is dependent upon Off-site power availability (CWIP5 needed to allow the main condenser to be available as a heat sink), Group I isolation signal remains due to low condenser vacuum with no 1OP-25 or EOP guidance to bypass and reset the isolation signal.

Reopening MSIVs would not be procedurally allowed due to Cond/FW and CW systems not having power.

Choice D: Plausible because HPCI and RCIC combined capacity is below 7% and decay heat generation lowering is correct.

53. 295026 A1.01 001 An ATWS has occurred on Unit One with the following plant conditions:

Reactor power 3%, slowly lowering RPV water level +60 inches, steady RPV pressure 300 psig Drywell pressure 3.0 psig Suppression pool temp 108°F Which one of the following identifies the minimum RHR logic requirement(s), if any, to place Suppression Pool Cooling in service under the current plant conditions?

Suppression Pool Cooling can be placed in service:

A. without the use of the Think Switch or the 2/3 Core Height LPCI Initiation Override keylock switch.

B only by placing the Think Switch in Manual.

C. only by placing the Think Switch in Manual [jt and then placing the 2/3 Core Height LPCI Initiation Override keylock switch in Manual Override.

D. only by placing the 2/3 Core Height LPCI Initiation Override keylock switch in Manual Override t and then placing the Think Switch in Manual.

Feedback - -

K/A: 295026 A1.01 Ability to operate and!or monitor the following as they apply to SUPPRESSION POOL HIGH WATER TEMPERATURE:

Suppression pool cooling (CFR: 41.7 /45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.1/4.1 Objective:

LOl-CLS-LP-01 7A*009 Given an RHR pump or valve, list the interlocks, permissives and/or automatic actions associated with the RHR pump or valve, including setpoints.

Reference:

IOP-17, RHR System Operating Procedure, Page 282, Attachment 8 Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Reactor pressure is less than 410# with DW pressure greater than 2# which would be a LOCA signal.

With a LOCA signal present, RHR can be placed in SPC with the use of the THINK switch.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because if the LOCA signal was not present this would be correct.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because incorrect recognition of LOCA signal conditions and wrong order of Cooling/Spray logic switch manipulation.

Choice D: Plausible because incorrect recognition of LOCA signal conditions and correct order of Cooling/Spray logic switch manipulation.

54. 295028 K3.05 001 DRYWLLL AVIERAGE AIR TEMP RLACI4ES ORYWELI SPRAY RFQUIREO 10 INITIATE A REACTOR SCRAM AND ENTER EOP- 01 DWfT Ii Which one of the following identifies:

(1) the Drywell Average Air Temperature that requires Drywell Sprays in step DW/T-09 and (2) one of the reasons for initiating a reactor scram at step DWIT-1 I lAW 001-37.8, Primary Containment Control Procedure Basis Document?

AY (1) 300°F (2) Operation at power with no recirc pumps operating is not allowed B. (1) 300°F (2) when the drywell coolers are secured a high drywell pressure scram signal is imminent C. (1) 340°F (2) Operation at power with no recirc pumps operating is not allowed D. (1) 340°F (2) when the drywell coolers are secured a high drywell pressure scram signal is imminent

Feedback K/A: 295028 K3.05 Knowledge of the reasons for the following responses as they apply to HIGH DRYWELL TEMPERATURE:

Reactor SCRAM (CFR: 41.5 /45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.6/3.7 Objective:

CLSLP300L*005g Given the Primary Containment Control Procedure, determine the appropriate operator actions if any of the following limits are approached or exceeded: Drywell Design Temperature Limit

Reference:

001-37.8, Primary Containment Control Procedure Basis Document, STEPS DW/T-09 through DW/T-17 Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

A reactor scram is inserted once it has been determined that drywell temperature cannot be maintained below 300°F and DW Spray is required. In order to spray the DW, the Reactor Recirculation Pumps and DW Coolers need to be secured. The reactor is not allowed operation at power without Recirculation Pumps in service. The scram requirement step satisfies shutting down the reactor to support tripping the Recirculation pumps.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because 300°F Drywell temperature is correct. Locking out the DW coolers is an action in the DW spray procedure but is not the reason for scramming the reactor.

Choice C: Plausible because not being able to restore and maintain below 300°F Drywell temperature means exceeding 300°F is allowed without scram but is the step requiring emergency depressurization and tripping the recirc pumps is correct.

Choice D: Plausible because not being able to restore and maintain below 300°F Drywell temperature means exceeding 300°F is allowed without scram but is the step requiring emergency depressurization and Locking out the DW coolers is an action in the DW spray procedure but is not the reason for scramming the reactor.

55.295030K2.09001 The Safety Parameter Display System (SPDS) Plant Status Matrix indicates Suppression Pool level is -31 .5 inches.

Which one of the following identifies the color code displayed by SPDS due to Suppression Pool level?

SPDS Suppression Pool level color code is:

A. Green B. Yellow C Red D. Cyan

Feedback -

K/A: 295030 K2.09 Knowledge of the interrelations between LOW SUPPRESSION POOL WATER LEVEL and the following:

SPDS/ERFIS/CRIDS/GDS: Plant-Specific (C FR: 41.7 / 45.8)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.5/2.8 Objective:

CLSLP060*002e Describe the basic operation of the ERFIS/SPDS Computer: Monitor Display Color Code

Reference:

SD-60 Rev.2, ERFIS DATA ACQUISITION, PROCESSING, AND DISPLAY Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Requires RO to know Tech Spec required Suppression Pool water level of -31 inches and -27 inches and that PCCP entry condition is SP level below -31 or above -27 (i.e. -31.2 or -26.8).

Knowing the specific level at which the display turns yellow just informs the operator that it is approaching the High/Low alarm (TS Limits).

SPDS display will be green when SP level is <-27.5 and > -30.5 the indication will turn yellow above

-27.5 or below -30.5 until the limit of -27 or -31is reached at which time the code turns red. The red code alerts the operator of possible PCCP entry condition. AOP-14 must be exited under these conditions.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because -31.5 is easily confused due to being a negative number which combined with greater than or equal signs make this value within the normal band and therefore Green.

Choice B: Plausible because for the same reason above except approaching alarm limit.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because a wrong assumption by the candidate beyond the stem of the question. All of the inputs to SPDS are operable.

56. 295031K3.03 001 Which one of the following completes the statement below lAW OEOP-01-UG, Users Guide?

Maintaining reactor water level at the jet pump suction with at least one core spray pump injecting into the reactor vessel at (1) gpm provides assurance that (2) exists.

A. (1) 4700 (2) adequate core cooling B. (1) 4700 (2) the minimum steam cooling water level C(1) 5000 (2) adequate core cooling D. (1) 5000 (2) the minimum steam cooling water level

Feedback K/A: 295031 K3.03 Knowledge of the reasons for the following responses as they apply to REACTOR LOW WATER LEVEL:

Spray cooling (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.1/4.4 Objective:

CLSLP300B*008 Define all EOP terms per the EOP definitions list in EOP-01-UG.

Reference:

EOP-01-UG, EOP Users Guide Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

The reason is adequate core cooling.

Adequate core cooling exists per EOP-UG if RPV level is at the jet pump suction with Core Spray injecting at @ 5000 gpm. Jet pump suction elevation is @ -59, specified in RVCP as -57.5 for instrument readability.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because 4700 gpm was the old flow requirement prior to EC#63657 and ACC is correct.

Choice B: Plausible because 4700 gpm was the old flow requirement prior to EC#63657 and MSCWL (LL4) is -30 inches (depressurized) and would not be applicable under these accident conditions.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because 5000 gpm is correct and MSCWL (LL4) is -30 inches (depressurized) and would not be applicable under these accident conditions.

57.295o32K2o2oo1 During accident conditions on Unit Two SCCP directed restarting Reactor Building HVAC lAW SEP-04, Reactor Building HVAC Restart Procedure.

Shortly following restart of the ventilation system the RO observes the following:

RX BLDG VENT TEMP HIGH in Alarm Rx Bldg Vent Exhaust Rad Monitor A indication 2.0 mR/hr Rx Bldg Vent Exhaust Rad Monitor B indication 3.5 mR/hr Based on the current conditions which one of the following:

(1) identifies the required action(s) and (2) the reason for these actions?

A. (1) Continue to operate Reactor Building HVAC (2) Performance of SEP-04 already defeated all isolation logic.

B. (1) Continue to operate Reactor Building HVAC (2) To ensure operability of the Rx Bldg Vent Exhaust Rad Monitors.

C. (1) Ensure auto isolation of Reactor Building HVAC (2) Performance of SEP-04 already defeated all isolation logic.

Dv (1) Ensure auto isolation of Reactor Building HVAC (2) The Rx Bldg Vent Exhaust Rad Monitor readings are no longer reliable.

Feedback K/A: 295032 K2.02 Knowledge of the interrelations between HIGH SECONDARY CONTAINMENT AREA TEMPERATURE and the following:

Secondary containment ventilation (CFR: 41.7 / 45.8)

ROISRO Rating:

3.6/3.7 Objective:

CLSLP300M(K)*o1 1 Given plant conditions involving Reactor Building HVAC system isolation and the Secondary Containment Control Procedure, determine if the Reactor Building HVAC system should be restarted.

Reference:

OEOP-01-SEP-04, Reactor Building HVAC Restart Procedure, Section 2.9 Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Rx Building Vent Temp Hi alarm indicates temperature in the exhaust duct 1 35°F deg. This exceeds the EQ of the Exh rad monitors. SEP-04 defeats RPV Low level, Hi DW pressure, and Main Stack rad Hi.

Rx Bldg Vent Rad Hi-Hi and Vent Temp Hi remain active and should have isolated RBHVAC and started both SBGT trains. SEP-04 also provides verification of these actions should either condition occur.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because SCCP provided guidance to restart RB HVAC which can be interpreted to mean under any conditions. Not ALL isolation logic is bypassed.

Choice B: Plausible because SCCP provided guidance to restart RB HVAC which can be interpreted to mean under any conditions. Rad monitor readings not being reliable is correct.

Choice C: Plausible because isolating RB HVAC is correct, but not ALL isolation logic is bypassed.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

58. 295033 A1.05 002 Following a Reactor Scram on Unit Two due to a loss of Off-site power (LOOP) the following plant conditions exist:

AREA RAD PXBLDG HIGH In alarm SOUTH RHR RM FLOOD LEVEL HI In alarm SOUTH CS RM FLOOD LEVEL HI In alarm Reactor Building 20 Rad Level Approaching Max Norm Operating Rad Reactor Building 20 Temperature Approaching Max Norm Operating Temp Based on the conditions above which one of the following identifies:

(1) the source of the leak and (2) the operator action required lAW SCCP?

A. (1)SDV (2) Open seven ADS valves.

B. (1)RBCCW (2) Open seven ADS valves.

C (1) SDV (2) Cooldown within Technical Specification limits D. (1)RBCCW (2) Cooldown within Technical Specification limits

Feedback K/A: 295033 A1.05 Ability to operate andlor monitor the following as they apply to HIGH SECONDARY CONTAINMENT AREA RADIATION LEVELS:

Affected systems so as to isolate damaged portions (CFR: 41.7 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating: 3.9/4.0 Objective: CLSLP300M*08a

8. Given plant conditions and the Secondary Containment Control Procedure, determine if any of the following are required:
a. Manual reactor scram
b. Consider Anticipation of Emergency Depressurization
c. Emergency Depressurization

Reference:

RSP, SCCP, 001-37.9 Cog Level: High Explanation:This meets the KA due to having to reset RPS to isolate the affected system (SDV leaking) thereby closing the scram valves which are the source of the leak causing the high rad levels in the reactor building.

Reactor Scram due to LOOP providing indications of SDV rupture.

The Maximum Normal Operating Values are the highest radiation levels expected to occur during normal plant operating conditions with all directly associated support and control systems functioning properly.

Separate radiation levels are provided for each Secondary Containment area.

Flood level Hi is MNOWL entry condition to SCCP. LOOP automatically provides Groups 1,2,3,6,8, & 10 isolations. No RWCU (Grp 3) isolation failure provided in stem. Based upon flood level status, along with rising 20 temperature and radiation leads to SDV rupture.

2 areas above MNOWL with primary system discharge requires Reactor Scram, cooldown <100 deg/hr, and consideration for anticipation of ED. No areas have reached Max Safe Operating Values, Emergency Depressurization is not required.

RPS can be reset and SCCP directs isolating the primary system discharge, main condenser not available due to LOOP Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the SDV is correct and if two areas above MSOWL with a primary system leak requires ED.

Choice B: Plausible because RBCCW leak could provide rising room levels, but area Rad and Temperature would not rise and if two areas above MSOWL with a primary system leak requires ED..

Choice C: Correct Answer Choice D: Plausible because RBCCW leak could provide rising room levels, but area Rad and Temperature would not rise and cooldown w/i TS limits is correct.

SRO Only Basis: N/A

59. 295035 A1.01 002 The unit is operating at rated power when the following alarms are received:

RXBLDG DIFF PRESS HIGH/LOW Which one of the following completes the statement below?

The RB Supply and Exhaust Fans (1) receive a trip signal and the SBGT System (2) receive a start signal.

A. (1)will (2)will B (1)will (2)will not C. (1) will not (2) will D. (1)wilI not (2)wiIl not

Feedback -

K/A: 295035 A1.01 Ability to operate andlor monitor the following as they apply to SECONDARY CONTAINMENT HIGH DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE:

Secondary containment ventilation system (CFR: 41.7 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.6/3.6 Objective:

CLS-LP-037. 1 *06a List the signals that will cause the following to automatically stop: Reactor Building supply fans

Reference:

APP UA-12 3-3 and SD-37.1 Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Fans trip on excessive building differential pressure (+4 inches or -4 inches) but SBGT does not start (APP UA-12 3-3)

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because RBHVAC will trip is correct and SBGT does not auto start.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because this alarm is easily confused with RB Static Press Duff Low which would not trip RB HVAC and SBGT trains auto starting to restore RB DP could be considered common sense but wrong.

Choice D: Plausible because this alarm is easily confused with RB Static Press Duff Low which would not trip RB HVAC and SBGT trains auto starting to restore RB DP could be considered common sense but wrong.

60. 295037 K1.03 002 Which one of the following identifies lAW LPC:

(1) the highest SLC tank level that will ensure the reactor is maintained shutdown during hot standby conditions and (2) the minimum pounds of Borax that will ensure the reactor will remain shut down irrespective of control rod position or reactor temperature?

A. (1)0%

(2) 2461 B. (1)32%

(2) 2461 C. (1)0%

(2) 6080 D (1)32%

(2) 6080

Feedbaek K/A: 295037 K1.03 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to SCRAM CONDITION PRESENT AND REACTOR POWER ABOVE APRM DOWNSCALE OR UNKNOWN:

Boron effects on reactor power (SBLC)

(CFR: 41.8 to 41.10)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.2/4.4 Objective:

CLSLP005*03 List the positive reactivity effects that must be overcome by SLC injection.

Reference:

001-37.5 Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

The Hot Shutdown Boron Weight (HSBW) is not a quantity which can be measured by the operator. An SLC tank level below 32% or approximately 2461 pounds of borax injected are equivalent to the HSBW.

The Hot Shutdown Boron Weight is defined to be the least weight of soluble boron which, if injected into the reactor vessel and uniformly mixed, will maintain the reactor shut down under hot standby conditions.

These values are determined in calculation OEOP-WS-16. It has been decided to use 32% to represent the Hot Shutdown Boron Weight in the procedure. This value can be read by the operator on the indication in the Control Room. The borax concentration for Hot Shutdown Boron Weight is calculated as approximately 2461 pounds.

The Cold Shutdown Boron Weight (CSBW) is not a quantity which can be measured by the operator. An SLC tank level of 0% or 6080 pounds of borax injected are equivalent to the CSBW. The Cold Shutdown Boron Weight is defined to be the least weight of soluble boron which, if injected into the reactor vessel and uniformly mixed, will maintain the reactor shut down under all conditions. This weight is utilized to assure the reactor will remain shut down irrespective of control rod position or reactor temperature.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because 0% is CSBW and 2461 is HSBW borax concentration Choice B: Plausible because 32% is correct HSBW and 2461 is HSBW borax concentration Choice C: Plausible because 0% is CSBW and 6080 is correct for CSBW.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

61. 295038 K2.10 002 Unit Two startup is in progress with both Mechanical Vacuum Pumps (MVPs) in service establishing main condenser vacuum when the following alarm is received:

MAIN STEAM LINE RAD HI-HI/INOP The operator determines that MSL A Rad Monitor, D12-RM-K603A, is exceeding the Hi-Hi setpoint and is the only cause for the alarm.

Which one of the following identifies the response of the MVPs?

A. MVP A will trip only.

Bk Both MVPs will remain running.

C. Both MVPs will trip and OG-V7, Hogging Valve, will close.

D. Both MVPs will trip and OG-V7, Hogging Valve, will remain open.

Feedback K/A: 295038 K2.10 Knowledge of the interrelations between HIGH OFF SITE RELEASE RATE and the following:

Condenser air removal.

(CFR: 41.7 / 45.8)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.2/3.4 Objective:

CLSLP30*1 lb Given the necessary plant conditions, describe the effect that a malfunction or loss of the Condenser Air Removal/Augmented Off-Gas System would have on the following: Radioactive Release Rates

Reference:

SD-30, Condenser Air Removal and Off-gas Recombiner System Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Hi-Hi trip on the MSL Rad channels will cause both Mechanical vacuum pumps to trip and OG-V7 valve to close. The logic trips the MVPs when a hi-hi condition is present in each division. The MVPs discharge via the 1.8 minute holdup line to the main stack. MSL rad high conditions directly impact off-site release rates with the MVPs in service due to no discharge path processing. MVPs are only allowed to be operated below 5% reactor power due no hydrogen explosion hazards present.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible due to MSL A Rad Hi-Hi causing MVP A trip (trip in one division trips a MVP).

Choice B: Correct answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible due to a single MSL Rad Hi-Hi in one division causing a complete isolation and would be correct if a second MSL Rad HI-Hi were received.

Choice D: Plausible due to a single MSL Rad Hi-Hi in one division causing a complete isolation and would be correct if a second MSL Rad HI-Hi were received and not recognizing trip impact on OG-V7.

62. 3000011K5.13 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power when plugging of C12-DOO6A, Supply Air Filter, causes the SCRAM VALVE PIL AIR HDR PRESS HI/LO alarm to be received.

Which one of the following identifies the impact of lowering scram air header pressure?

The CRD Scram Outlet Valves will fail (1) on a low scram air header pressure and the DW Lower Vent Dampers will reposition to the (2) position.

A (1)open (2)MAX B. (1)open (2) MIN C. (1)closed (2) MAX D. (1)closed (2) MIN

Feedback K/A: 300000 K5. 13 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to the INSTRUMENT AIR SYSTEM:

Filters (CFR: 41.5 / 45.3)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.9/2.9 Objective:

CLS-LP-08 Obj. 7d State the normal and fail position for the following components: CRD Scram Outlet Valves

Reference:

APP-A-07 SD-08, CRD Hydraulic System Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Loss of the air supply will result in the in-service flow control valve closing. With no drive water pressure RMCS will not be able to move rods but they could still be scrammed. If air pressure would continue to lower below 40 psig the scram inlets and outlet valves would fail open on the loss of air. The lower DW dampers go to the MAX position on a scram as sensed by pressure switches in the scram air header.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation.

Choice B: Plausible since it does fail open and it may seem correct that more cooling would be needed in the upper part of the DW since hot air rises.

Choice C: Plausible because some valves do fail closed (CRD flow control valve) and the dampers do go to the MAX position Choice D: Plausible because some valves do fail closed (CRD flow control valve) and it may seem correct that more cooling would be needed in the upper part of the DW since hot air rises.

63. 4000001(4.01 001 Which one of the following choices completes the statements below?

The hicihest CSW system pressure that will auto start the standby CSW pump is (1) psig.

If pressure remains below this setpoint for at least (2) seconds the SW-V3(V4),

SW to TBCCW Hxs Otbd(lnbd) Isol, will reposition to their throttled positions.

A. (1)65 (2)30 B. (1)65 (2)70 C. (1)40 (2)30 D(1)40 (2)70 Feedback KJA: 400000 K4.01 Knowledge of CCWS design feature(s) and or interlocks which provide for the following:

Automatic start of standby pump (CFR: 41.7)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.4/3.9 Objective: CLS-LP-43 Obj 6d Given plant conditions, predict whether any of the following pumps should start: Conventional Service Water Pumps

Reference:

SD-43, Service Water System AOP-19, Conventional Service Water System Failure Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

The CSW pumps will auto start at 40 psig, the RCC pumps start at 65 psig.

The SW-V3/4 throttle to a mid position if the low pressure exists for 70 seconds.

The DG cooling valves swap to the opposite unit after low pressure for 30 seconds.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the RCC pumps auto start at 65 psig and the DG cooling valves swap to the opposite unit after low pressure for 30 seconds.

choice B: Plausible because the RCC pumps auto start at 65 psig.

Choice C: Plausible because the DG cooling valves swap to the opposite unit after low pressure for 30 seconds.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation.

- 64. 6oo000K2.oI 001 Which one of the following completes both statements?

The SBGT Trains utilize (1) to indicate a fire in the filter bank.

If a valid fire signal is detected filter bank sprinkler flow (2) occur. (Assume no operator actions)

A. (1) temperature switches (2) will B (1) temperature switches (2) will not C. (1) ionization detectors (2) will D. (1) ionization detectors (2) will not

Feedback K/A: 600000 K2.01 Knowledge of the interrelations between PLANT FIRE ON SITE and the following:

Sensors / detectors and valves ROISRO Rating:

2.6/2.7 Objective:

CLS-LP-41 *21 Given plant conditions, predict the response of the Fire Suppression and Fire Detection Systems.

Reference:

SD-lU, Standby Gas Treatment System, Section 3.2.5 Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

There are two temperature switches to monitor the temperature of each Carbon Filter in each SBGT train.(TS 3/4) Switches VA-TS-5302-1 (VA-TS-5302-2), and VA-TS-5297-1 (VA-TS-5297-2) monitor Carbon Filter Bank No. I and actuate at 210°F, rising, to indicate a fire in the filter bank. Actuation of any switch will automatically open the Fire Suppression Systems deluge valve for the associated carbon bank (note that the associated isolation valves must be opened manually for this system to inject)

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because temperature switches is correct. High temperature trips the train with inlet temp < 180F but fire sprinkler flow will not occur until the local manual deluge vavle is opened.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because Ionization detectors detect the early products of combustion before they become visible smoke. High temperature trips the train with inlet temp < 180°F but fire sprinkler flow will not occur until the local manual deluge valve is opened.

Choice D: Plausible because Ionization detectors detect the early products of combustion before they become visible smoke and will not is correct due to local valve manipulations required to flow water.

65 700000 K1.02 001 Unit Two operating at rated power with Main Generator MVAR loading at +300 MVARs.

Which one of the following completes the statement below based on these conditions?

The Main Generator component that could overheat is the (1) windings.

MVARs must be lowered to less than (2) lAW 20P-27, Generator and Exciter System Operating Procedure.

A. (1) armature (stator)

(2) +70 B. (1) field (rotor)

(2) +70 C. (1) armature (stator)

(2) +170 D (1) field (rotor)

(2) +170

Feedback K/A: 700000 K1.02 Knowledge of the operational implications of the following concepts as they apply to GENERATOR VOLTAGE AND ELECTRIC GRID:

Over-excitation (CFR: 41.4,41.5,41.7,41.10/45.8)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.3/3.4 Objective:

CLSLP27*i if Given plant conditions, describe the effect that a loss or malfunction of the following may have on the Main Generator: Voltage regulator (including Under and Over-Excitation)

Reference:

SD-27, Main Generator and Exciter System, Section 2.17 Cog Level:

High Explanation:

The limitation placed on lagging MVARs (+ MVAR5) of the estimated capability curve, limits operation because of excessive heating that occurs in the generator field. Since the generator is operating in an overexcited condition, a larger field current is necessary to produce the extra KVAR being supplied to the system. with the conditions given, the generator is operating outside the capabilities curve. The minimum gross MVAR requirement is 70 (positive) while the maximum gross MVAR requirement is 170 (positive).

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the limitation placed on leading MVARs (- MVARs) of the estimated capability curve are less effected by Hydrogen pressure. We see that the curves come together sharply. As the system is required to supply more reactive power to the generator field, the flux in the air gap between the field and stator becomes more distorted. The distortion results in the exposed ends of the stator coils becoming overheated. As field strength is reduced, this heating accelerates. The +70 is the lower end of the operating band for the generator VARS.

Choice B: Plausible because overheating of the field is correct and the +70 is the lower end of the operating band for the generator VARS.

Choice C: Plausible because the limitation placed on leading MVARs (- MVARs) of the estimated capability curve are less effected by Hydrogen pressure. We see that the curves come together sharply. As the system is required to supply more reactive power to the generator field, the flux in the air gap between the field and stator becomes more distorted. The distortion results in the exposed ends of the stator coils becoming overheated. As field strength is reduced, this heating accelerates. The +170 is the high end of the operating band for the generator VARS.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

66. G2.O1.27OO1 Which one of the following is the purpose of the High Pressure Coolant Injection (HPCI) System lAW Technical Specifications Bases?

HPCI is designed to provide sufficient coolant injection to maintain the Reactor core covered during a (1) Loss-Of-Coolant-Accident to maintain fuel cladding temperatures below (2)

A. (1) small break (2) 1800°F B (1) small break (2) 2200°F C. (1) large break (2) 1800°F D. (1) large break (2) 2200°F

Feedback -

K/A: G2.01.27 Conduct of Operations Knowledge of system purpose andlor function.

(CFR: 41.7)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.9/4.0 Objective:

CLS-LP-01 9*01 State the purpose of the High Pressure Coolant Injection (HPCI) System.

Reference:

U2 TS Bases SD-19, High Pressure Coolant Injection System (HPCI), Section 1.2 Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

The High Pressure Coolant Injection (HPCI) System was designed to provide sufficient coolant injection to maintain the Reactor core covered during a small line break Loss-Of-Coolant-Accident (LOCA) which does not result in rapid vessel depressurization, thus maintaining fuel cladding temperatures below 2200°F. The original design basis of the HPCI System was to provide part of the Emergency Core Cooling System (ECCS) function. HPCI system operation mitigated small break LOCAs where the depressurization function [Automatic Depressurization System (ADS) I SRVs) was assumed to fail.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because small break is correct, and 1800°F is the number for if adequate core cooling can not be maintained by core submergence.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because HPCI is a high capacity, high pressure injection system which is easily mistaken for large break LOCA makeup requirements, and 1800°F is the number for if adequate core cooling can not be maintained by core submergence.

Choice D: Plausible because HPCI is a high capacity, high pressure injection system which is easily mistaken for large break LOCA makeup requirements, and 2200°F is the temperature that cladding will not exceed with core submergence.

67. G2.0-1.31 001 LOCA conditions exist on Unit One. CREV has failed to auto start and the CRS has ordered CREV to be manually started per the Hard Card.

Which one of the following identifies:

(1) the minimum required action(s) to start the CB Emerg Recirc Fan and (2) the expected position indication for the CB Emerg Recirc Damper (VA-2J-D-CB) after the fan is started?

A. (1) Place the CB Emerg Recirc Fan control switch on Unit Two XU-3 panel to On (2) Closed B& (1) Place the CB Emerg Recirc Fan control switch on Unit Two XU-3 panel to On (2) Open C. (1) Simultaneously place both Units CB Emerg Recirc Fan control switches on their respective XU-3 panel to On (2) Closed D. (1) Simultaneously place both Units CB Emerg Recirc Fan control switches on their respective XU-3 panel to On (2) Open

Feedback K/A: G2.01.31 Conduct of Operations Ability to locate control room switches, controls, and indications, and to determine that they correctly reflect the desired plant lineup.

(CFR: 41.10 / 45.12)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.6/4.3 Objective:

CLS-LP-37, Obj 12d Explain the following: How to place the Control Room Ventilation system in Recirculation Mode.

Reference:

OOP-37, Control Building Ventilation System operating Procedure Cog Level:

High Explanation:

The controls for the CREV system are on U2 only. Indication for the CREV System is on both units. The emergency recirc damper will open when the fan is started and the open indication is red. The normal makeup damper closes on starting the fan in which the closed indication is green.

The Control Building Mechanical Equipment Room Vent Fans can only be stopped by simultaneously placing both Units control switches in OFF.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the control switch is located on U2, but the recirc damper will open. The normal makeup damper closes.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation.

Choice C: Plausible because the CB Mechanical Equipment Room Vent Fans can only be stopped by simultaneously operating both Units control switches and the normal makeup damper closes.

Choice D: Plausible because the CB Mechanical Equipment Room Vent Fans can only be stopped by simultaneously operating both Units control switches and the recirc damper does open.

68. G2.OL39OO1 Which one of the following describes the applicable guidance of 001.01.02, Operations Unit Organization and Operating Practices, Attachment 1, Operations Performance Standards?

When moving a control rod (1) , the operator is required to stop one notch short, then single notch to the final position unless the control rod is going to position 48 (full out).

When moving a control rod (2) , the operator is required to perform separate single notch moves.

A. (1)3 notches or less (2) 4 notches or more B. (1)3 notches or less (2) 3 notches or less C. (1) 4 notches or more (2) 4 notches or more D (1) 4 notches or more (2) 3 notches or less

Feedback K/A: G2.0l.39 Conduct of Operations Knowledge of conservative decision making practices.

(CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.12)

ROISRO Rating:

3.6/4.3 Objective:

CLSLP201D*24f Explain the following regarding OPS-NGGC-1306 Reactivity Management Program:

The procedural requirements for positioning intermediate control rods.

Reference:

001-01.02, Conservative Decision Making and Reactivity Management, Attachment 1,Sectioh 5.10 Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Control rod manipulations within the guidance of Attachment I are conservative decisions.

Per 001-01.02,

12) When moving a control rod four notches or more, stops one notch short, then single notches to final position unless control rod is going to position 48 (full out).
13) When moving a control rod three notch or less, performs separate single notch moves.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because since 3 notches provides for sufficient rod movement to allow for stopping conservatively one notch short and moving control rods 4 notches or more by single notch is conservative.

Choice B: Plausible because since 3 notches provides for sufficient rod movement to allow for stopping conservatively one notch short and 3 notches or less is correct.

Choice C: Plausible because 4 notches or more is correct and moving control rods 4 notches or more by single notch is conservative.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

69. G2.02.04 001 Which one of the following identifies where the Electric Fire Pump can be started from?

The Electric Fire Pump can be manually started locally:

A. only.

B and at the Unit One RTGB only.

C. and at the Unit Two RTGB only.

D. and at either Unit One or Unit Two RTGBs.

Feedback K/A: G2.02.04 EQUIPMENT CONTROL (multi-unit license) Ability to explain the variations in control boardlcontrol room layouts, systems, instrumentation, and procedural actions between units at a facility.

(cFR:41.6/41.7/41.lo/45.1 /45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.6/3.6 Objective:

None

Reference:

OOP-41, Fire Suppression Systems Operating Procedure, Section 8.3 SD-41, Fire Suppression Systems, Section 3.2.2 cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Ability to explain the variation is identifing the difference in location of the controls.

The Electric Fire Pump can be started

1. Automatically (Low system pressure)
2. Manually from the Control Room (Panel XU-69 which is only located on Unit One)
3. Manually from local control panel.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the majority of License Operator simulator training is performed on U2 simulator which does not have Panel XU-69.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because controls would exist on Unit Two however they do not. This is a difference between Units Choice D: Plausible because controls would exist on Unit Two however they do not. This is a difference between Units

70. G2.02.25 001 Which one of the following describes the bases for the Minimum Critical Power Ratio (MCPR) Safety Limit lAW Technical Specifications Bases 2.1.1, Reactor Core Safety Limits?

The MCPR Safety Limit ensures that:

A. the calculated total oxidation shall no where exceed 0.17 times the total cladding thickness before oxidation.

B. the calculated changes in core geometry shall be such that the core remains amenable to cooling.

C. cladding plastic strain remains less than 1%.

D during normal operation and during Anticipated Operational Occurrences, at least 99.9% of the fuel rods in the core do not experience transition boiling.

Feedback K/A: G2.02.25 EQUIPMENT CONTROL Knowledge of the bases in Technical Specifications for limiting conditions for operations and safety limits.

(CFR: 41.5 / 41.7 / 43.2)

ROISRO Rating:

3.2/4.2 Objective:

CLSLP200B*O3 State each TS Safety Limit and discuss the basis for each of the Safety Limits.

Reference:

U2 TS Bases Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Requires knowledge of TS Safety Limit Bases and the ability to distinguish between Safety Limits and Operating Limits. The MCPR fuel cladding integrity SL ensures that during normal operation and during AOOs, at least 99.9% of the fuel rods in the core do not experience transition boiling.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because since this is ECCS acceptance criteria.

Choice B: Plausible because since this is ECCS acceptance criteria.

Choice C: Plausible because since this is the basis for the LHGR limit.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation

71. G2.02.39 001 Unit Two startup is in progress when the operating CRD Pump trips.

The following plant conditions exist:

CRD pumps Unavailable Reactor Pressure 850 psig Charging header pressure 875 psig CRD ACCUM LO PRESS/HI LEVEL In alarm Control Rod 18-19 Full core display Amber Accumulator light is lit Control Rod 18-19 Full core display Red Full Out light is lit Which one of the following describes the required action lAW Technical Specifications 3.1.5, Control Rod Scram Accumulators and OAOP-02.O, Control Rod Malfunction/Misposition?

A A manual reactor scram is required Immediately.

B. Restore charging water header to >950 psig within 20 minutes or insert a manual reactor scram.

C. Fully insert control rod 18-19 immediately and declare INOP within 1 hour1.157407e-5 days <br />2.777778e-4 hours <br />1.653439e-6 weeks <br />3.805e-7 months <br />.

D. A manual reactor scram is required Qjjjy if a second accumulator alarm is received.

Feedback K/A: G2.02.39 EQUIPMENT CONTROL Knowledge of less than or equal to one hour Technical Specification action statements for systems.

(CFR: 41.7/41.10/43.2/45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.9/4.5 Objective:

CLSLP008B*1 0 Given plant conditions, determine proper operator actions if no CRD pumps are operating.

Reference:

Unit 2 Tech Spec 3.1.5, Control Rod Scram Accumulators, Condition D Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Immediate scram required by Tech Spec 3.1.5, Conditions C & D.

The reactor must be immediately scrammed if either the Required Action and associated Completion Time associated with loss of the CRD charging pump (Required Actions B.1 and C.1)cannot be met. This ensures that all insertable control rods are inserted and that the reactor is in a condition that does not require the active function (i.e., scram) of the control rods.

Scram also required by supplemental actions of OAOP-02.0.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because with reactor pressure> 950 psig combined with charging header pressure

<940 psig, 20 minutes is allowed for restoration of charging water header pressure.

Choice C: Plausible because accumulator alarm could be due to High water level which would still provide for sufficient accumulator pressure to fully insert the control rod. Revision 12 of 2AOP-02.0 provided guidance on time frame to IMMEDIATELY insert a manual scram upon receipt of the first HCU low pressure alarm (A-07 6-1, confirmed by amber light on Full Core Display).

Choice D: Plausible because waiting for the second accumulator is applicable to reactor pressures

> 950 psig for restoration of charging water header pressure.

72. G2.03.14 002 Unit One is operating at 50% power with the HWC System operating in Auto.

Which one of the following choices completes the statements below?

The reactor power input to HWC System is determined by total (1) flow.

If reactor power is raised, the Turbine Building radiation levels will increase due to the increased production of (2)

A. (1)Steam (2) Ammonia (NH3)

B (1) Feedwater (2) Ammonia (NH3)

C. (1)Steam (2) Nitrates (N03)

D. (1) Feedwater (2) Nitrates (N03)

Feedback K/A: G2.03.14 Radiation Control Knowledge of radiation or contamination hazards that may arise during normal, abnormal, or emergency conditions or activities.

(CFR: 41.12/43.4 / 45.10)

RO/SRO Rating: 3.4/3.8 Objective: CLSLP59* 14

14. Explain why background radiation levels outside primary containment increase when the HWC System is placed in service.
15. State the parameter used for the reactor power level reference input to the hydrogen injection flow controller, and explain why it is used.

Reference:

SD-59, Revision 14, Page 8, Section 1.3.2 Cog Level: Low Explanation:

The implementation of Hydrogen Water Chemistry (H2 injection) alters the Nitrogen-16 carryover ratio.

The net production of Nitrogen-16 is not influenced by Hydrogen injection. The excess Hydrogen injected into the reactor coolant creates the driving force to shift the Nitrogen-16 distribution ratio, resulting in a larger fraction of the Nitrogen-16 forming volatile Ammonia and a smaller fraction forming Nitrites and Nitrates. This additional volatile Ammonia is then carried over in the reactor steam resulting in higher background radiation levels. Any increase in Hydrogen injection rates will result in a proportional increase in background radiation levels and vice-versa. DFCS provides power input signals to systems (RWM, HWC, Recirc) via total steam flow and total feedwater flow.

HWC utilizes Feedwater flow from DFCS for power input Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because DFCS steam flow does provide power input to the RWM and is often confused with feedwater flow and increased production of Ammonia (NH3) is correct.

Choice B: Correct Answer Choice C: Plausible because DFCS steam flow does provide power input to the RWM and is often confused with feedwater flow and raising power with HWC in AUTO raises H2 injection rate which raises Ammonia (NH3) carryover. Increased Nitrates (N03) are removed by RWCU and do not cause TB rad levels to rise.

Choice D: Plausible because feedwater is correct and raising power with HWC in AUTO raises H2 injection rate which raises Ammonia (NH3) carryover. Increased Nitrates (NO3) are removed by RWCU and do not cause TB rad levels to rise.

SRO Only Basis: N/A

73. 02.03.15 001 Which one of the following identifies the current Drywell radiation level?

A. -2O RIh B 200 RIh C. 1000 RJh D. 10000 R/h

Feedback K/A: G2.03.15 Radiation Control Knowledge of radiation monitoring systems, such as fixed radiation monitors, portable survey instruments, personnel monitoring equipment, etc.

(CFR: 41.12/43.4/45.9)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.9/3.1 Objective:

CLS-LP-1 1.1 *03a Describe the function/operation of the following: Drywell High Range Radiation Monitors

Reference:

SD-I 1.1, Area Radiation Monitoring System, Section 2.5 Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Drywell high range area monitors provide indications of gross fuel failure and are used to determine emergency plan emergency action level associated with abnormal core conditions. With the function switch in the E1-E4, meter readings are taken from the lower scale between 10- 10000 RJh. Current indication of 200 R/h Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible if function switch is not taken into account would be 20 R/h.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible if read directly off the upper scale Choice D: Plausible if read off the upper scale and adjusted by a factor of 10 for function switch position.

74. G2.04.01 002 Which one of the following radiation annunciators requires entry into RRCP?

A. RBCCW LIQUID PROCESS RAD HIGH B RXBLDG ROOF VENT RAD HIGH C. PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HIGH D. PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HI-HI Feedback K/A: G2.04.01 Emergency Procedures I Plan Knowledge of EOP entry conditions and immediate action steps.

(CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)

ROISRO Rating: 4.6/4.8 Objective: LOlCLSLP300N*002

2. Given plant conditions, determine if OEOP-04-RRCP should be entered.

Reference:

RRCP Cog Level: Low Explanation: Brunswick does not have any immediate operator actions in any EOP.

Annunciator requires immediate operator action of entry into RRCP. RRCP provides guidance to the operator for minimizing off-site radioactivity releases up to and including events involving substantial degradation of all of the fission product barriers (e.g., fuel, fuel clad, reactor vessel pressure boundary, primary containment, and secondary containment).

RRCP and SCCP are used concurrently to control releases from primary systems. This procedure controls non-primary system releases through actions incorporated in the non-PSTG legs of the procedure.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because SCCP entry would be appropriate.

Choice B: Correct Answer Choice C: Plausible because is easily confused with the roof vent alarm and is a SCCP entry condition.

Choice D: Plausible because this annunciator provides indication of Secondary Containment auto isolation setpoint and is easily confused with the roof vent alarm.

SRO Only Basis: N/A

75. G2.04.09 001 An ATWS has occurred on Unit One with the following plant conditions:

Reactor Water Level 130 inches (stable)

Injection Systems CRD Reactor Power APRM downscale lights are illuminated Control Rods 19 rods failed to insert SRVs All closed Reactor Pressure 920 psig and stable Suppression Pool Temp. 92° F Which one of the following choices completes the statement below lAW LPC?

Reactor Recirculation pumps (1) required to be tripped and the SLC Pumps (2) required to be started.

AY(1) are not (2) are not B. (1) are not (2) are C. (1) are (2) are not D. (1) are (2) are

Feedback K/A: G2.04.09 Emergency Procedures I Plan Knowledge of low power/shutdown implications in accident (e.g., loss of coolant accident or loss of residual heat removal) mitigation strategies.

(CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13) e.g. is an abbreviation for the latin phrase exempli gratia. When you mean that is use i.e. Since e.g.

indicates a partial list, it would be redundant to add etc. at the end of a list introduced by this abbreviation.

(from answerbag. corn) The recirc pumps and SLC pumps are used for mitigation of the A TWS.

RO/SRO Rating:

3.8/4.2 Objective:

CLSLP300E*01 7 Compare and contrast the operator actions for emergency depressurization with an ATWS condition present versus those with all control rods inserted.

Reference:

001-37.5 Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Reactor recirc pumps are evaluated during the ATWS and are tripped to reduce core flow thereby reducing reactor power. If power is less than 2% then tripping the pumps is not required. SLC is injected into the reactor to provide an alternate means of shutting down the reactor. It is required to be injected prior to exceeding 110° F in the torus. With SRVs closed and temperature at 92 with no additional heat load to the torus SLC injection is not required.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation.

Choice B: Plausible because recirc pumps are not required to be shutdown is correct and if the torus was in jeopardy of reaching 110 then this would be correct.

Choice C: Plausible because if power was greater than 2% the recirc pumps are required to be shutdown is correct and the torus is not in jeopardy of reaching 110 so this is correct.

Choice D: Plausible because if power was above 2% and the torus temperature in danger of reaching 110 then these actions would be correct.

76. S204000 G2.0225 003 With Unit Two operating at power which one of the following choices completes the statements below lAW Technical Specification 3.6.1.3, Primary Containment Isolation Valves (PCIVs)?

If the G31-FOO1, RWCU Inlet Inboard Isolation Valve is inoperable, the line is required to be isolated in (1) and verify the affected penetration flow path is isolated once per 31 days.

This 31 day verification of the G31-F004, RWCU Inlet Outboard Isolation Valve, breaker and valve position (2)

A. (1)2hours (2) may be accomplished remotely by Administrative means B (1)8 hours9.259259e-5 days <br />0.00222 hours <br />1.322751e-5 weeks <br />3.044e-6 months <br /> (2) may be accomplished remotely by Administrative means C. (1)2hours (2) must be accomplished by actual hands on verification at the components D. (1)8hours (2) must be accomplished by actual hands on verification at the components

Feedback KJA: 204000 G2.02.25 Knowledge of the bases in Technical Specifications for limiting conditions for operations and safety limits.

Reactor Water Cleanup System (CFR: 41.5 / 41.7/ 43.2)

There are no safety limits associated with RWCU system, so question is written directly to the TS.

RO/SRO Rating:

3.2/4.2 Objective:

CLS-LP-14, Obj. 13 Given plant conditions and Technical Specifications, including the Bases, TRM, ODCM, and COLR, determine the required action(s) to be taken in accordance with Technical Specifications associated with the RWCU system.

Reference:

Tech Spec 3.6.1.3 Primary Containment Isolation Valves (PCIV5)

Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

Tech Spec 3.6.1.3 PCIVs Condition A applies; Required Action A.1 must be completed within 8 hours9.259259e-5 days <br />0.00222 hours <br />1.322751e-5 weeks <br />3.044e-6 months <br />; Required Action A.2 must be completed once per 31 days. Bases 3.6.1.3 allows completion of A.2 by administrative means for the given conditions.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because 2 hours2.314815e-5 days <br />5.555556e-4 hours <br />3.306878e-6 weeks <br />7.61e-7 months <br /> is the required completion time for Required Action B.2 Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because 2 hours2.314815e-5 days <br />5.555556e-4 hours <br />3.306878e-6 weeks <br />7.61e-7 months <br /> is the required completion time for Required Action B.2; plausible because hands on verification is required in areas other than high radiation areas Choice D: Plausible because hands on verification is required in areas other than high radiation areas SRO Basis:

10 CFR 55.43(b)-2, Facility operating limitations in the TS and their bases.

Knowledge of TS bases that is required to analyze TS required actions and terminology.

77. S212000 A2.12 002 Unit One is operating at full power when the following plant conditions occur:

- Part time load shedding has been implemented

- Load Reject Signal received

- Line 31 (Whiteville Line) PCBs red lights are lit

- Line 31 (Whiteville Line) white VOLT lights are not lit

- All other line PCBs green lights are lit

- 230 KV BUS IA BUS POT UNDER VOLTAGE is in alarm

- 230 KV BUS lB BUS POT UNDER VOLTAGE is in alarm Which one of the following identifies the initial RPS trip signal and the procedure which contains the guidance to trip the Whiteville Line PCBs?

A. Turbine Control Valve Fast Closure; OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses.

B. Turbine Stop Valve Closure; OAOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses.

C. Turbine Control Valve Fast Closure; OAOP-22, Grid Instability.

D. Turbine Stop Valve Closure; OAOP-22, Grid Instability.

Feedback -

K/A: 212000 A2.12 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the REACTOR PROTECTION SYSTEM ; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:

Main turbine stop control valve closure (C FR: 41.5 / 45.6)

ROISRO Rating:

4.0/4.1 Objective:

CLS-LP-03, Obj. 8.

List the RPS trip signals, including setpoints and how/when each signal is bypassed.

Reference:

SD-03, Reactor Protection System AOP-36.1, Loss of Any 4160V Buses or48OV E-Buses Cog Level:

High Explanation:

A load reject signal at any reactor power level will cause a turbine control valve fast closure scram. The load reject signal does not input into the turbine stop valve closure scram logic. During a loss of offsite power, if the grid is lost all PCBs are opened per OAOP-36.1.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Incorrect Load reject initiates a TCV fast closure scram not a TSV. A misconception of the difference between TCV and TSV scrams may cause a student to select this answer.

Choice C: Incorrect. OAOP-22 does not have an action for loss of grid only for degraded conditions.

Choice D: Incorrect. Load reject initiates a TCV fast closure scram not a TSV. A misconception of the difference between TCV and TSV scrams may cause a student to select this answer.

OAOP-22 does not have an action for loss of grid only for degraded.

SRO Basis:

10 CFR 55.43(b)-5, Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.

78. S214000A2.03 00-I The Unit is at 30% power during reactor startup.

The operator withdraws control rod 26-27 to position 48.

The following indications are noted:

- ROD DRIFT alarm seals in

- ROD OVER TRAVEL alarm seals in

- Rod 26-27 full core display red light out Which one of the following identifies:

(1) the indication that would be displayed on the four-rod group display and (2) the minimum required action(s) for the inoperable control rod lAW Technical Specifications?

A. (1)48 (2) Fully insert control rod 26-27 and disarm the HCU B. (1)48 (2) Fully insert control rod 26-27 and disarm the HCU; verify >12 control rods are withdrawn and implement GP-1 1, Second Operator Rod Sequence Checkoff Sheets C (1) Blank (2) Fully insert control rod 26-27 and disarm the HCU D. (1) Blank (2) Fully insert control rod 26-27, disarm the HCU; verify >12 control rods are withdrawn, and implement GP-1 1, Second Operator Rod Sequence Checkoff Sheets

Feedback K/A: 214000 A2.03 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the ROD POSITION INFORMATION SYSTEM; and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal conditions or operations:

Overtravel/in-out (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.6/3.9 Objective:

CLS-LP-07 Obj 5b Given plant conditions, determine if the following conditions exist: Indications of an uncoupled control rod.

Reference:

SD-07, Reactor Manual Control System Tech Spec 3.1.3, Control Rod Operability GP-1 1, Second Operator Rod Sequence Checkoff Sheets Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

If the control rod is in the overtravel out position, the corresponding digital indicator will be blank since the magnet will not be near any of the 00 to 48 reed switches. lAW TS the rod is declared inoperable then inserted to 00 (within 3 hours3.472222e-5 days <br />8.333333e-4 hours <br />4.960317e-6 weeks <br />1.1415e-6 months <br />) and disarmed (within 4 hours4.62963e-5 days <br />0.00111 hours <br />6.613757e-6 weeks <br />1.522e-6 months <br />). TS 3.1.6 if the RWM is inoperable then if

>12 control rods are withdrawn GP-1 1 would be implemented, unless the rod is at 00 and is not intended to be moved.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the full in and 00 indications are at the same point or the examinee may think that the rod may settle to the 48 position.

Choice B: Plausible because the full in and 00 indications are at the same point or the examinee may think that the rod may settle to the 48 position. These are TS actions for an inoperable RWM, not control rod.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation.

Choice D: Plausible because this is the correct indication but these are TS actions for an inoperable RWM, not control rod.

SRO Basis:

10 CFR 55.43(b)-2, Facility operating limitations in the technical specifications and their bases.

Application of required actions statements.

79. S217000 G2.04.08 002 Given the following ATWS conditions on Unit Two:

2A CRD Pump Overcurrent trip 2B CRD Pump Shaft uncoupled HPCI System Under Clearance SLC Both squib valves failed to fire RCIC Running for LEP-03, Alternate Boron Injection, with an unisolable steam supply leak SRHR Equip Room 180°F Suppression Pool Level -24 inches Reactor Power 10%

Reactor Water Level 160 inches Which one of the following completes the statement below based on the conditions above?

The RCIC system must (1) which is required by (2)

A. (1) be isolated (2) SCCP B. (1) be isolated (2) OAOP-05.0, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation, and Airborne Activity C (1) remain running (2) SCCP D. (1) remain running (2) OAOP-05.0, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation, and Airborne Activity

Feedback K/A: 217000 G2.04.08 Knowledge of how abnormal operating procedures are used in conjunction with EOPs.

Reactor Core Isolation Cooling System (RCIC)

(CFR: 41.10/43.5 /45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.8/4.5 Objective:

CLS-LP-300-B, Obj. 19 Given a situation where a conflict exists between AOP or ASSD requirements and EOP guidance, determine the correct operator action.

Reference:

AOP-05, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation and Airborne Activity SCCP Cog Level:

High Explanation:

EOP action that supercedes the AOP action is what the question is asking.

AOP-5 does have a step to isolate the system that is leaking, but SCCP overrides that if the system is required by EOPs. With the ATWS the RCIC system is required for alternate boron injection therefore should remain running per the direction from SCCP.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because SCCP/AOP-5 does have a step to isolate the system that is leaking and reasonable for the student to think this direction comes from SCCP.

Choice B: Plausible because SCCP/AOP-5 does have a step to isolate the system that is leaking Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible for student to think the direction to remain running comes from AOP-5.0.

SRO Basis:

10 CFR 55.43(b)-5, Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.

80. S233000 G2.04.06 001 Unit Two was operating at rated power with the following conditions:

- A dual Unit Loss Of Offsite Power (LOOP)

- Spent Fuel Pool level is lowering rapidly

- RRCP has been entered due to high rad conditions on the refuel floor Which one of the following is the first makeup source to be used for filling the fuel pool and identifies the procedure to perform the action?

A. Emergency Diesel Makeup Pump lAW OAOP-38.O, Loss of Fuel Pool Cooling B RHR B Loop lAW OAOP-38.O, Loss of Fuel Pool Cooling C. Emergency Diesel Makeup Pump lAW OEDMG-002, Spent Fuel Pool Makeup/Spray and Refuel Floor Enhanced Ventilation under Conditions of Extreme Damage D. RHR B Loop lAW OEDMG-002, Spent Fuel Pool Makeup/Spray and Refuel Floor Enhanced Ventilation under Conditions of Extreme Damage

Feedback K/A: 233000 G2.04.06 Knowledge of EOP mitigation strategies.

Fuel Pool Cooling and Clean-up (CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)

There are no direct EOP actions associated with FPC, a loss of level in the fuel pool will cause entry into RRCP which is an EOP. So these actions are mitigation strategies to RRCP.

RO/SRO Rating:

3.7/4.7 Objective:

CLS-LP-13, Obj.11 State the sources of makeup water for the Fuel Pool in order of preference.

Reference:

AOP-38.0, Loss of Fuel Pool Cooling EDMG-02, Spent Fuel Pool Makeup/Spray and Refuel Floor Enhanced Ventilation under Conditions of Extreme Damage Cog Level:

High Explanation:

The order of the makeup sources is from the normal fill, Demin water hose stations, Fire protection hose stations, demin water through RHR keepfill, and then other sources that are not service water. For a high capacity water source and the gates installed RHR Loop B would be used via the FPC system. With a LOOP the demin pumps have no power. If no other sources are available then the procedure has injection from the EDMP.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because although this is a makeup source it is not the preferred source (last resort per the procedure) and is performed per the EDMG procedures. Although upon entering the AOP there is a step to start lining this system up for injection because of the time required to get all of the hoses run in the procedure up to the fuel pool.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because although this is a makeup source it is not the preferred source (last resort per the procedure). Although upon entering the AOP there is a step to start lining this system up for injection because of the time required to get all of the hoses run in the procedure up to the fuel pool.

Choice D: Plausible because RHR is the high capacity source that will need to be used, but the EDMG procedure does not provide this guidance.

SRO Basis:

10 CFR 55.43(b)-5, Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.

81. S239002G2.02.25OfY2 With Unit Two at rated power, which one of the following identifies:

(1) the required number of SRVs with safety function operable lAW Technical Specification LCO 3.4.3, Safety/Relief Valves and (2) the overpressurization event that bounds this number of required operable SRVs lAW Technical Specification Bases 3.4.3, Safety/Relief Valves?

A. (1)9 (2) an ATWS with MSIV closure B (1) 10 (2) an ATWS with MSIV closure C. (1)9 (2) an MSIV closure with reactor scram D. (1)10 (2) an MSIV closure with reactor scram

Feedback - -

KIA: 239002 G2.02.25 Knowledge of the bases in Technical Specifications for limiting conditions for operations and safety limits.

Safety Relief Valves (CFR: 41.5 /41.7 / 43.2)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.2/4.2 Objective:

CLS-LP-25, Obj. 10 Given plant conditions and TS, including the Bases, TRM, ODCM, and COLR determine the required actions to be taken in accordance with TS associated with the Reactor Recirculation System. (SRO only)

Reference:

TS 3.4.3 Safety/Relief Valves (SRV5) and bases document Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

TS 3.4.3 states 10 must be operational for the safety function, the bases states the reason, ATWS.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the bases states that 9 are required for the MSIV closure.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because the bases states that 9 are required for the MSIV closure and the MSIV closure is not the binding failure mode.

Choice D: Plausible because 10 are required for the ATWS and the MSIV closure is not the binding failure mode.

SRO Basis:

10 CFR 55.43(b)-2, Facility operating limitations in the technical specifications and their bases.

This is knowledge of tech spec bases to determine the reason 10 are required.

82. S262002 G2.01.23 001 Both Units are operating at full power when the Main Stack Rad Monitor kst its normal power supply.

Which one of the following identifies the procedure that contains the steps to transfer the Main Stack Rad Monitor to its alternate power supply?

A. IOP-52, 120 Volt AC UPS, Emergency, and Conventional Electrical Systems Operating Procedure B 20P-52, 120 Volt AC UPS, Emergency, and Conventional Electrical Systems Operating Procedure C. 1APP UA-03 6-3, PROCESS SMPL OG VENT PIPE DNSC/INOP D. 2APP UA-03 6-3, PROCESS SMPL OG VENT PIPE DNSC/INOP

Feedback K/A: 262002 G2.01.23 Ability to perform specific system and integrated plant procedures during all modes of plant operation.

Uninterruptable Power Supply (A.C./D.C.)

(CFR: 41.10/43.5 / 45.2 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.3/4.2 Objective:

CLS-LP-11.0, 15a Given plant conditions and a trip or failure of one of the following Radiation Monitors, determine appropriate plant response and use procedures to determine the actions required to control and/or mitigate the consequences of the event: a. Main Stack.

Reference:

20P-52, Section 8.7 Stack Radiation Monitor UPS Power Supply Transfer Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

The normal power supply for the Main Stack Rad Monitor is from Unit Two. On a loss of power from the normal power supply the operators will need to transfer to the alternate power supply. This direction is only in the U2 procedure. There is no directions to perform this in the UI procedure or the APPs for either Unit.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible if the student wrongly believes the normal power supply is from Unit 1 rather than Unit 2.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation.

Choice C: Plausible because the downscale / mop annunciator will be actuated on a loss of power but the APPs do not address transfer of power to backup supply.

Choice D: Plausible because the downscale / mop annunciator will be actuated on a loss of power but the APPs do not address transfer of power to backup supply. U2 is the normal power supply to the rad monitor.

SRO Basis:

10 CFR 55.43(b)-5, Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.

83. S295006G 2.02.22 002 Following a reactor scram on Unit Two the following conditions exist:

0900 RHR Pump 2B tripped on overcurrent while placing Suppression Pool Cooling in service.

1100 The RSP is exited to OGP-05, Unit Shutdown, while in Mode 3.

Which one of the following completes the statement below?

The Technical Specification 3.5.1, ECCS Operating, LCO Action Statement is required to be entered at (1) lAW OEOP.-01-UG, Users Guide.

RHR Loop B Operability is required to be restored within (2) lAW Tech Spec 3.5.1, ECCS Operating.

A. (1)0900 (2) 7 days Bb (1) 1100 (2) 7 days C. (1)0900 (2)l4days D. (1)1100 (2)l4days

Feedback KIA: S295006G 2.02.22 Knowledge of limiting conditions for operations and safety limits.

SCRAM (CFR: 41.5 / 43.2 /45.2)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.0/4.7 Objective:

CLSLP30OC*1 1 Given plant conditions, the Unit Shutdown Procedure (GP-05), and the Reactor Scram Procedure, determine if conditions allow exiting the Reactor Scram Procedure.

Reference:

OEOP-O1-UG, Revision 55, Page 31, Section 3.5 Tech Spec 3.5.1, ECCS Operating Cog Level:

High Explanation:

The EOPs authorize actions outside of technical specifications to mitigate the consequences of an emergency condition. The EOPs also provide for returning the system or component to service. If the system or component is not returned to its standby or operable condition prior to exiting the EOPs, then the appropriate limiting condition of operation shall be implemented in accordance with Technical Specifications. The starting time for the limiting condition of operation is the time that the EOPs were exited.

In order to exit EOP, compatibility with GP-05 along with active LCOs need to be implemented. RHR Pump 2B tripping on overcurrent requires declaring RHR Loop B Inoperable for LPCI (Modes 1,2 &3), TS 3.5.1 Condition A (Al )requires Restore low pressure ECCS injection/spray subsystem to OPERABLE status within 7 days.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because LCO start time is wrong (time occurred while executing EOP5) and 7 days is correct.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because LCO start time is wrong (time occurred while executing EOPs) and 14 days is wrong completion time (would be correct for HPCI within the same TS)

Choice D: Plausible because LCO start time is correct and 14 days is wrong completion time (would be correct for HPCI within the same TS)

SRO Basis:

Requires knowledge of EOP bases and greater than 1 hour1.157407e-5 days <br />2.777778e-4 hours <br />1.653439e-6 weeks <br />3.805e-7 months <br /> TS completion times

84. soa A205 002 Following a scram on Unit Two, which one of the following identifies:

(1) the response of reactor water level when an SRV is opened and (2) the procedure that contains the following decision step?

CAN RETOR WA1R LEVEL BE UAJNTMNED >

LESSTHANMSL _-

A. (1)Shrink (2) RSP B. (1) Shrink (2) RVCP C (1)Swell (2) RSP D. (1)Swell (2) RVCP

Feedback K/A: 295008 A2.05 Ability to determine andlor interpret the following as they apply to HIGH REACTOR WATER LEVEL:

Swell (CFR: 41.10 / 43.5 / 45.13)

ROISRO Rating:

2.9/3.1 Objective:

CLS-LP-300-C, Obj.1 0 Given plant conditions and the RSP, determine the required operator actions.

Reference:

RSP RVCP 001-37.3, Reactor Scram Procedure Basis Document 001-37.4, Reactor Vessel Control Procedure Basis Document Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Opening of the SRV will cause the reactor water level to swell up due to the reduction in pressure in the vessel. The given decision block is from the RSP.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible if the examinee thinks that opening the SRV would reduce the water volume in the RPV.

Choice B: Plausible if the examinee thinks that opening the SRV would reduce the water volume in the RPV and that the given decision step is applicable to the level leg of RVCP.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because examinee may think that the given decision step is applicable to the level leg of RVCP.

SRO Basis:

10 CFR 55.43(b)-5, Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.

85. S295014G2.0I.25 001 Unit Two is operating at 74% power with the Feedwater Temperature at 405°F.

The FW-V120, FW HTRS 4 & 5 BYP VLV, is inadvertently opened by mechanics.

The valve is bound in mid position and cannot be reclosed.

Conditions are now stable with reactor power at 81 % and Feedwater Temperature at 306°F.

(Reference provided)

Which one of the following identifies whether continued operation is allowed including the required actions or procedures?

Continued operation:

A is not allowed and a reactor shutdown per OGP-05, Unit Shutdown, is required lAW 20P-32, Condensate and Feedwater System Operating Procedure.

B. is not allowed and a reactor shutdown per OGP-05, Unit Shutdown, is required lAW TS 3.1.2, Reactivity Anomalies.

C. is allowed provided that OGP-1 3, Increasing Unit Capacity At End Of Core Cycle, is implemented.

D. is allowed provided that the FWTR Power to Flow Map is implemented.

Feedback K/A: 295014 G2.01.25 Ability to interpret reference materials, such as graphs, curves, tables, etc.

Inadvertent Reactivity Addition (CFR: 41.10 / 43.5 / 45.12)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.9/4.2 Objective:

CLS-LP-34, Obj.1 ic Given plant conditions, describe the effect a loss/malfunction of the feedwater heaters will have on:

Feedwater Temperature

Reference:

20P-32, Attachment 4 (provided)

Cog Level:

High Explanation:

From Attachment 4 of 2OP-32 operation is outside of the allowable range (<110.3°F) therefore not allowed and will require a Unit shutdown lAW GP-05 per the direction of 20P-32.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because the examinee may believe that the direction to shutdown is driven from Tech Spec 3.1.2, Reactor Anomalies Choice C: Plausible because the examinee could wrongly apply the direction of GP-1 3.

Choice D: Plausible because the examinee could believe that the use of the FWTR Power to Flow Map is applicable for the given situation.

SRO Basis:

Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations (43(b)(5) a. Assessement of the plant conditions and then prescribing the shutdown lAW the GP.

86. S295021 A2.03 002 While in Mode 4 a loss of Shutdown Cooling (S DC) occurs.

Which one of the following completes both statements?

The minimum required Reactor Water Level to support Natural Circulation is (1) inches.

An Alert declaration is first required after an unplanned RPV pressure increase greater than (2) psig due to a loss of RCS cooling.

A. (1) 200 (2) 135 B(1) 200 (2)10 C. (1) 254 (2) 135 D. (1) 254 (2) 10

Feedback -

K/A: S295021 A2.03 Ability to determine and/or interpret the following as they apply to LOSS OF SHUTDOWN COOLING:

Reactor water level (CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.5/3.5 Objective:

CLS-LP-1 20*06 Describe how to determine when natural circulation exists within the Reactor Vessel.

Reference:

OAOP-15, Loss of Shutdown Cooling OPEP-2.1, EAL Flowcharts Cog Level:

High Explanation:

During conditions in which there is no circulation, the reactor vessel water level, as read on B21-LI-R605A(B), should be maintained between 200 and 220, or as directed by the Shift Superintendent based on plant conditions, until forced circulation is restored.

lAW PEP-2.1, Section CA3 Inability to Maintain Plant in Cold Shutdown an unplanned reactor pressure increase of >10 psig due to a loss of SDC requires an ALERT declaration.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because 135 psig reactor pressure is a setpoint associated with SDC that could be confused with the correct answer.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because 254 inches is the level of the MSLs and could be confused with Natural Circulation level due to the requirement to be at this level during alternate SDC.

Plausible because 135 psig reactor pressure is a setpoint associated with SDC that could be confused with the correct answer.

Choice D: Plausible because 254 inches is the level of the MSLs and could be confused with Natural Circulation level due to the requirement to be at this level during alternate SDC SRO Only Basis:

Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations (43(b)(5)a.

Requires assessing plant conditions (LOOP, Mode 3, power availability, impact of power losses) and prescribing correct section of a procedure to provide DHR.

87. S295023G 2.04.49 001 While performing refueling activities on Unit Two, a spent fuel bundle was dropped and the following alarms were received:

AREA RAD REFUEL FLOOR HIGH PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HIGH Which one of the following identifies:

(1) the required immediate operator action and (2) the bases for the performance of this action lAW OAOP-05.O Radioactive Spills, High Radiation and Airborne Activity, and Technical Specifications Bases?

A. (1) Manually start Standby Gas Treatment (SBGT)

(2) Ensures control room operators will not exceed 2 Rem TEDE B. (1) Manually start Standby Gas Treatment (SBGT)

(2) Ensures control room operators will not exceed 5 Rem TEDE C. (1) Manually start Control Room Emergency Ventilation (CREV)

(2) Ensures control room operators will not exceed 2 Rem TEDE D (1) Manually start Control Room Emergency Ventilation (CREV)

(2) Ensures control room operators will not exceed 5 Rem TEDE

Feedback K/A: S295023G 2.04.49 Ability to perform without reference to procedures those actions that require immediate operation of system components and controls.

Refueling Accidents (CFR: 41.10 / 43.2/45.6)

ROISRO Rating:

4.6/4.4 Objective:

CLSLP302J*02 Given plant conditions with spent fuel damage and a high airborne activity problem in progress, determine if the appropriate automatic actions have occurred in accordance with OAOP-5.0, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation, and Airborne Activity.

Reference:

AOP-05, Radioactive Spills, High Radiation and Airborne Activity Cog Level:

High Explanation:

OAOP-05 immediate action for a dropped or damaged fuel assembly is to ENSURE CREVS is in operation.

The dose consequence calculation for the fuel handling accident does not credit the secondary containment or automatic CREVS start, however, it does assume that CREVS is manually initiated within 20 minutes of a dropped/damaged fuel assembly. Based on this analysis, Technical Specifications do not require secondary containment or CREVS automatic initiation instrumentation except during Modes 1, 2, or 3 or during operations with the potential to drain the Reactor vessel. The CREV System is designed to maintain a habitable environment in the CRE for a 30 day continuous occupancy after a DBA without exceeding 5 rem total effective dose equivalent (TEDE).

Knowledge of DBA analysis initial conditions.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HIGH annunciator is easily confused with the auto start for SBGT verifying Auto actions can be confused with Immediate Actions. SBGT start is a supplemental action which will reduce control room dose and 2 Rem TEDE is a site administrative dose limit and can be confused with the actual Dose Analysis from FHA of 2.69 rem TEDE.

Choice B: Plausible because PROCESS RX BLDG VENT RAD HIGH annunciator is easily confused with the auto start for SBGT verifying Auto actions can be confused with Immediate Actions. SBGT start is a supplemental action which will reduce control room dose and 5 Rem TEDE is correct.

Choice C: Plausible because CREV is correct and 2 Rem TEDE is a site administrative dose limit and can be confused with the actual Dose Analysis from FHA of 2.69 rem TEDE.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation SRO Only Basis:

Conditions and limitations in the facility license (43(b)(1)

SB. S295026 A2.03 001 An event on Unit One has resulted in the following plant conditions:

Reactor pressure 1000 psig Reactor Water Level 120 inches Control Rod Positions All unknown APRMs Downscale Drywell pressure 3 psig Supp. Pool pressure 2 psig Supp. Pool water temp 1500 F Supp. Pool water level -4 feet (Reference provided)

Which one of the following identifies the status of the Heat Capacity Temperature Limit (HCTL) and the required procedure for reactor pressure control?

HCTL Pressure Control Leg of Procedure A. has been exceeded RVCP B has been exceeded LPC C. has NOT been exceeded RVCP D. has NOT been exceeded LPC

Feedback K/A: S295026A2.03 Ability to determine andlor interpret the following as they apply to SUPPRESSION POOL HIGH WATER TEMPERATURE:

Reactor pressure (CFR: 41.10/43.5/45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.9/4.0 Objective:

CLSLP300L*05a Given the PCCP, determine the appropriate actions if any of the following limits are approached or exceeded: Heat Capacity Temperature Limit

Reference:

Heat Capacity Temperature Graph only is given to examinee PCCP.

Cog Level:

High Previous Exam - 11/08 Brunswick Explanation:

HCTL has been exceeded. With rods unknown the operator would be in LPC.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because rods are unknown, would be in LPC.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because HCTL has been exceeded. rods are unknown, would be in LPC Choice D: Plausible because HCTL has been exceeded.

SRO Basis:

Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations (43(b)(5)

8-9. S29502&A205001 Unit Two is operating at rated power when half of the Drywell (DW) Coolers are lost.

Which one of the following completes the statements below?

(Assume initial DW and Suppression Pool pressures are equal)

Suppression Pool pressure will rise at (1) DW pressure.

If DW Average Air Temperature is not restored to within the LCO limit in (2) hours, the Unit is required to be in Mode 3 within the following 12 hours1.388889e-4 days <br />0.00333 hours <br />1.984127e-5 weeks <br />4.566e-6 months <br /> per TS 3.6.1.4 (Drywell Air Temperature).

A. (1) the same rate as (2) 8 B. (1) the same rate as (2) 12 C (1) a slower rate than (2) 8 D. (1) aslowerrate than (2) 12

Feedback K/A: S295028A2.05 Ability to determine and/or interpret the following as they apply to HIGH DRYWELL TEMPERATURE:

Torus/suppression chamber pressure: Plant-Specific (CFR: 41.10 / 43.5 /45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.6/3.8 Objective:

CLSLP004A* I 5a Given plant conditions, determine the effects that the following will have on the Primary Containment, Primary Containment Ventilation and Primary Containment Monitoring: Loss of Drywell cooling.

Reference:

SD-04, Primary Containment Tech Spec 3.6.1.4, Drywell Air Temperature Cog Level:

High Explanation:Reduced DW cooling or rising DW temperature results in DW pressure increases whose severity is dependent upon plant conditions. OAOP-14.0, Abnormal Primary Containment Conditions provides guidance on indications to be monitored and actions to be taken which include verification of cooling system lineups and reductions in power to maintain average temperature below 150°F. Failure to accomplish this may require entry into the OEOP-02-PCCP Primary Containment Control.

Elevated DW temperature causes DW pressure to rise. As DW pressure rises, SP water level rises causing a rise in SP pressure. Due to the downcomers extending 3 feet below the surface of the SP water level a differential pressure will always exist. Temperature response is different from LOCA response due to steam AND non-condensibles being forced into the SP steam condensing and non-condensibles collecting in SP air space.

TS 3.6.1.4 (DW Air Temperature) limit of< 150°F, CONDITION A Drywell average air temperature not within limit, REQUIRED ACTION A.1 Restore drywell average air temperature to within limit has a COMPLETION TIME of 8 hours9.259259e-5 days <br />0.00222 hours <br />1.322751e-5 weeks <br />3.044e-6 months <br />. If temperature is not restored to < 150°F, CONDITION B, REQUIRED ACTION B.1 Be in MODE 3 has a COMPLETION TIME of 12 hours1.388889e-4 days <br />0.00333 hours <br />1.984127e-5 weeks <br />4.566e-6 months <br />.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because SP pressure is changed by the change in SP level only vs pressure, steam, and non-condensibles during a LOCA. The SP air space temperature is in equilibrium with SP water temperature (95°Fmax during normal operations) rising DW pressure would have a direct impact on SP level. However during temperature only (no steam), the DW pressure increase is cushioned by SP water, small changes in SP water level provides small change in SP pressure. 8 hours9.259259e-5 days <br />0.00222 hours <br />1.322751e-5 weeks <br />3.044e-6 months <br /> to restore temperature is correct.

Choice B: Plausible because SP pressure is changed by the change in SP level only vs pressure, steam, and non-condensibles during a LOCA. The SP air space temperature is in equilibrium with SP water temperature (95°Fmax during normal operations) rising DW pressure would have a direct impact on SP level. However during temperature only (no steam), the DW pressure increase is cushioned by SP water, small changes in SP water level provides small change in SP pressure. 12 hours1.388889e-4 days <br />0.00333 hours <br />1.984127e-5 weeks <br />4.566e-6 months <br /> is the time required to get to MODE 3 if not restored within the required Completion Time.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because rising at a slower rate is correct and 12 hours1.388889e-4 days <br />0.00333 hours <br />1.984127e-5 weeks <br />4.566e-6 months <br /> is the time required to get to MODE 3 if not restored within the required Completion Time.

SRO Basis:

Application of required actions (Section 3) and surveillance requirements (Section 4) in accordance with rules of application requirements (Section 1). (43(b)(2)

90. 8295029 &2.01 .07 002 The following plant conditions exist on Unit Two:

- An ATWS with a spurious Group I Isolation has occurred

- HPCI is injecting to the RPV to maintain RPV level

- SUPPRESSION CHAMBER LVL HI-HI is in alarm Which one of the following identifies:

(1) the reason that HPCI is re-aligned from its current suction source and (2) the procedure that contains the steps to perform the actions to transfer the HPCI suction valves?

A. (I) To prevent pump bearing damage (2) 20P-19, High Pressure Coolant Injection System Operating Procedure B (1) To prevent pump bearing damage (2) SEP-10, Circuit Alteration Procedure C. (1) To prevent HPCI exhaust check valve damage (2) 20P-19, High Pressure Coolant Injection System Operating Procedure D. (I) To prevent HPCI exhaust check valve damage (2) SEP-I 0, Circuit Alteration Procedure

Feedback K/A: 295029 G2.01.07 Ability to evaluate plant performance and make operational judgments based on operating characteristics, reactor behavior, and instrument interpretation.

High Suppression Pool Water Level (CFR: 41.5 / 43.5 / 45.12 /45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.4/4.7 Objective:

CLS-LP-019-A, Obj. 26g:

Given plant conditions and one of the following events, use plant procedures to determine the actions required to control and/or mitigate the consequences of the event: High Suppression Pool water level

Reference:

20P-19, HPCI System Operating Procedure 001-37.5, Level/Power Control Procedure Basis Document SUPPRESSION CHAMBER LVL HI-HI APP Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Very high lube oil temperatures can result in loss of lubricating qualities in the oil and thus cause damage to the bearings. Suction for HPCI and RCIC is aligned to the Condensate Storage Tank (CST) if it is available. The HPCI automatic suction transfer logic can be defeated to allow this lineup if necessary provided suppression pool temperature is approaching 140°F. Step RC/L-25 of LPC directs maintaining reactor water level with the systems listed in Table 1. HPCI with suction from CST if available is listed in Table I with the direction to defeat the Defeat HPCI Hi Suppression Pool level Suction Transfer if necessary per SEP-10.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because 20P-19 contains direction for transferring the HPCI suction from the torus to the CST. (Section 8.9)

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because RC/L-20 references potential HPCI equipment damage which could be interpreted as exhaust check valve damage. 20P-19 contains direction for transferring the HPCI suction from the torus to the CST. (Section 8.9)

Choice D: Plausible because RC/L-20 references potential HPCI equipment damage which could be interpreted as exhaust check valve damage.

SRO Basis:

10 CFR 55.43(b)-S Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.

91. S295038G 2.0242 001 Unit Two is operating at rated power when both SJAE Offgas Radiation monitor readings increase by 50% over their previous value.

Which one of the following completes the statement below?

lAW (1) surveillance requirements, the SJAE release rate must be confirmed within the limits within (2)

A. (1) ODCM 7.3.2, Radioactive Gaseous Effluent Monitoring Instrumentation (2) 4 hours4.62963e-5 days <br />0.00111 hours <br />6.613757e-6 weeks <br />1.522e-6 months <br /> B. (1) ODCM 7.3.2, Radioactive Gaseous Effluent Monitoring Instrumentation (2) 12 hours1.388889e-4 days <br />0.00333 hours <br />1.984127e-5 weeks <br />4.566e-6 months <br /> C (1) Technical Specification 3.7.5, Main Condenser Offgas (2) 4 hours4.62963e-5 days <br />0.00111 hours <br />6.613757e-6 weeks <br />1.522e-6 months <br /> D. (1) Technical Specification 3.7.5, Main Condenser Offgas (2) 12 hours1.388889e-4 days <br />0.00333 hours <br />1.984127e-5 weeks <br />4.566e-6 months <br />

Feedback K/A: S295038G 2.02.42 Ability to recognize system parameters that are entry-level conditions for Technical Specifications.

High Off-Site Release Rate (CFR: 41.7 /41.10 /43.2 / 43.3 / 45.3)

ROISRO Rating:

3.9/4.6 Objective:

CLSLP3O*08 Given plant conditions and Technical Specifications, including the Bases, TRM, ODCM, and COLR, determine whether given plant conditions meet minimum Technical Specifications, TRM, or ODCM requirements associated with the Condenser Air Removal/Augmented Offgas System.

Reference:

101-03.1, Revision 10, Page 44, Item #57 (CODSR)

Cog Level:

High Explanation:

NOTIFY E&RC to confirm release rate is within limits within 4 hours4.62963e-5 days <br />0.00111 hours <br />6.613757e-6 weeks <br />1.522e-6 months <br /> following a monitor reading increase of greater than or equal to 50% without an accompanying increase in thermal power. SR 3.7.5.1 Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because the SJAE Rad Monitor operability is required by ODCM 7.3.2 and 4 hours4.62963e-5 days <br />0.00111 hours <br />6.613757e-6 weeks <br />1.522e-6 months <br /> is correct.

Choice B: Plausible because the SJAE Rad Monitor operability is required by ODCM 7.3.2 and 12 hours1.388889e-4 days <br />0.00333 hours <br />1.984127e-5 weeks <br />4.566e-6 months <br /> is a timeframe for another Required Action in this spec.

Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because TS 3.7.5 is correct and 12 hours1.388889e-4 days <br />0.00333 hours <br />1.984127e-5 weeks <br />4.566e-6 months <br /> is a timeframe for another Required Action in this spec.

SRO Basis:

Application of Surveillance Requirements and timeframe greater than 1 hour1.157407e-5 days <br />2.777778e-4 hours <br />1.653439e-6 weeks <br />3.805e-7 months <br />.

92. S300000A2.01 001 The following plant conditions exist on Unit Two due to a malfunction of the Air Dryer:

- SERVICE AIR PRESS-LOW is in alarm

- RB INSTR AIR RECEIVER 2A PRESS LOW is in alarm

- RB INSTR AIR RECEIVER 2B PRESS LOW is in alarm

- Instrument Air pressure is 93 psig and recovering Based on the above indications, which one of the following identifies:

(1) the status of the Service Air Dryer Bypass Valve, SA-PV-5067, and (2) the procedure that contains the steps to close the Reactor Building Inboard and Outboard Isolation Valves (BFIVs)?

A(1) open (2) OAOP-20.O, Pneumatic (Air/Nitrogen) System Failures B. (1) open (2) 2APP-UA-O1, Se,vice Air Press-Low C. (1) closed (2) OAOP-20.O, Pneumatic (Air/Nitrogen) System Failures D. (1) closed (2) 2APP-UA-O1, Service Air Press-Low

Feeilback K/A: 300000 A2.01 Ability to (a) predict the impacts of the following on the INSTRUMENT AIR SYSTEM and (b) based on those predictions, use procedures to correct, control, or mitigate the consequences of those abnormal operation:

Air dryer and filter malfunctions (CFR: 41.5 / 45.6)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.9/2.8 Objective:

CLS-LP-46, 07i:

Given plant conditions, determine if the following automatic actions should occur: Air Dryer is bypassed.

Reference:

RB INSTR AIR RECEIVER 2B PRESS LOW(UA-01 1-2)

SERWCE AIR PRESS LOW(UA-01 5-4)

OAOP-20, Pneumatic (Air/Nitrogen) System Failures Cog Level:

High Explanation:

The air dryer malfunction has caused air pressure to lower. The Service Air low pressure alarms comes in at 107 psig. At 105# decreasing the Service Air system isolates, thus the 0 psig indication on Service Air.

The alarms for the receivers low pressure come in at 95# and are located in the Reactor Building. With these alarms in the operators are required to close the BFIVs while there is still sufficient air pressure remaining to make the secondary containment isolation valves close in accordance with the AOP supplemental actions.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because the air dryer bypass valve is open, but the guidance for closure of the BFIVs is contained in the AOP or RB INSTR AIR RECEIVER 2A(B) PRESS LOW APP.

Choice C: Plausible because the AOP is the correct procedure for closure of the BFIVs, but the air dryer bypass valve would be open (requires system knowledge to know the setpoint for the bypass opening).

Choice D: Plausible because the student may not know the setpoint of the bypass valve opening and the guidance for closure of the BFIVs is contained in the AOP or RB INSTR AIR RECEIVER 2A(B)

PRESS LOWAPP.

SRO Basis:

10 CFR 55.43(b)-5 Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, and emergency situations.

The first part of the question is RO knowledge (setpoint for the auto opening of the air dryer bypass valve the second part is Assessing plant conditions (normal, abnormal, or emergency) and then prescribing a procedure to mitigate, recover, or with which to proceed.

93. S600000G 2.02.37 002 Unit Two is operating at rated power when a fire in the Unit Two Reactor Building 20 North is confirmed.

Which one of the following identifies the impact on safety related equipment and the procedure(s) required to be entered under the above plant conditions?

A fire on the Unit Two Reactor Building 20 North will impact (1) Availability.

The Unit CRS is required to enter (2)

A. (1) RHRL0opA (2) OPFP-013, General Fire Plan, only B(1) RHRL00pA (2) OPFP-013, General Fire Plan, and OASSD-01, Alternative Safe Shutdown Procedure Index C. (1) RHRLoopB (2) OPFP-013, General Fire Plan, only D. (1) RHRL00pB (2) OPFP-013, General Fire Plan, and OASSD-01, Alternative Safe Shutdown Procedure Index

Feedback K/A: S600000G 2.02.37 Ability to determine operability andlor availability of safety related equipment.

Plant Fire On Site (CFR: 41.7 / 43.5/45.12)

ROISRO Rating:

3.6/4.6 Objective:

Reference:

OAP-025, BNP Integrated Scheduling, Section 3.1 Cog Level:

High Explanation:

2PFP-RB identifies safety related electrical equipment by red or green color coding. (Div I or II respectively) The north side of Unit 2 RB 20 has Div I related MOOs identified which provide power to RHR system motor operated valves. There are no Div II designated MCCs identifies for the same location. of PFP-013 Senior Control Operator Fire Actions directs the SCO to enter PFP-013 and ASSD-01.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because RHR Loop A is correct and OPFP-013 directs entry into both PFP-013 and ASSD-01.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because RHR Loop B can be impacted bya fire in RB South and OPFP-013 directs entry into both PFP-013 and ASSD-01.

Choice D: Plausible because RHR Loop B can be impacted by a fire in RB South and part 2 is correct.

SRO Basis:

Knowledge of administrative procedures that specify implementation, and/or coordination of plant normal procedures.

94. soioi.oooi Which one of the following choices completes the statement below?

If the ASSD staffing composition is less than the minimum required, establish an (1) lAW (2)

A (1) ASSD Impairment (2) OPLP-1 .5, Alternative Shutdown Capability Controls B. (1) LCO for T.S. 5.2.2, Facility Staff Organization, (2) OPLP-1 .5, Alternative Shutdown Capability Controls C. (1) ASSD Impairment (2) 001-01 .01, BNP Conduct of Operations Supplement D. (1) LCO for T.S. 5.2.2, Facility Staff Organization, (2) 001-01.01, BNP Conduct of Operations Supplement

Feedback K/A: SG2.01.05 Conduct of Operations Ability to use procedures related to shift staffing, such as minimum crew complement, overtime limitations, etc.

(CFR: 41.10 / 43.5 /4512)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.9/3.9 Objective:

CLSLP304M*1 3m Given ASSD procedures and plant conditions that require use of ASSD procedures, determine the following: The manpower required to support the ASSD actions.

Reference:

ASSD-00, ASSD Users Guide, Section 5.3.3 Cog Level:

Low Explanation:

The ASSD staffing composition may be less than the minimum requirements for a period of time not to exceed two hours in order to accommodate unexpected absence of on-duty shift crew members provided immediate action is taken to restore requirements to within the minimum requirements of the shift ASSD staffing. If the ASSD staffing composition is less than the minimum required, establish an Alternative Safe Shutdown Impairment in accordance with OPLP-1 .5, Alternative Shutdown Capability Controls, and OFPP-020, Impairment Notification.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because an impairment is the same as LCO (001-01.01) but impairments are not established against TS 5.2.2 and ASSD User Guide is correct.

Choice C: Plausible because ASSD impairment is correct and 001-01.01 provides staffing requirements for TS 5.2.2 but directs use of OASSD-00 procedure use for required staffing.

Choice D: Plausible because Plausible because an impairment is the same as LCO (001-01.01) but impairments are not established against TS 5.2.2 and 001-01.01 provides staffing requirements for TS 5.2.2 but directs use of OASSD-00 procedure use for required staffing.

SRO Basis:

Requires knowledge of TS 5.2.2 Facility Staff Organization and prescribes the procedure required for guidance during periods of ASSD minimum complement not maintained.

95. SG2.0 1.42 001 Which one of the following core loading sequences establishes a neutronic bridge as described in OFH-11?

Four fuel bundles are loaded around (1) then fuel is loaded in all fuel cells in a line between SRMs (2)

A. (1) SRMs A and D only (2) A and D B. (1) SRMs B and D only (2) B and D C. (1) eachofthefourSRMs (2) A and D D. (1) each of the four SRMs (2) B and D

Feedback K/A: SG2.0l.42 Conduct of Operations Knowledge of new and spent fuel movement procedures.

(CFR: 41.10/43.7/45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

2.5/3.4 Objective:

Reference:

OFH-1 1, Refueling, Section 4.37 Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Provide ENP-24-12, Figure 1 as a reference From FH-1 1, 4.37 To help ensure that an unmonitored criticality will not occur, control rod withdrawal is not allowed during the core reload sequence until a neutronic bridge is established. The neutronic bridge ensures that two SRMs are neutronically coupled, thus monitoring the loaded area of the core. The reload sequence has three basic steps. Four fuel bundles are loaded around each of the four SRMs, the neutronic bridge is established and a spiral reload of the other fuel bundles completes the sequence. The neutronic bridge is established by loading fuel in all fuel cells in a line between two SRMs. These SRMs must be on opposite sides of the core and the line of loaded fuel cells must intersect the center of the core (A to D would not intersect the center, B to D would).

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because loading fuel around 2 SRMs and a line between them would establish a neutron bridge (between those 2 SRM5) but not lAW OFH-1 1 and A&D are adjacent.

Choice B: Plausible because loading fuel around 2 SRMs and a line between them would establish a neutron bridge (between those 2 SRM5) but not lAW OFH-1 1 and A&D are adjacent.

Choice C: Plausible because loading fuel around all SRMs is correct but A&D are adjacent.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation SRO Basis:

IOCFR55.43.6 Procedures and limitations involved in initial core loading, alterations in core configuration, control rod programming, and determination of various internal and external effects on core reactivity.

10CFR55.43.7 Fuel handling facilities and procedures.

96. SG2.02.15 001 With Unit Two operating at power, Annunciator RCIC TURBINE STM LINE DRN POT LEVEL HI alarms and the RO observes the E51-F054, F025, & F026 indications on Panel P601 are green and the valves cannot be re-opened.

Which one of the following completes the statements below?

(Reference provided)

These valves are closed due to loss of (1)

After 5 minutes the appropriate actions in the annunciator procedure have been taken and the system (2)

A. (1) pneumatics (2) remains Operable B (1) pneumatics (2) is Inoperable C. (1) DC Power (2) remains Operable D. (1) DC Power (2) is Inoperable

Feedback KJA: SG2.02.15 EQUIPMENT CONTROL Ability to determine the expected plant configuration using design and configuration control documentation, such as drawings, line-ups, tag-outs, etc.

(CFR: 41.10 /43.3 /45.13)

ROISRO Rating:

3.9/4.3 Objective:

CLS-LP-01 6*1 5e Given plant conditions, predict the RCIC System response to the following conditions: DC power failure.

Reference:

2APP A-03 3-5, Page 44 Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Valves fail closed on loss of DC power or Pneumatics, however with a loss of power, position indication on P601 will also be lost. Per APP A-03, 3-5 If either E51-F025 or E51-F026 has been failed closed for more than 5 minutes, perform the following:

a. Close Turbine Trip and Throttle Valve, E51-V8, to prevent water hammer damage from a RCIC auto start.
b. If RCIC must be started, proceed to OP-16.

this would still make RCIC available for use per the procedure but it is inoperable because it will not auto start as required.

This will make the RCIC system inoperable but available to be restarted per the procedure.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because loss of pneumatics only is correct and the system will not start in auto when required, but could be manually started.

Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible because a loss of power will cause valves to fail closed, but with loss of power position indication will be lost and the system will not start in auto when required.

Choice D: Plausible because pneumatics and power will cause valves to fail closed, but with loss of power position indication will be lost and it is available to start per the procedure which makes it available.

SRO Basis:

Assessment of facility conditions and selection of appropriate procedures during normal, abnormal, emergency conditions.

97. SG2.02.22 002 Unit One is operating at 88% power with the following conditions:

Jet Pump Flow Loop A (B21-R61 IA) 29 Mlbs/hr Jet Pump Flow Loop B (B21-R611B) 33 Mlbs/hr Total Core Flow (UICPWTCF) 62 Mlbs/hr Which one of the following completes the statements below lAW T.S. 3.4.1, Recirculation Loops Operating, and Bases?

The current Jet Pump Flow Mismatch (1)

When Jet Pump Flows are not matched within limits, then the ioop with the (2) must be considered not in operation.

A. (I) is within limits (2) lower flow B. (1) is within limits (2) higher flow Cv (1) is not within limits (2) lower flow D. (I) is not within limits (2) higher flow

Feedback K/A: SG2.02.22 Equipment Control Knowledge of limiting conditions for operations and safety limits.

(CFR: 41.5 /43.2/45.2)

RO/SRO Rating:

4.0/4.7 Objective:

CLSLPO02*34 Given plant conditions and Technical Specifications, including the Bases, TRM, ODCM, and COLR determine the required action(s) to be taken in accordance with Technical Specifications associated with the Reactor Recirculation System. (SRO/STA only)

Reference:

Unit 1 Tech Spec 3.4.1, Recirculation Loops Operating and BASES Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Two recirculation loops are normally required to be in operation with their flows matched within the limits specified in SR 3.4.1.1 to ensure that that during a LOCA caused by a break of the piping of one recirculation loop the assumptions of the LOCA analysis are satisfied.

Jet pump loop flow mismatch should be maintained within the following limits:

- jet pump loop flows within 10% (maximum indicated difference 7.5 xl 0 lbs/hr) with total core flow less than 58 x10 lbs/hr

- jet pump loop flows within 5% (maximum indicated difference 3.5 xl 06 lbs/hr) with total core flow greater than or equal to 58 x10 6 lbs/hr Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because flow mismatch is within limits for lower reactor power level.

Choice B: Plausible because flow mismatch is within limits for lower reactor power level and because the belief that the higher flow loop will experience excessive vibration could cause them to select the higher flow response Choice C: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice D: Plausible because the belief that the higher flow loop will experience excessive vibration could cause them to select the higher flow response SRO Basis:

Application of Required Actions and Knowledge of TS Bases.

98.-sG2.3.11 001 Following a small steam line break in the drywell plant conditions are as follows:

Drywell pressure: 20 psig and rising Drywell Temperature: 305°F Drywell hydrogen: 1.8%

Suppression Chamber hydrogen: 1 .5%

Suppression Chamber level: +5 inches Which one of the following identifies the procedure required lAW PCCP?

A. SEP-01 Section 1, Venting Primary Containment Irrespective of Off Site Release rate B SEP-01, Section 2, Venting Primary Containment via the Suppression Chamber within Site Release Rate Limit C. SEP-01, Section 3, Venting Primary Containment via the Drywell within Site Release Rate Limit D. OEDMG-003, Containment Venting Under Conditions of Extreme Damage Irrespective of Off Site Release Rates

Feedback K/A: SG2.03.ll Radiation Control Ability to control radiation releases.

(CFR: 41.11 /43.4/45.10)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.8/4.3 Objective:

CLSLP300L*08d Given the Primary Containment Control Procedure and plant conditions, determine if the following actions are required: Venting the primary containment IRRESPECTIVE of radioactivity release rate limits

Reference:

001-37.8, Primary Containment Control Procedure Basis Document Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Following the H2 leg of the PCCP with the given conditions will drive you to step PC/H-14 which directs you to Vent the Suppression Chamber per Section 2 of Primary Containment Venting (EOP-0 1-SEP-01)

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible if examinee determines that PCPL-A is being challenged out of the pressure leg of the PCCP Choice B: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice C: Plausible if examinee determines that the appropriate vent path is from the drywell vs. the suppression chamber.

Choice D: Plausible because EDMG-03 provides alternative venting strategies which may be directed from SEP-01 in needed.

SRO Basis:

Detailed knowledge of diagnostic steps and decision points in the EOPs that involve transitions to emergency contingency procedures.

99. SG2.04.17_002 Which one of the following identifies the bases for the Minimum Number of SRVs Required for Emergency Depressurization and the required procedure utilized if this number of SRVs open cannot be achieved?

The Minimum Number of SRVs Required for Emergency Depressurization is based on the low pressure ECCS system with the lowest head being capable of making up the SRV steam flow at the (1)

If the minimum number of SRVs cannot be opened while performing LPC, then (2) is required to be entered.

A. (1) Reactor Flooding Pressure (2) SAMG-O1, SAMG Primary Containment Flooding Procedure B. (1) Reactor Flooding Pressure (2) OEOP-O1-AEDP, Alternate Emergency Depressurization Procedure C. (1) Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure (2) SAMG-O1, SAMG Primary Containment Flooding Procedure D (1) Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure (2) OEOP-O1-AEDP, Alternate Emergency Depressurization Procedure

Feedbick K/A: SG2.04.17 Emergency Procedures I Plan Knowledge of EOP terms and definitions.

(CFR: 41.10/45.13)

ROISRO Rating:

3.9/4.3 Objective:

CLSLP300H*002 Given plant conditions and the Emergency Operating Procedures, determine if execution of the Alternate Emergency Depressurization Procedure is required.

Reference:

OEOP-01 -UG, Attachment 5 (Definitions)

RVCP Cog Level:

High Explanation:

The Minimum Number of SRVs Required for Emergency Depressurization (5) is defined to be the least number of SRVs which correspond to a Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure sufficiently low that the ECCS with the lowest head will be capable of making up the SRV steam flow at the corresponding Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure. If the number of SRVs specified cannot be opened, the reactor must be depressurized by other means. A list of alternate systems that can be used for depressurizing the reactor is included in the Alternate Emergency Depressurization Procedure, EOP-01 -AEDP.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Plausible because Minimum Reactor Flooding Pressure is easily confused with Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure and Primary Containment Flooding requires exiting all EOPs which is wrong for the given conditions.

Choice B: Plausible because Minimum Reactor Flooding Pressure is easily confused with Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure and AEDP is correct.

Choice C: Plausible because Minimum Alternate Reactor Flooding Pressure is correct and Primary Containment Flooding requires exiting all EOPs which is wrong for the given conditions.

Choice D: Correct Answer, see explanation SRO Basis:

Detailed knowledge of diagnostic steps and decision points in the EOPs that involve transitions to emergency contingency procedures.

100. SG2.04.35- 002 An ATWS has occurred on Unit Two:

ARI has been actuated No blue lights are lit on the Full Core Display Suppression Pool Temperature is 112° F The 2A SLC pump has a red light indication The 2B SLC pump has a green light indication The SLC A Squib Valve Continuity white light is lit The SLC B Squib Valve Continuity white light is extinguished Which one of the following identifies the procedure that an AD is required to perform?

A Perform LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion, Section 2.

B. Perform LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion, Section 6.

C. Perform LEP-03, Alternate Boron Injection, Section 2.

D. Perform LEP-03, Alternate Boron Injection, Section 3.

Feedback K/A: SG2.04.35 Emergency Procedures I Plan Knowledge of local auxiliary operator tasks during an emergency and the resultant operational effects.

(CFR: 41.10/43.5 /45.13)

RO/SRO Rating:

3.8/4.0 Objective:

CLSLP300J*005 Given plant conditions and the Local Emergency Procedures, determine which sections of the Alternate Control Rod Insertion Procedure should be utilized for Control Rod Insertion (EOP-01-LEP-02).

Reference:

OEOP-01-LEP-02, Alternate Control Rod Insertion Cog Level:

High Explanation:

Based on the conditions given, determines that scram valves have not opened (no blue lights on full core display) and that Boron is injecting with A pump running (red light on) and B squib valve opened (white light extinguished) so LEP-03 is not required. The pumps discharge into a common header before going to the squib valves. Requires assessment of alternate control rod insertion sections and determines venting the scram air header is appropriate.

Distractor Analysis:

Choice A: Correct Answer, see explanation Choice B: Plausible because venting of the over piston area will insert the control rods but would be the inappropriate decision for rod insertion given the conditions. The operational effect is reactor shutdown with control rod insertion.

Choice C: Plausible because suppression pool temperature is greater than 110° F and boron injection is required. With A pump running but the A squib valve not open and no B pump a common misconception is that SLC flow will not occur to the Reactor. this would be correct under different conditions in the stem. The operational effect is reactor shutdown with boron injection.

Choice D: Plausible because suppression pool temperature is greater than I 10° F and boron injection is required. With A pump running but the A squib valve not open and no B pump a common misconception is that SLC flow will not occur to the Reactor. this would be correct under different conditions in the stem. The operational effect is reactor shutdown with boron injection.

SRO Basis:

Assessing plant conditions and prescribing a section of a procedure with which to proceed.